Nothing Special   »   [go: up one dir, main page]

Fire Catalogue Iss 7 24

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 210
At a glance
Powered by AI
The document discusses different types of fire detection systems including addressable systems, conventional systems, aspirating systems, and special hazard systems. It also discusses various components, accessories, and tools related to fire detection.

The document discusses addressable systems, conventional systems, networks and graphics, detector test equipment, system accessories, aspirating systems, fire phones and disabled refuge, water leak detection, and special hazards.

Some of the components of addressable fire detection systems discussed include control panels, repeaters, detectors, bases and accessories, input/output modules, sounders and beacons, and software tools.

Contents

CONTENTS CONTENTS

Chapter 1 - Introduction

1.1

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology 2.1 Minerva MZX Addressable Control Panels 2.2 Minerva MX2 Range 2.4 Minerva MX4000 2.5 Battery & Expansion Boxes 2.6 Minerva MX Repeaters 2.7 MZX4000 Black Box 2.8 Minerva T2000 & T2000 CV Marine Detection Panels 2.9 Minerva T2000R & T2000R CV Marine Repeaters 2.10 MX Panel Components 2.13 DDA Compliant Pager 2.25 MX Virtual Multi-Sensor Detectors 2.28 Beam and Linear Heat Detectors 2.32 Detector Bases & Accessories 2.35 Detector Ancillaries 2.39 Duct Probe Air Sampling 2.41 MX Addressable Input/Output Modules 2.43 MZX Compatible 4 Amp 24VDC Addressable Door Holder PSU 2.47 MX Ancillary Housings 2.48 Callpoints 2.50 Sounders & Beacons 2.56 Software Tools & Accessories 2.70 2.71 MZX Interactive Training CD Programming and Service Tools 2.73 Service & Spares 2.76 Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Control Panels and Repeater Panels DDA Compliant Pager Point Detectors Beam Detectors Linear Heat Detectors Detector Bases and Accessories Duct Probes Callpoints Sounders & Beacons Service & Spares Chapter 4 - Networks & Graphics Tyco Expert Graphics (TXG) MXNet MX Minerva - Bridge Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment Chapter 6 - System Accessories Batteries, PSU and Chargers Door Release Equipment Auxiliary Interface Relays Fire Resistant Cable 3.1 3.1 3.9 3.11 3.16 3.18 3.19 3.23 3.25 3.32 3.46 4.1 4.1 4.4 4.6 5.1 6.1 6.1 6.3 6.4 6.5

Chapter 7 - VESDA 7.1 LaserFOCUS Aspirating Smoke Detection 7.1 LaserCOMPACT and MX LaserCOMPACT 7.2 LaserPLUS Standard Modular Range 7.3 LaserPLUS Scanners 7.4 ICAM IAS800 Air Sampling Smoke Detection Systems 7.7 Vesda Pipe, Fittings and Test Equipment 7.8 Chapter 8 - Fire Phones & Disable Refuge 8.1 Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection 9.1

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards 10.1 Special Hazard Flame Detectors 10.3 System 800 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas 10.7 System 620 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas 10.13 MZX SensorLaser Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System 10.24 Chapter 11 - Useful Information MX Addressable Detector, Mode Selection & Design Charts Conventional Detector Selection & Design Charts MKII Sounder Base Application Table Sounder Tone Tables Consultants Guide 11.1 11.1 11.3 11.4 11.6 11.8

Fire Catalogue

12/10

Chapter 1 - Introduction Fire Detection


Welcome to the latest issue of the Tyco Safety Products Fire Detection Catalogue of product available from our Letchworth U.K. distribution centre. This catalogue is intended to assist all sellers and system designers involved in fire detection from entry level conventional systems to extensive networked addressable systems and special hazard protection. In line with our ISO 9000 accreditation, only those products that meet the highest quality criteria have been included. Our goal is to despatch product on the same day as we receive your order. Our warranty and service returns policy is second to none. We recognise that your business is highly dependant on excellence in customer service and to help achieve this we offer extended warranty from many of our suppliers. Full credit is also available on a "No Question - No Fuss" basis for any new in-warranty product returned to the distribution centre. New Catalogue Layout With an emphasis on ease of use, the contents of this Issue has been arranged to meet the specific needs of individual users. Each section covers a different aspect of fire detection and contains all product associated with that subject. If a particular product is used for example with both conventional systems and addressable systems, it will appear in both sections. Each section can therefore be used independently and each section can also be downloaded separately from the Tyco Safety Products website. The 11 sections covered are; 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Introduction Addressable Systems Conventional Systems Networks & Graphics Detector Test Equipment System Accessories Aspirating Systems Fire Phones and Disabled Refuge Water Leak Detection Special Hazard Useful Information

Website The Tyco Safety Products website is full of up-to-date information including a section dedicated to fire detection products where you will find lots of useful information including; Approval Certificates AutoCAD Downloads Catalogues Datasheets Forums Marketing Bulletins Presentations Technical Information including; User manuals Application & Design Manuals Installation Manuals Commissioning Manuals Service Manuals Sales Information Software Downloads Contact Us For further details on this catalogue, contact our customer telephone Help Line at Letchworth Customer Services on + 44 (0) 1462 66 77 00. TFS Technical Support Call Centre:Direct: +31 475 352 722 Fax: +31 475 352 725 Hours: 9:00 to 19:00 CET, 8:00 to 18:00 GMT, 7:00 to 17:00 EET UK only: 08701-238 787 Toll Free: 0800 CALL TYCO or (0800 22 55 89 26) E-Mail: tspemea.support.fire@tycoint.com Our web site can be found at: www.tycoemea.com

03/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 1 Page 1

Chapter 1 - Introduction

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 1 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

03/10

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology MZX Detection Panels


Tyco MX detection panels use all the features of Tyco MX Technology to provide the latest fire detection technology meeting the latest worldwide standards in cost-effective, expandable packages.

Tyco MX detection panels support Tyco MX Technology: MX VIRTUAL Multi-sensor detectors MX DIGITAL high speed reliable digital protocol MX FASTLOGIC fuzzy logic smoke detection algorithms MX CCO universal carbon monoxide fire detection algorithms

Tyco MX panels include advanced manager and engineer functions including: Menu driven Multi-level password protected Viewing 3000 event log Detailed fault reporting Isolate by point, zone or sector Viewing and printing status Viewing and printing isolated points Manual and automatic walk test and reporting functions Viewing and printing maintenance reports Extensive diagnostic functions including simulation and force outputs Text and configuration changes/Automatic battery test Detector service functions Tyco MX detection panels include very powerful event/action programming including: Seamless network wide event/action 240 x 240 Output map and output sequencing algorithms Over 3000 event/action groups for the most complex applications Templates for fast programming of standard applications including: - EN54/BS5839 - EN54 Marine User defined templates Time, date and special day programming Wide range of co-incidence, double knock and delay functions

Tyco MX detection panels provide modular cost effective solutions: Networked panels from 1 to 792 detection loops Powerful central loop processing functions Powerful and modular user interface MX REMOTE diagnostics and service functions TXG graphical user interfaces MZX, MX2 and designer housing options

Tyco MX detection panels provide long term fire detection solutions including upgrade paths from earlier panel models and a long term develop-ment strategy providing future upgrade paths. Tyco MX detection panels include: MZX for compact single loop solutions MINERVA MX for EN54 LPCB approved systems MINERVA T2000 for Marine approved systems Tyco MX detection panels include a powerful user interface: 640 Character display Displays first alarm and most recent alarm Permanently displays systems status including number of alarms, number of faults, number of isolated points Scroll function allows details of all events and status to be easily viewed Displays temperature, CO level and smoke level at point in alarm Displays 95 character custom messages for emergency procedures

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 1

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Supports one, two or 4 loops with 125, 250, 500 or 1000 addresses (panel dependant) 2km loop length High level User Interface with Front Panel Controls to reduce lifetime cost of ownership Wide range of detectors including the 3oTec triple sensing detector providing early detection without false alarms. Wide range of ancillaries including door control to BS7273 category A DDA compliance using AVBase and loop powered sounder beacons. Approved to EN54 the system is designed to be installed to BS5839 Part 2

Minerva MZX Addressable Control Panels


This range of digital addressable fire control panels uses the well established MXDigital Loop protocol, detectors, i/o modules, user interface and software from the MX range of panels. They provide a single box solution ideally suited for small and medium sized installations up to 64 zones. The following models are available :MZX125 Single Loop, 125 Addresses, 16 Zones MZX250 Single Loop, 250 Addresses, 32 Zones MZX251 Single Loop, 250 Addresses, 32 Zones MZX252 Two Loop, 500 Addresses, 32 Zones MZX253 2 to 4 Loop, up to 1000 addresses, 64 Zones The MZX125 housing has space for 2 x 12Ah batteries The MZX250 housing has space for 2 x 17Ah batteries The MZX251,252 & 253 housings have space for 2 x 38Ah batteries Running the robust MXDigital loop protocol the panels can operate using most cable types. This makes them ideal for upgrades as the existing cables can be utilised reducing installation time and cost. All panels are complete with an integral PSU which will support a full compliment of loop powered sounders and beacons. The MZX250, 251, 252 and 253 control panels can be fitted with the TLI800EN network interface module, This enables up to 99 control panels to be seamlessly networked, or to be added to an existing network of MX Fire controllers. Repeaters Three dedicated repeaters are available. These repeaters offer the user full panel functionality. Up to 7 repeaters can be attached to the control panels 2 wire remote bus. Two repeaters are mains driven with internal mains psu & batteries and one requires an external 24VDC supply MZX16R 16 Zones with space for 7Ah or 12Ah batteries MZX32R 32 Zones with space for 17Ah batteries MZX64DR 64 Zones (requires 24VDC supply)

Product Codes
557.200.501 557.200.502 557.200.503 557.200.506 557.200.508 557.202.073 557.200.520 557.200.521 557.200.526 557.201.502 557.201.501 557.201.503 MZX125 1 loop 16 Zone Fire Controller MZX250 1 loop 32 Zone Fire Controller MZX251 1 loop 32 Zone Fire Controller MZX252 2 loop 32 Zone Fire Controller MZX253 2 to 4 loop 64 zone fire controller 2 Loop expansion kit for MZX253 (includes XLM loop card) MZX16R 16 Zone Repeater (mains powered) MZX32R 32 Zone Repeater (mains powered) MZX64DR 64 Zone Repeater (24VDC powered) Semi-Flush Bezel for MZX125/MZX16R Semi-Flush Bezel for MZX250/251/252/253/MZX32R Accessory mounting plate for std modules, IOB800, LIM800 and TUD800 (MZX250/251/252 only) Comms Interface mounting plate (MZX250/251/252/253 only) Rack mount kit for MZX 125 Rack mount kit for MZX 250 Rack Mount Kit for MZX 251/252/ 253 MZX250 17Ah Battery Clamp MZX251/ 252 38Ah Battery Clamp MZX251/252/253 24Ah Battery Clamp 02/12

557.201.519 557.201.510 557.201.511 557.201.512 557.201.307 557.201.505 557.201.520 Chapter 2 Page 2 Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


MZX Addressable Control Panels Technical Specifications
MZX125 Dimensions H x W x D mm 370x325x126 Weight 7kg Operating Temp Storage Temp Humidity Housing Colour Facia Colour EMC/RFI Supply Voltage Input Current 0.9A Charger Size Note 1 2.5A Max Battery Size 2 x 12V 12Ah MZX250 480x410x140 9.7kg MZX251/252/253 MZX16R MZX32R MZX64DR 370x254x84 4kg 480x410x205 370x325x126 480x410x140 10.6kg 6.6kg 9.3kg -5oC +40oC -20oC +70oC 90% relative Humidity Non Condensing RAL7035 Pantone Grey 431C EN50130-4 & EN61000-6-3 230VAC 50/60 Hz 1.6A 0.9A 0.9A 5.0A 2 x 12V 38Ah 2.5A 2 x 12V 12Ah 2.5A 2 x 12V 17Ah

1.6A

24VDC 250mA none none

5.0A 2 x 12V 17Ah

Note 1 Max PSE output current with the charger interrupted (I max b, EN54-4)

MZX Ancillary housings & PSUs This range of housing & PSUs is designed to complement the MZX range of fire controllers, the housings are available in different sizes to match the MZX fire controller. Two ranges of ancillary housing are available; one is designed to accommodate various modules on the removable chassis plate and also has the option to mount a document holder on the rear of the door. The other ancillary housings, (aperture housings) are designed to accommodate one or two standard sized MX control, display, printer or annunciator modules ie ANN880, COM820, PRN800 or similar, a chassis plate for mounting modules is also fitted. The housings with two apertures are supplied with one blanking plate

Product Codes
557.202.625 557.202.626 557.202.627 557.202.622 557.202.623 557.202.624 557.201.513 557.201.518 ANC125-A ANC250-A ANC251-A ANC125 ANC250 ANC251 Ancillary Housing, One Aperture (Small - matches MZX125) Ancillary Housing, Two Aperture (Large matches MZX250) Ancillary Housing, Two Aperture (Deep matches MZX251/252/253) Ancillary Housing (Small - matches MZX125) Ancillary Housing (Large matches MZX250) Ancillary Housing (Deep matches MZX251/252/253) Document Holder attachment (used with ANC125/250/251) M520 Anc Fitting Kit reqd for older M520 modules, fittings for 4 modules

Power Supply Units The power supplies utilise switch mode PSUs as used in the MZX range of panels, if monitoring of these PSUs is required a monitoring kit is available which includes a MIM800, mounting bracket and cables 557.200.530 557.200.531 557.201.516 PSU A17 PSU A38 17Ahr 5A Addressable expansion PSU - matches MZX250 38Ahr 5A Addressable expansion PSU - matches MZX251/252/253 PSU monitor kit (includes MIM800)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 3

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology

Minerva MX2 Range - IEC 61508 Approved (SIL2)


The Minerva MX2 range of panels are intelligent LPCB EN54 compliant panels, which can be networked to provide up to 396 detection loops and installed to BS5839:Pt1 2002. The MX2 design philosophy is to have a single panel housing that incorporates all the necessary components required to satisfy the most comprehensive of specifications. Additional matching ancillary housings can accommodate a range of standard modules, adjacent to or remote from the main controller. MX2 panels support two MX DIGITAL detection loops with up to 250 addressable devices per loop. MX2 panels can be expanded to eight loops supporting up to 1000 addressable devices. MX2 consists of a strong steel enclosure incorporating a removable chassis plate. The chassis plate holds: PSU830 5A 24Vdc battery back power supply and loop booster to EN54:pt.4. FIM800 field interface PCB incorporating two MX DIGITAL loops. CPU800 32 bit processor and memory card Optional network card and additional loop card(s) Optional IOB800 input/output expansion card The panel has a removable steel front door, which incorporates the MX user interface and optional zonal LEDs. The user interface has a 16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys. All mandatory operator controls are provided with LED functions including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2 status indication LEDs are provided for site-specific functions.

Product Codes
557.200.203 557.200.205 557.200.207 557.200.208 557.200.209 557.200.210 557.202.007 557.202.026 557.202.021 557.202.022 557.202.020 557.202.024 557.201.211 MX2-210 Two loop c/w LEDs shallow housing MX2-211 Two loop c/w LEDs deep housing MX2-XB0 Expansion Box Shallow MX2-XB1 Expansion Box Deep MX2-FB Panel/repeater flush mounting bezel MX2-FBX Expansion box flush mounting bezel XLM800 Loop expansion module TLI800 MXNet network node interface module ANN840 LED Annunciator 40 way bi-colour ANN880 LED Annunciator 80 way COM820 Status command module 20 way PRN800 In-built thermal printer (expansion box) Ancillary/expansion board mounting kit 557.202.206 557.202.204 557.202.205 557.202.209 557.202.208 557.202.200 MX battery expansion aperture installation kit. MX2 Battery housing MX2 Battery and Expansion Housing (65AH) MX2 LCD Assembly (Spare) MX2 8 Loop Expansion Kit DCM800 (Display + Control Module)

Chapter 2 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Compact MX Technology Digital Loop LPCB Approved

Minerva MX4000 - IEC 61508 Approved (SIL2)


The MINERVA MX panels are intelligent LPCB EN54 approved panels, which can be networked to provide up to 792 detection loops and installed to BS5839:Pt.1. The MX4000 supports two MX DIGITAL detection loops and can be expanded to eight loops supporting up to 1000 addressable devices. The MX4000 provides up to 240 zones of detection Both panels consist of a strong steel enclosure incorporating a removable chassis plate. The chassis plate holds: PSB800M 5A 24Vdc battery backed power supply and loop booster to EN54:pt.4 FIM800 field interface PCB incorporating one or two MX DIGITAL loops CPU800 32 bit processor and memory card Optional network card and additional loop card(s) Optional IOB800 input/output expansion card The panel has a strong cast aluminium front door, which incorporates a modular user interface that fully complies with EN54:pt.2. The user interface incorporates the ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad, 5 softkeys. The OCM800 operator control module provides all mandatory operator control keys and LED functions including Day/Night switching. Two control keys and 2 indication LEDs are provided for site-specific functions. Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to the default LPCB functionality. The slide in decals can be reversed and alternative text added. A maximum of 1200 digital INPUT/OUTPUT points can be provided via expansion boards connected to the remote bus.

Product Codes
Standard Panels 557.200.003 MX4000 Two to Four Loop Panel Shallow Back Box 557.200.004 MX4000 Two to Eight Loop Panel Deep Back Box 557.200.009 MX4000 Two to Four Loop Panel - Flush Back Box Options 557.202.006 IOB800 (8in/8out) expansion board (Max. 24 I/O on main panel 8in/16out) 557.202.007 XLM-MX two loop MX DIGITAL expansion card 557.202.026 TLI 800 ThornNet & MX-NET network card

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 5

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Compact Low Cost Option Rack Mounting Kit

Battery & Expansion Boxes


The batteries and any additional zone LEDs or operator controls and firemans interface are mounted in a separate housing which can be mounted below the main panel or behind the panel. The matching battery and expansion box is available with shallow (17Ah) or deep backbox (38Ah) according to the batteries used. The chassis plate in the battery box also has space for up to 2 x IOB800 input/output expansion modules (maximum 24 I/O) or 1 x MX FILNET or 1 x PSM/PSB800M.

Product Codes
557.200.005 557.200.019 557.200.006 557.200.016 572.065 MX-BBX 17Ah shallow expansion and battery box MX-BBX-F 17Ah shallow flush expansion and battery box MX-DPBX 38Ah deep expansion and battery box. MX-BATT Deep Battery Box (322H x 442W x 217D mm) MX Rack Mounting Kit for standard 19 racks

Chapter 2 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Fully Functional Flush or Surface Mounting Fully Monitored

Minerva MX Repeaters
The MINERVA MX full function repeater is an EN54 LPCB approved repeater with optional addressable EN54:Pt.4 power supply. The repeater consists of a steel backbox and cast aluminium front door which incorporates the ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys. The OCM800 operator control module provides all mandatory operator control keys and LED functions including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2 indication LEDs are provided for site-specific functions. Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to the default LPCB functionality. The slide in decals can be reversed and alternative text added. Two power supply options are available for repeaters. The MXR incorporates an RSM800 repeater supply module for connection to a 24 Vdc supply. Or the MXR-PSU which incorporates a PSM800 power supply module for connection to a 120-240Vac mains supply and an APM800 addressable power monitor for connection to an MX addressable loop, providing power supply monitoring in accordance with EN54-pt.4. The back box has a removable chassis plate with either the RSM800 or the PSM800 power supply. APM800 addressable PSU monitor and provides space for 2 x 7 Ah batteries to provide 72 h backup. The MINERVA MX repeater is connected to the Panel via the remote bus (RS485, 1200 m distance). A maximum of 7 repeaters (including one MX REMOTE repeater) can be linked to each MINERVA MX panel and can provide full repeater functions for all panels on the system. The operator control module (OCM800) can support up to 80 inputs and outputs in the form of LED annunciators, IOB800 input/output modules, or com 820 command modules.

Product Codes
Standard Repeaters 557.200.012 MXR Repeater with shallow backbox (24Vdc) 557.200.017 MXR-F Repeater with flush backbox (24Vdc) 557.200.013 MXR-PSU Repeater and addressable PSU (120-240 Vac) Options 557.202.006 IOB-800 (8in/8out) expansion board 557.180.005 Mimic driver module 557.180.016 XIOM universal I/O module 557.202.028 RSM800 PSU Module (24Vdc)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 7

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
2 MZX detection loops as standard Expandable to 8 loops using XLM800 Same loop power capability of standard MZX4000 panel/Reduces the cost of network systems Uses MXNet networks (network card supplied separately) Create a system of distributed loops to reduce installation costs Alarm, fault, power and system fault status display Single deep surface mount enclosure Integral power supply and space for 38AH batteries Distributed power supplies reduce cabling costs On board dual sounder circuits/Printer support at each black box Fully featured and supported remote bus at each black box-drive repeaters and mimic displays Download MX Consys configurations from any panel or black box on the network

MZX4000 Black Box


For situations where a networked MX TechnologyTM panel is not required to have a user interface an MZX4000 black box panel can be used. Black box panels consist of steel back boxes which house the FIM, processor board, power supply and optional network card and expansion loop card. The front cover is of steel construction and has a simple status display panel giving LED indication of alarm, fault, power and system fault. MZX4000 black box panels are fully featured MZX TechnologyTM panels designed to be used on networked systems in situations where a local user interface is not required.

Technical Specification
Dimensions (mm): Aprox weight: Colour, housing & front cover: Operating Temp: Storage Temp: Relative Humidity: Supply voltage: Input current: 640H X 440W X 230D 16Kg Dawn Grey (BS 4800 10A) Range -8C to +55C -20C to +70C 95% non condensing 120 to 240 Vac 0.8 to 2.2A

Product Code
542.098 MZX4000 Black Box

Chapter 2 Page 8

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
PSB800M 5A 24V DC battery backed power supply and loop booster to EN54pt4 FIM800 field interface PCB incorporating one or two MX DIGITAL loops CPU800 32 bit processor and memory card Optional network card and additional loop card(s) (T2000 only) VDR (Voyage Data Recorder) Interface as standard

Minerva T2000 and T2000 CV Marine Detection Panels IEC 61508 Approved (SIL2)
The T2000 is a fully Marine approved EN54 compliant 1 to 8 loop networkable detection panel. The T2000 supports two Tyco MX DIGITAL detection loops and can be expanded to eight loops supporting up to 1000 addressable devices. The T2000 consists of a strong stainless steel or mild steel Marine approved enclosure incorporating the above features. The T2000CV is a 3 loop marine approved panel housed in a mild steel enclosure designed for use in commercial vessels. All panels have a strong cast aluminium front door, which incorporates a modular user interface that fully complies with EN54 pt2. The user interface incorporates the ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys. The OCM800 operator control module provides all mandatory operator control keys and LED functions including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2 indication LEDs are provided for vessel specific functions. Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to the default Marine functionality. The slide in decals can be reversed and alternative text added. The batteries and any additional zonal LEDs or operator controls are mounted in a separate housing which can be mounted below the main panel or behind the panel. The battery box incorporates a heavy duty backbox and battery clamp. The chassis plate in the battery box also has space for up to 2 x IOB800 input/output expansion modules (maximum 24 I/O) or 1 x PSM/PSB800M.

Product Codes
557.200.600 557.200.602 557.200.605 557.200.606 557.200.610 557.201.216 557.200.620 557.202.127 557.202.128 557.180.454 557.180.452 557.180.022 557.201.233 557.201.234 T2000 Two To Eight Loop Marine Panel (Stainless steel enclosure) T2000B Battery Box (Stainless steel enclosure) T2000 BM Battery Box (Mild steel enclosure) T2000 RMRS Door Stay Kit T2000 Standard Two to Eight Loop Marine Panel (Mild steel enclosure) T2000 XLM 8-Loop Mounting Kit T2000CV 3 loop marine panel (mild steel back box) VDR Cable For a Standalone panel, Com port 3 VDR Cable for a networked system, Com port 1 Marine Bulkhead Mount Marine 19 rack mount kit for use with surface mounting housings Terminal chamber PCB assembly PSU 830 T2000/T2000R Conversion Kit PSU 830 T2000 120VAC Kit

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 9

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Fully Functional Optional Approved Mild Steel Enclosure Fully Monitored R-Bus

Minerva T2000R and T2000R CV Marine Repeaters


The T2000R full function repeater is an EN54 Marine approved repeater with optional addressable EN54:Pt.4 power supply. The repeater consists of a steel backbox and cast aluminium front door which incorporates the ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys. The OCM800 operator control module provides all mandatory operator control keys and LED functions including Day/Night switching. One control key and 2 indication LEDs are provided for vessel-specific functions. Control keys and LEDs are labelled in English according to the default Marine functionality. The slide in decals can be reversed and alternative text added The back box has a removable chassis plate with the PSM800M power supply and APM800 addressable PSU monitor and space for 2 x 7 Ah batteries to provide 72h backup. The T2000R CV indicating repeater is an EN54 Marine approved repeater (24Vdc Supply). The repeater consists of a mild steel backbox and cast aluminium front door which incorporates the ODM800 operator display module with a 16 x 40-character backlit LCD display, simple alphanumeric keypad and 5 softkeys.Operator controls comprise a panel buzzer silence button , status LEDs are provided for fire, fault and power on indication. Both repeaters are connected to the Panel via the remote bus (RS485, 1200 m distance). A maximum of 7 repeaters (including one MX REMOTE repeater) can be linked to each control panel and can provide repeater functions for all panels on the system. The repeater can support up to 80 inputs and outputs in the form of LED annunciators, IOB800 input/output modules, XIOM universal I/O modules or the 80 LED mimic module.

Product Codes
557.200.601 557.200.604 557.200.606 557.200.611 557.200.612 557.200.621 557.201.233 557.201.234 T2000R Marine Repeater with Power Supply Unit 240Vac (Stainless steel enclosure) T2000R Marine Repeater without Power Supply Unit 24Vdc (Stainless steel enclosure) T2000 RMRS Door Stay Kit T2000R Standard Marine Repeater with Power Supply Unit 240Vac (Mild steel enclosure) T2000R Standard Marine Repeater without Power Supply Unit 24Vdc (Mild steel enclosure) T2000R CV Marine Indicating Repeater without Power supply unit 24Vdc (Mild Steel enclosure) PSU 830 T2000/T2000R Conversion Kit PSU 830 T2000 120VAC Kit

Chapter 2 Page 10

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


MX Detection Panels - Technical Specifications & System Schematics
MX Detection Panels - Designer Housing Technical Specification
Shallow Housing 320Hx440Wx120D 7Kg -20oC to +70oC -8oC to +55oC Flush Shallow Housing Deep Housing 380Hx500Wx120D 320Hx440Wx215D 7.2Kg 8Kg -20oC to +70oC -20oC to +70oC o o -8 C to +55 C -8oC to +55oC up to 95% RH, Non-Condensing Dawn Grey (BS 4800 10A - 03) Pantone 431C EN 50130-4 EN 54-2 EN 54-2 Marine 320Hx440Wx135D 14Kg -20oC to +70oC -8oC to +55oC

Dimensions (mm) Approx Weight Temperature (Storage) Temperature (Operating) Humidity Colour (Housing) Colour (Modules) EMC/RFI Shock Vibration

MX2 Detection Panels Technical Specification


Panel Shallow Housing Dimensions (MM) Approx Weight Temperate (storage) Temperate (operating) Humidity Colour (Housing) Colour (Modules) EMC/RFI IP Rating 580H x 458W x 129D 12.7kg Panel Deep Housing 580H x 458W x 209D 15.2kg Expansion Housing Shallow 357Hx 458W x 129D Expansion Housing Deep 357H x 458W x 209D 7.5kg

6.2kg -20 C to + 70C -5C to +55 C Up to 90 % RH Non Condensing Dawn Grey (BS4800 10A-03) Pantone 431C EN50130-4 EN61000-6-3 IP30

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 11

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


DESIGNER HOUSING SCHEMATIC
24Vdc Non-Resettable 24Vdc Resettable Field I/O Network PC/Modem Printer

CPU PSB FIM Loop C XLM 110-240Va.c. Loop A Loop D Loop B TLI RBus

ODM

FRONT DOOR

OCM

MAIN PANEL HOUSING

XBus

TUD/ IOB

IOB

PSB/PSM MX FILNET

ANN880 ANN840 or COM820 FRONT DOOR

17 or 38Ah

17 or 38Ah

MPM

ANN880 ANN840 or COM820

BATTERY & EXPANSION HOUSING

Remote bus up to 15 addresses a combination of up to 7 x OCM and 15 x MPM Maximum

MX2 Schematic
NETWORK FIELD I/O 110-240 Vac

RBUS TLI XLM


CPU

LOOP A LOOP B LOOP C LOOP D

DCM PSB

FIM

PRINTER

NETWORK

PC MODEM

24Vdc

ANN881

17AH OR 38AH

17AH OR 38AH

MAIN PANEL HOUSING Chapter 2 Page 12 Fire Catalogue

FRONT DOOR 02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology MX Panel Components


Features
Full alarm and fault monitoring for up to 1000 addressable points including central loop processing of MX Fastlogic expert algorithms Concurrent operation of the main user interface and 2 remote user interfaces including one remote dial up or networked user interface Cause and core effect using up to 1000 input, output groups, delay timers and logic functions

CPU Central Processor


The CPU-800 provides the main processing power behind the MX detection panels. It is a multi-layer PCB and contains the CPU, the memory and interface electronics. The CPU-800 plugs into the Field Interface Module (FIM800). The CPU-800 contains a Data Memory (SRAM), a Program Memory (Flash EPROM), a Configuration Memory (Flash EPROM) and a Boot ROM (EPROM). The use of flash EPROM allows program upgrades without the need for changing chips.

Technical Specification
32 bit Processor: Data Memory SRAM: Prog. Memory Flash EPROM: Config. Memory Flash EPROM: Boot EPROM: Number of serial Interfaces: Quiescent Current: Alarm Current: Motorola 68331 1 MByte 2 MByte 1 Mbyte 64 kByte 4 67mA 67mA

Product Code
557.202.002 CPU800 standard MX central processor

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 13

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
MX Digital Loop Protocol Extensive Loop Protection Interfaced to FIM 800 module

MX Loop Expansion Module


The XLM800 Loop Expansion Module fits piggyback style onto the FIM or an existing XLM 800 and is used to: Expand the capability of the MX4000 C.I.E. two l loop system to eight loops Replace the FIM loops in case of a failure on either a two or four loop system. The XLM800 Loop Expansion Module controls the communications between the detectors (and other ancillaries) connected on the 2-wire loop circuits and the controller. In addition, the addressable interface contains line isolation circuits which protect the loop driver circuit from short-circuit conditions.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Battery Requirements: 17.5H x 104W x 196Dmm Standby 104.3mA+loop current Alarm105.3mA + loop current Loop Current 495mA maximum

Product Code
557.202.007 XLM-MX Two Loop MX Digital Expansion Card

Chapter 2 Page 14

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Interfaces to CPU & XLM modules 3 Download/Network & Printer ports Up to 2 MX Loops

FIM800 Field Interface Module


The Field Interface Module FIM is the main interface for field wiring on MX detection panels and contains plug-in field wiring terminals, inter board connectors, EMC protectors and filters and general I/O electronics. The FIM801and FIM801CV provides 1 x MX DIGITAL loop and the FIM802 provides 2 x MX DIGITAL loops. Each MX DIGITAL loop can support several kilometres of loop wiring using a mixed topology using multiple loops and spurs. The FIM provides up to 495mA of loop power to each loop to drive loop powered sounders and other loop power devices. An optional plug-in additional loop cards(XLM800MX) provide up to 8 x MX Digital loops. The FIM incorporates the following local I/O connections: 2 x reverse polarity monitored sounder outputs 2 x volt free outputs (Default alarm and fault) 1 monitored input (eg. Day/Night changeover) 1 emergency alarm input 1 unmonitored input (eg. Class Change or Tamper) Full monitoring of power supply Ground fault monitoring The FIM incorporates a local I/O bus which allows the local I/O connections to be increased by 24. A variety of I/O expansion boards are available including: IOB800 (8 in/8 out) expansion board TUD800 German Transmission Unit The FIM includes two connections to the RBUS one for the local user interface and one for connecting up to 15 remote addresses in the form of up to 2 x operator control modules (OCM800) or up to 15 multi-purpose modules (MPM800). The FIM provides 3 configurable external serial ports : Port 1 Local printer Port 2 Configuration PC or remote diagnostics and upload/download modem Port 3 FSI open protocol or Network card/gateway (TLI-800 or MX-FIL) (not provided on FIM 800CV)

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Power Consumption: 25H x 105W x 196D mm 156g 119mA (Quiescent excluding loops and operator interface) 169mA (Alarm) 30Vdc @ 2A 10k Ohm EOL, 3KHz in parallel RS-485 , default 19.6kB, up to 1200m RS232C, 19.6kB, up to 10m Up to 2 modules, up to 24 I/O, max. 300mm

Product Codes
557.202.000 557.202.001 557.202.008 557.180.053 FIM801 field interface module with one MX loop driver FIM802 field interface module with two MX loop drivers FIM801CV for Marine T2000 CV MX RBUS Driver chip (spare)

Relay Outputs: Monitored inputs: RBUS: Serial Ports: Local I/O Expansion:

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 15

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Universal Input Voltage Temperature Compensated Full Fault Monitoring Can drive 4 fully loaded MX digital loops When used with second PSU830 and MX2 8 loop expansion kit can power 8 fully loaded MX digital loops Same footprint and fixings as the PSB821 Replaces PSB820 and PSM820 Meets the requirements of EN54 part 4 amendment 2

PSU830 Power Supply


The MX PSU830 power supply module is a state-of-the-art integrated switch mode system power supply and battery charger, which can provide up to 5A external and auxiliary loop power during alarm conditions. The charging voltage is temperature compensated. The power supply recharges the batteries within 24hr for the following timings: 90hr stand by time and 15 minute alarm condition. 72hr stand by time and 30 minute alarm condition. The power supply provides full condition and fault monitoring to the system via the FIM or addressable power supply monitor module APM800. The PSU830 incorporates a booster module to provide the correct voltage levels to maximise the performance of the MX DIGITAL protocol. Fault signals (Loss of AC, Battery charger fault, Battery fault and earth fault) are provided. Battery voltage readings are also provided to the FIM and a volt free fault o/p is also provided. Screw terminals provide 2 x 27V outputs (one with reset control) and one 5V output. The power supply is fitted in a steel cage with mounting points to allow any of the following boards to be mounted: APM800 addressable power supply monitor module. FB800 fuse board with 15 x 24Vdc fused spurs. IOB800 input/output expansion board. PTM800 power terminal module. The MX2 PSU830 Dual PSU Kit is required to power the XLM800 pcb on 6 to 8 loop systems which require the extended loop power capability. It consists of the necessary cables & connectors to enable an additional PSU830 to be fitted to an MX2 controller.

Technical Specification
Dimensions (HWD): 62 x 132 x 242mm Electrical Characteristics: Input Voltage: 120-240Vac -15% /+10% 50/60Hz (auto ranging) Input Current Rated Load: RMS 0.8-2.2A Output Voltages 27.3Vdc @ +25C Non-reset: 27.3Vdc @ 2A 5Vdc @ 2.2A 40Vdc @ 2.2A Reset: 27.3Vdc @ 2A Rated Output Maximum Alarm current 5A for 30 minutes Maximum continuous load current (excluding charging): 2.5A Battery Requirements 17Ah or 38Ah single PSU 65Ah dual PSU Standby Current Consumption: 90mA @ 24Vdc Battery Fault High Resistance: Single PSU: 0.6 Ohms Dual PSU: 0.3 Ohms

Product Codes
557.202.210 557.201.232 557.201.231 557.202.044 557.202.030 557.202.031 557.200.014 557.200.015 PSU830 Power Supply Module PTM800 Power Terminal Module MX2 PSU830 Dual PSU Kit PSU 830K Power Expansion Kit PSU 830 Panel Fixing Conversion Kit PSU 830 Small Chassis Plate Conversion Kit MXAPSU17 Boxed Addressable PSU (17A/H) MXAPSU38 Boxed Addressable PSU (38A/H)

Chapter 2 Page 16

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Changeable Legends Fully programmable Optional I/O via R-Bus

OCM800 Operator Control Module


The OCM800 is utilised by all MX detection panels and full function repeaters to provide mandatory operator control and LED indication functions to comply with EN54:pt.2. The OCM800 is fully programmable but operates in default configurations according to the software template used. Most software templates allow several of the LEDs and control buttons to be programmed for site-specific functions. The LEDs and control buttons both have slide in legends to suit the default configurations and language. Standard panels include the appropriate legends for their relevant markets. The OCM800 incorporates the functionality of an MPM800, which allows it to drive an operator display module to provide a complete panel user interface. In addition the OCM800 can drive up to 80 inputs/outputs using one of the following modules. The following I/O and LED annunciator modules can be slaved from an MPM800: Up to 5 x IOB800 (8 in/8 out LPCB/VdS approved . expansion board) Up to 5 x XIOM (16 way universal I/O board) One Mimic Panel (80 way LED mimic driver PCB) One 80 way ANN880 LED mimic One 40 way ANN840 LED mimic using red & yellow LEDs Two 20 way COM820 LED status/command modules Up to 2 x OCM800 units can be connected to an MX panel via the internal or external RBus communication port.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Power Consumption: 50H x 232W x 133D mm 0.272Kg 35mA (Quiescent) 36mA (Lamp test) 81mA (Alarm) 7 18 RS-485: RBus Default 9.2Kb MX X-Bus UK/English, Marine

Product Code
557.202.013 OCM800 with Minerva MX Inserts

Control Buttons: Indication LEDs: Communications: Expansion Bus: Legends for LPCB modules:

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 17

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
0-9 alpha-numeric phone style keypad Up and down scroll keys Five function keys

ODM800 Operator Display Module


The ODM800 operator display module provides a powerful and flexible 40 x 16 character backlit LCD display used by all MX detection panels and full function repeaters. The ODM800 is used with the OCM800 to provide a fully compliant and approved user interface EN54 fire detection panels. The ODM800 is powered and controlled by the OCM800 operator control module and provides various functions according to the panel software. Standard EN54 panels use the LCD display as five windows on the system. Window 1-Details of first detector in alarm Window 2-Details of the most recent detector in alarm Window 3-System Status including Alarm/Fault and Isolate counters Window 4-Full alarm/event details and lists including 95 character procedure plus full password controlled system manager, service and engineering menu structure Window 5-Function key legends (eg. Back, Enter, >>,<<)

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Power Consumption: 25H x 232W x 133D mm 0.361Kg 50mA (Quiescent) 900mA (Alarm Backlit) 50mA (Alarm during mains failure)

Product Code
557.202.019 ODM800 operator display module

OCM800 to IOB800 Connection Details


OCM800 TO IOB800 CONNECTION DETAILS

Chapter 2 Page 18

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


ANN840 LED Annunciator
The ANN840 is a standard LED annunciator user interface module which can be driven from an OCM800 or an MPM800. The MPM800 can be mounted remotely or piggy-backed on the ANN840. The ANN840 has removable legends for 40 zone status indicators. Each zone can indicate RED (eg. Alarm) and YELLOW (eg. Fault & Isolate). The functionality is programmed in the MX detection panel. The ANN840 operates as 80 outputs (RED & YELLOW). Technical Specification Dimensions: 25H x 232W x 133D mm 177g Weight: Power Consumption: 1mA + MPM800 (Quiescent) 85mA + MPM800 (25% zones in alarm (Alarm)) 340mA +MPM800 (Lamp test) Product Code 557.202.021 ANN840 LED annunciator

ANN880 LED Annunciator


The ANN880 is a standard LED annunciator user interface module, which can be driven from an OCM800 or an MPM800. The MPM800 can be mounted remotely or piggy-backed on the ANN880. The ANN880 has 80 red LEDs numbered 1 to 80. The functionality is programmed in the MX detection panel but is defaulted to zone alarm LEDs. Technical Specification Dimensions: 25H x 232W x 133D mm Weight: 177g Power Consumption: 1mA + MPM800 (Quiescent) 85mA +MPM800 (25% zones in alarm (Alarm)) 340mA + MPM800 (Lamp test) Product Code 557.202.022 ANN880 LED annunciator

COM820 Status Command Module - 20 Way


The COM820 is a standard user interface module, which can be driven from an OCM800 or an MPM800. The MPM800 can be mounted remotely or piggybacked on the COM820. The COM820 has removable legends for 20 status command functions. Each function includes a command button and a yellow status LED. The functionality is programmed in the MX detection panel. Typical applications include: . Manual/OFF/Auto/Isolate functions for evacuation or plant control . Selective isolate and evacuate functions for firemans control . Selective plant shutdown and override functions . Selective system delay and timer functions 2 can be driven from 1 x MPM800. Technical Specification Dimensions: 25H x 232W x 133D mm Weight: 204g Power Consumption: 0.267mA (Quiescent - No LEDs) 5mA (Alarm - 25% LEDs) 21mA (Lamp test) Product Code 557.202.020 COM820 Status/Command Module

Remote Mimics
The 80-Way Mimic allows custommade display and presentation panels to be incorporated in the MINERVA MX addressable system. It is supplied as a single PCB, which may be mounted in an expansion box or on the rear of a free-standing panel, as required. It may be used to drive up to 80 zonal LED indicators, arranged in any configuration, together with two FIRE LEDs, one FAULT LED and one ISOLATE LED. These indicators can operate in the same manner as the corresponding indicators on the panel. A remote Mimic can be connected to the MPM800s configured as remote Mimic drivers via the remote bus. Up to 15 MPM800s may be connected on to the remote bus, each with a unique address [set onboard]. The Mimic includes audible and visible warning facilities. Technical Specification Dimensions: 235H x 190Wmm -10C to +55C Operating Temp: Storage Temp: -20C to +65C Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH NonCondensing Power Consumption: 11mA (Quiescent) 200mA (25% Alarm) 800mA (Lamp Test) Product Code 557.180.005 MINERVA 80 way mimic driver module

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 19

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Drives up to 80 I/O points Direct Interface to Zonal Displays and other Modules Interfaces to FIM Board

MPM800 Multi Purpose Interface Module


The MPM800 is used to provide various expansion capabilities via the remote bus (RBUS). The MPM800 is provided as a standalone module but is also incorporated into the circuitry of the OCM800 operator control module to drive the LCD display, LEDs, keyswitch and keys on the OCM800 and the operator display module. The OCM800 and MPM800 have an XBUS which can be used to drive up to 80 I/O. The MPM800 also has a printer interface for connecting to a serial or parallel printer. An additional printer driver kit is required to allow the MPM800 to drive a printer - a serial isolation module should be used to eliminate earth fault indications caused by some mains connected printers. Up to 15 x MPM modules can be connected to each panel of which 8 can be in the form of OCM800 (including the main OCM800 user interface). One OCM800 can also be in the form of an emulated user interface on a remote PC connected via the network or dial up modem. The following I/O and LED annunciator modules can be slaved from an MPM800: Up to 5 x IOB800 (8 in/8 out expansion board) Up to 5 x XIOM800 (16 way universal I/O board) One Mimic Panel (80 way LED mimic driver PCB) One 80 way ANN880 LED mimic** One 40 way ANN840 LED mimic using red & yellow LEDs** Two 20 way COM820 LED status/command modules** The MPM800 is mounted by plugging directly onto the back of those items marked **

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Power Supply: Communications: Printer Connection: 25.4H x 92W x 167.64D mm 98g 24Vdc (from PSB or PSM800) RS-485, up to 19.6kB Serial or Parallel

Product Codes
557.202.012 557.202.117 557.180.052 557.180.053 MPM800 multi-purpose interface modules Serial printer cable for MPM800 or FIM800 Serial Printer Driver Kit Isolated RS485 IC (for U16)

Chapter 2 Page 20

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


XIOM Input/Output Expansion Board
The XIOM is a 16 universal input/output expansion board. The I/O on the XIOM can be set in banks of 8 to operate as follows: LED driver outputs (10mA source) Relay Driver Outputs (100mA sink) Voltage Monitor Input (8 - 30Vdc Normal) Volt Free Contact inputs Features 16 I/Ps or 16 O/Ps or 8 I/P + 8 O/P 5 per MPM800 (80 I/O points) Fully configurable in MX consys Technical Specification Dimensions: 144H x 85W x 15D mm Product Code 557.180.016 XIOM MINERVA Input/Output Expansion Module (16 Way)

FB800 Fuse Board


The FB800 fuse board provides terminations for 15 fused 24Vdc output spurs from a single 24V d.c. input. The FB800 is designed to be normally mounted on the PSB800M or PSM800 power supply. The fuses are rated at 500mA. Technical Specification Dimensions: 93H x165W x 80D mm 149g Weight: Input: 24Vdc Output: 15 x 24V d.c / 500mA Terminations: 2.5mm Product Code 557.202.100 FB800 fuse board (15 way)

IOB Input/Output Expansion Board


The IOB800 is an LPCB approved board that provides 8 opto-isolated digital inputs and 8 x 24V d.c. relay outputs for providing I/O expansion capabilities to MX detection panels for interfacing to other subsystems and signalling devices. The IOB800 also incorporates a connector, which provides decoded signals for the 8 inputs and 8 outputs for specialist interfacing. The IOB800 can be used to provide expansion I/O to the following MX panel components: . FIM801/802 field interface modules (maximum 24 I/O 8IN/16OUT) . OCM800 operator control modules (maximum 80 I/O) . MPM800 multi-purpose interface (maximum 80 I/O) The IOB800 can be mounted in the top of a battery box or repeater. The IOB800 has two expansion bus connectors which allow them to be daisy chained together. Technical Specification Dimensions: 15H X 164W X 80D mm 153g Weight: Terminations: 1.5mm Product Code 557.202.006 IOB800 Expansion Board and cables

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 21

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
High level interface to building automation systems Meet interfacing requirements for large integrated projects Displayed on BACnet Client side: Zone alarms, point alarms from fire inputs MZX panel faults, faults from zones and points Mains fault, System faults Pre-alarms and alarm warnings Isolation of zones, loops & points Day/Night Mode status Analogue values of automatic detectors Supported commands issued from the BACnet Client side: Silence, Resound Sounders On and Off Evacuate Fire Reset Isolation of zones and points

MZX BACnet Interface


BACnet can be provided from a stand-alone MZX Technology panel or from an MZX or FILnet network via the MZX BACnet converter. The MZX BACnet converter is a mini RISC-based embedded computer which converts fire data to the BACnet communications protocol. The converter needs special firmware that is simply uploaded from a PC.

Technical Specification
Mechanical Weight: Dimensions: Mounting: Operating Temperature: Operating Humidity: Storage Temperature: Electrical Input Voltage: 130 g 67 x 22 x 100.4 mm DIN-Rail, wall -10 to 60C 5 to 95% RH -20 to 80C 12 to 48 VDC

Product Code
557.202.135 BACnet Converter for MZX

Chapter 2 Page 22

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
A cost effective digital communication platform to enable a range of remote services Robust dual path transmission over the clients IT network and the GPRS network, ensures continuity of communication in the event of a failure Regular polling of the IP path and the GPRS path confirms successful end to end communication - a failure will be reported within 3 minutes Secure communication is ensured by AES encryption with a 128 bit key and 256 bit hash code BRE approved to EN 54-21 for fire alarm transmission and fault warning routing equipment and LPCB Red Book listed Supplied with an activated 02 SIM card All access is securely controlled and logged

RS800-IP/GPRS - IP Communication Module


The RS800-IP/GPRS module connects to an individual or a network of MZX, MX, ZX, MX2 and T2000 fire control panels to provide a cost effective, secure and robust IP (Internet Protocol) based communication platform for alarm signalling, fault reporting and a range of remote services. The RS800-IP/GPRS module connects to the communication ports and relays of a fire control panel and converts the RS232 and digital data into IP data that can be transmitted over the internet. Communication is dual path. The primary path is the clients IP network, eliminating the additional cost of a traditional PSTN telephone line. Efficient, digital communication puts negligible demand on the network and ensures future compatibility as the traditional analogue systems are progressively phased out. The GPRS mobile communication network is the secondary path and maintains communication in the event of a failure of the primary path.

Technical Specfication
RS800-IP/GPRS Type: Dual Path Ethernet / GPRS EN 5421 Alarm Transmission and Fault Routing Equipment Fire Alarms and Fault Warning Type 1 - Dual Path LPS 1277 Fire Type 1 Transmission protocol: UDP/IP Encryption: AES standard with a 128-bit key and 256 bit hash code Data bandwidth: 160 bytes (round trip including alarm and acknowledgement) Approvals: BRE 0832-CPD-1565: EN 54-21: 2006 LPCB Red Book to LPS1277 Power Supply: From the connected panel's EN 544 power supply Power Consumption: 100 mA / 24 VDC Dimensions: 160 x 95 x 40 mm Weight: 0.2 kg Housing: To be mounted in an IP30 / Access Level 2 metal enclosure, close coupled to MZX panel.

Product Codes
557.202.090 RS800 WebWay IP/ GPRS For alarm signalling, fault reporting and remote IP services. Includes cables, SIM and first year's service RS800 WebWay IP For remote IP services only. No GPRS SIM included. Includes cables and first year's service Enclosure for RS-800 WebWay Smart Disc Eng Pack High performance antenna with roaming SIM WebWay High Gain Eng Pack High gain extension antenna with roaming SIM and 10m cable WebWay High Gain Eng Pack High gain extension antenna with roaming SIM and 15m cable

557.202.091

557.202.093 22-5054

22-5049-10M

22-5049-15M

Enclosure for RS-800 Dimensions: Weight: Material: Finish: Ingress Protection: Access Level:

237 x 161 x 58 mm 1 Kg 1.2 mm Mild Steel RAL 7035 Semi Textured IP30 2

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 23

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Desktop Printer
The printer is designed as a low cost business printer ideally suited for mounting adjacent to the fire control panel.The LQ-300+ combines high performance with paper handling flexibility and quiet operation. Features 300 cps draft/ 90cps LQ. Quiet operation Lightweight and compact design 9 LQ fonts 2 paper feed paths Convertible push/pull tractor Paper guide Auto loading Paper park Cable feed recess Epson LQ standard terminal emulation available Parallel and serial interface Technical Specification Dimensions: 159H x 366W x 275D mm 4.4kg Weight: Operating Voltage: 180V to 264Va.c. Product Codes 557.180.239 MINERVA printer LQ-300+ 557.180.220 LQ 300+ Printer Ribbon (spare) 557.202.117 MX FIM/MPM to serial printer lead

In-Built Printer
The PRN800 Printer Kit is designed for use with the designer range of MX Controllers (MX4000 and T2000). It is fitted to the front cover of the MX battery housing and is powered from the PSB 800 power supply via an FB800 fuseboard in the MX Controller housing. Features A thermal printer mechanism which ensures high reliability. Quiet Operation Lightweight and Compact Design High Speed Printing: 40mm per second. High quality printing: 384 dots. 40 Columns Friction paper feed Technical Specification Dimensions: 230H x 137W x 85D mm Weight: 0.38Kg Operating Temp: +5C to +45C Storage Temp: -20C to +70C Relative Humidity: Up to 80% noncondensing EMC: 61000-6-3 for emissions BS EN 50082-1 for immunity Product Codes 557.202.024 PRN 800 Printer c/w front cover module 557.301.014 Spare Paper Roll (pk of 5)

Remote LCD Display


The Remote LCD Repeater Module is designed to provide an independent scrolling log of system status at numerous points within a building or site. The module interfaces directly to a serial printer port of the MX addressable fire panel. If a local printer is already connected to the Panels MPM800 serial port, a second MPM800 must be used. Features Uses a backlit 4x20 character alphanumeric display. Provides an internal log of up to 330 events. Provides internal audible warning of an event. Allows the event log to be scrolled. Local internal buzzer silence. Connects to host panels RS232 port (maximum cable length between panels and first repeater of 15m). Provides an external sounder to mimic the internal buzzer. Can be connected to an unlimited number of other LCD Repeaters by using the RS232/RS422 converter (Up to 1200m between repeaters). The LCD repeater must not be used in the primary fire path. It must not be used as the sole warning that a fire exists. Technical Specification Dimensions: 150H x 200W x 75D mm Bayblend Material: polycarbonate/ABS alloy Operating Temp: -10 C to +55 C Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH Non-Condensing Power Supply: 200mA @24Vdc Ext. Sounder Relay: 500mA@24Vdc EMC: Product Family Standard EN50130-4 in respect of Conducted Disturbances, Radiated Immunity, Electrostatic Discharge, Fast Transients and Slow High Energy. EN61000-6-3 -1 for Emissions. Product Codes 557.200.030 Remote LCD Repeater MKII (compatible with Version 4.1 and above for UK/UL/Marine/Western European Countries) 557.202.128 MX FIM com1 to RS422 Lead 557.180.151 RS232/422 converter for LCD Repeaters.

Chapter 2 Page 24

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology DDA Compliant Pager


Features
UHF radio link for maximum licensable protection Unique coding avoids neighbouring system clashes Self monitoring of system health Rugged steel enclosure to IP65 Backlit 2 line text display continuously reports system status Additional audible & visible status indicators Prioritised Fire Alarm Inputs Automated test calls alert pagers to loss of radio signal Fault Notification to the lost fire panel via a monitored link Key operated "System Test" facility for routine confidence checking Over 90 hour's backup operation with internal battery Achieves Disability Discrimination Act (DDA) compliance

Fire Tek Pro Paging System


The FireTek Pro paging system is designed for use with professional Fire Systems installed in commercial, industrial and educational premises. The system is primarily designed to alert the "hearing impaired" in the event of a fire or other emergency where an audible sounder is the normal means of indication. The FireTek Pro has been designed to comply with the recommendations detailed in BS5839-1: 2002 for alerting the "hearing impaired" to the activation of a fire alarm system. The system can also be used in conjunction with a security panel to alert guards who might be located remotely from the main premises. The interface to the fire panel comprises of three Prioritised Fire Inputs and two Fault Inputs. For ease of installation, a monitored cable assembly is provided with each system which includes a "common fault" relay output back to the host fire panel. This output will activate if the FireTek Pro suffers a mains failure, transmitter fault, antenna mismatch, interface link failure, or low battery state. Upon activation of any one of the Fire Inputs, the FireTek Pro will enter the fire alert condition, prioritising and transmitting the Fire message to all enrolled pagers. The transmissions will be repeated until the fire condition is reset. The FireTek Pro Pagers ensure that users are alerted by distinct vibration patterns and clear text messages. UHF Radio Operation Any alerting system is only as good as its weakest link. The FireTek Pro utilises UHF radio frequencies, the main benefits being superior in-building radio signal propagation and the option of a manual frequency co-ordinate license issued by OFCOM. Licensing the FireTek Pro provides a higher degree of protection from interference. This fact is acknowledged in Section 18.1 of BS 5839-1:2002. High Integrity Pagers To complete the system the alphanumeric pagers have added features specifically incorporated for the "hard of hearing" when used with the FireTek Pro. These features include distinct vibrate alerts for emergency messages, a vibrating out of range indicator which displays "No Service" on the pager when the radio link is lost, and a vibrating low battery indicator. Antenna Options Mini Dipole Antenna - remote internally mounted antenna for large sites or areas of difficult signal propagation. Folded Dipole Antenna - remote externally mounted antenna for maximum signal coverage e.g. campuses and multibuilding sites.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 25

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Technical Specification
Supply Voltage: Operational Current: Inputs: 230V AC 50-60 Hz 12v 7Ah standby battery 250mA 3 Prioritised Volt Free (Fire) Input 1 - Fire Alarm - Evacuate Building Input 2 - There is an Incident Leave Building Input 3 - Prepare to Evacuate Await Instructions 2 Volt Free (Fault) 1 off volt free relay output Mains Failure Transmitter Fault Antenna Mismatch Panel Link Failure Low/Missing Battery 2 Line Backlit LCD Steel Enclosure rated to IP65 380 x 320 x 110 mm (H x W x D) (No antenna fitted)

Product Codes
557.200.071 557.200.074 557.200.076 557.200.077 557.200.078 557.200.079 557.200.080 Paging Transmitter 40 Character Alpha Numeric Pager 1/2 wave dipole antenna Wall mounting folded dipole antenna Pole mounting folded dipole antenna 5 metre antenna feeder cable 10 metre antenna feeder cable

Outputs: Fault Notification:

Visual Display: Enclosure: Dimensions:

Chapter 2 Page 26

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
The pagers: Display messages sent out by the MX as displayed on the MX LCD Internal log of up to 40 events Audible and/or vibrate warning of event Allows the event log to be displayed The transmitter: Connects using a 9 way D type MX interface lead to MX printer port

Pager Interface
The MX pager system is designed to provide a facility to signal all text messages or alarm/fault messages from a local transmitter to the pagers. The transmitter connects to the serial printer port on the FIM800 or if already in use to a MPM800. The pager system requires a +12V d.c. connection from a remote psu. If the transmitter needs to be located further than 2 m from the MX Panel, then a non-standard serial printer cable may be used, up to a maximum distance of 14m. The Type A alarm pager displays alarm/fault messages. The Type A maintenance pager displays all messages sent by the fire controller. CAUTION: Before any installation is carried out, an on site radio paging license must be obtained by the customer. Care should be taken when designing pager systems. Normal practice indicates that a site survey should be done. Contact Product Management for additional advice on site surveys.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: System operating voltage: Effective radiated power: Frequency range: Channel spacing: TX baud rate: Type approval Manual - Vol17A-2-Pager 328H x 190W x 75D mm 12 to 13.8Vdc 500mW Max 450-470 MHZ 25KHz 512 or 1200 ETS 300 224,EC type approved to ETS 300 682

Product Codes
557.200.029 577.002.002 577.002.003 577.002.007 577.002.008 G13801N-A Pager Transmitter Type A alarm pager Type A maintenance pager Pager aerial 60 db gain up to 1km (c/w mounting bracket) Optional feeder cable (10m long) Elmdene 12V 1A PSU in Housing

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 27

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Generation 6 Fire Detectors


Features
Advanced multi-sensor designs Choice of heat, optical, optical and heat multi-sensor or 3oTec triple multi-sensor FASTLOGIC expert algorithms Up to 250 detectors per loop Built-in line isolator on 850 series Advanced commissioning features using the 850EMT Engineering Management Tool Two way infra-red communication to the 850EMT Engineering Management Tool Protective optical chamber screen Robust coated electronics Extended service life Fire, isolate and fault LED indications

850 and 830 Series Fire Detectors - Generation 6


The 850 and 830 series of fire detectors are designed to be both adaptable and flexible which means they can be used in most premises to protect against a wide range of potential fire risks. They use sophisticated digital signalling to communicate with the MZX Technology fire control panel, sending fire data from each sensing element for analysis. Because all of the sensed data is sent to the controller, powerful algorithms can be used to determine whether a fire condition is real or not. The sensitivity, mode and degree of verification can be altered by the user in response to environmental or activity changes. A built-in line isolator incorporated into the 850 series devices means that when a single short circuit fault occurs on a loop, all the detectors will continue to operate. An on-board amber LED will give a local indication that the line isolator has operated. The 830 series detectors can be used with an isolator base to provide protection against short circuit faults. Two way infrared communications allows the detector to work with the 850EMT Engineering Management Tool to speed up commissioning and service routines and to provide status / reports data without the need to physically access the device. Extended drift compensation reduces the lifetime cost of ownership by typically doubling the service life of the detector whilst a new insect screen and surface coating of electronics results in a robust industrial design. Both 850 series and 830 series detectors are environmentally friendly. They do not use any radioactive parts and can be returned for recycling at the end of their life. The detectors are constructed from hardwearing flame retardant FR3010 BAYBLEND plastic. They are supplied with dust covers as part of the packaging which essentially prevents contamination entering the detection chambers during installation, after which they are removed.

Chapter 2 Page 28

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


850PH and 830PH Photo Heat Multi-Sensor Detectors
With its ability to detect a wide range of fires from flaming to smouldering types, the combined optical and heat multi-sensor detector is the preferred choice for a range of applications including light industrial, retail and office environments. It operates in a number of approved modes and sensitivities that can be dynamically selected to suit different environmental conditions. Technical Specification Detector material: Flame Retardant FR3010 BAYBLEND Dimensions:Height 43mm Dia.109mm Colour: White Weight: (Excluding Base)76g. Voltage: 20 40 VDC Quiescent Current: 380uA Alarm Current: 3.3mA Operating Temp: -25 C to +70 C Storage Temp: -40 C to +80 C Relative Humidity: 95% (noncondensing) Approvals: EN54-5 and EN54-7, CPD, VdS Type Approval: CEA4021 Product Codes 516.850.051 850PH Photo Heat Detector with built in line isolator 516.830.051 830PH Photo Heat Detector

850P and 830P Photo Detectors


More benign environments where any potential fire will be slow burning can be protected using the optical detector. A choice of sensitivities and modes gives this detector a broad range of applications. Technical Specification Detector material: Flame Retardant FR3010 BAYBLEND Dimensions: Height 43mm Dia. 109mm Colour: White Weight: (Excluding Base)76g. Voltage: 20 40 VDC Quiescent Current: 380uA Alarm Current: 3.3mA Operating Temp: -25 C to +70 C Storage Temp: -40 C to +80 C Relative Humidity: 95% (non-con densing) Approvals: EN54-7, CPD, VdS Type Approval CEA4021 Product Codes 516.850.052 850P Photo Detector with built in line isolator 516.830.052 830P Photo Detector

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 29

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


850H and 830H Heat Detectors
Complimenting the range is the heat sensor which can operate in fixed temperature and rate-of-rise modes with a number of approved sensitivities. It is most often used in areas where high levels of dust are present or where the environment precludes the use of smoke detectors. Technical Specification Detector material: Flame Retardant FR3010 BAYBLEND Dimensions: Height 43mm Dia. 109mm Colour: White Weight: (Excluding Base) 81g Voltage: 20 40 VDC Quiescent Current: 335uA Alarm Current: 3.3mA Operating Temp: -25 C to +70 C, Short-term: to +90 C Storage Temp: -40 C to +80 C Relative Humidity: 95% (non-con densing) Approvals: EN54-5, CPD, VdS Type Approval Product Codes 516.850.053 850H Heat Detector with built in line isolator 516.830.053 830H Heat Detector

850PC and 830PC 3oTec Triple Sensor Detectors


3oTec Triple Sensor Detector Technical Specification Detector material:Flame Retardant FR3010 BAYBLEND Dimensions: Height 43mm Dia. 109mm Colour: White Weight: (Excluding Base) 94g Voltage: 20 40 VDC Quiescent Current: 420uA Alarm Current: 3.3mA Operating Temp: -10 C to +55 C Storage Temp: -20 C to +55 C Relative Humidity: 95% (noncondensing) Approvals: 850PC: EN54-5 and EN54-7, CPD, VdS Type Approval: VdS2806, CEA4021 Product Codes 516.850.054 850PC 3oTec Triple Sensor Detector with built in line isolator 516.830.054 830PC 3oTec Triple Sensor Detector

For life protection and when the environmental conditions are challenging, the 850PC/830PC 3oTec detector provides the ultimate in detector performance and false alarm rejection. It is a multi sensor that uses optical, heat and carbon monoxide sensors in concert to accurately determine the presence of fire. Applications include industrial, retail, transport hubs, and healthcare. Its false alarm rejection properties make it the ideal choice for hotel bedrooms where steam from bathrooms is a common source of false alarms.

850 and 830 Series Coloured Detector Covers & Bases


The existing white cover on the 850 and 830 Series Fire Detectors can be removed and replaced with any of the below coloured covers.

Product Codes

517.050.501 517.050.502 517.050.503 517.050.504 517.050.505 517.050.506 517.050.507 517.050.508 517.050.509 517.050.510 517.050.511

Sample set of coloured detector covers and bases - set of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Orange Semi Gloss-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Yellow Gloss-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Matt Green-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Matt Red-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Matt Brown-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Blue Gloss-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Pink Gloss-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Metallic Silver-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Metallic Gold-pack of 10 Detector Cover & Base in Matt Black-pack of 10

Chapter 2 Page 30

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


800F Flame Detectors
The 800F is a digital addressable, low cost infrared flame detector with some high end features such as Solar Blind operation for false alarm free reliability and an automatic health check feature. Will detect a 0.1m2 flaming fire at a range of 20m. Uses the standard MX detector bases and MX base accessories. An Intrinsically safe version is available as part of the System 800 I.S. range. Technical Specification Dimensions (mm): 108Dia x 21.2H Weight: 74g Operation Temp: -20C to+70C Storage Temperature: -40C to+80C Relative Humidity: 90% RH continuous (non-condensing) Range: 0.1m2n-heptane at 50m Field of View:100 Standards EN54 pt10 Certification Product Codes 516.800.006 801F LPCB 516.800.007 811F Marine

800I Ionisation Smoke Detector


The 800I ionisation detectors are offered for old specifications which still call for ionisation smoke detectors. The 800CH and 800PH detectors offer improved performance, significantly lower false alarms and environmental compatibility for smoke detection applications. The 800I nevertheless offers state-of-the-art ionisation smoke detection with self verification, smoke level indication and threshold compensation for detector condition monitoring. The 801I is LPCB approved. Technical Specification Dimensions: 109dia x 43Hmm Operating Temp: -20 to +70C Storage Temp: -40 to +80C Relative Humidity: <95% (non condensing) Standards: EN54 pt 7 Product Codes 801I 516.800.515.A 516.800.515.T 516.800.515.Y

ADT THORN TYCO

801PS High Sensitivity Smoke Detector


The 801 PS high sensitivity smoke detector is designed for applications which require a detector with a greater sensitivity than specified within EN54-7. Having a response to smoke of 0.6%/m makes this device suitable for use in locations where early smoke detection is required, ie cabinet protection and areas where aspirating systems would have previously been considered. Technical Specification Dimensions: 109 Dia x 43Hmm Operation temp: - 25oC to + 70o C Storage temp: - 40oC to +80oC Relative Humidity 95% non-condensing Product Code 516.800.518 801PS High sensitivity smoke detector

Line Shorting Adaptor


Low profile line shorting adaptor commissioning tool (shorts terminals together enabling cable resistance checks to be carried out) - ADT Branded Product Code 517.050.002.A Line Shorting Adapter

GD210 Gas Detector


The GD210 flammable gas detector is designed for use in non-hazardous areas where flammable gas detection is required, typical locations include kitchens, gas fired boiler rooms, meter rooms, sub basements and cable chambers. This detector connects via a 4-20mA interface to the DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Module Voltage 12-30 VDC Power 3.5 watts Output 4-20mA 3 wire Source Load resistance 250 ohms (max) Operating temp - 40 to +65oC IP rating 55 Cable entry 1 x M20 Product Codes 516.100.050 GD210 Flammable Gas Detector 4 - 20mA interface 516.100.013 Test Gas Kit - 12 L can of 2.5% methane (50%LEL) c/w adaptor and tube 516.100.014 Test Gas - 12 L can of 2.5% methane (50%LEL) 516.100.051 Spare Flammable Gas Detector Sensor 516.100.052 Spare Flammable Gas Detector PCB

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 31

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Beam and Linear Heat Detectors


Beam type smoke detection is ideal for large open span buildings where point type detection is unsuitable i.e. warehousing & sports halls. The range of Linear Heat Detection is of particular use in tunnels and cable ducts and other similar areas.

Features
Motorised Auto-Aligning Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller Each Detector configurable from 8m to 100m Integral LASER Auto-Align Fast Automatic BeamAlignment Auto-Optimise Building Movement and Contamination Compensation Low Level System Controller 20mm Cable Gland Knockouts on System Controller 2-wire interface from System Controller to Detector Worldwide Approvals including EN54:12 and UL268 Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller

FIRERAY 5000 Multi Head Auto Aligning Infrared Optical Beam Smoke Detector
The FIRERAY 5000 motorised, auto aligning infrared optical beam smoke detector can now be installed with up to four detector heads per system, thus saving on installation time and costs. This innovative system has been designed from the ground up to include pioneering technology that fully addresses the needs of the installer and user, both now and in the future. With its industry leading optics, the FIRERAY 5000 is ideally suited for the protection of large areas where the use of traditional detection technologies would prove to be too difficult and/or costly to install. The FIRERAY 5000 combines an infrared transmitter and receiver in the same discrete unit and operates by projecting a well-defined beam to a reflective prism, which returns the beam to the receiver for analysis. Smoke in the beam path causes a drop in power, which, if below a pre-determined level, results in an alarm signal. Getting the system operational is simplified by a number of groundbreaking features that combine to make the FIRERAY 5000 the quickest and easiest detector of its type to install. Once the detector heads are connected, using the Easifit First Fix system, an integral LASER, which is aligned along the optical path of the beam, can be activated. This allows the reflective prism to be sighted quickly and with confidence. Once the LASER has been used to coarsely align the beam, the AutOptimise beam alignment system takes over and automatically steers the beam into the optimum position. The system can be fully customised, according to local conditions; both alarm thresholds (sensitivity) and time to Alarm/Fault can be set from the ground level System Controller. Each detector head is independently configurable from 8m through to 100m and has its own individual fire threshold. The System Controller retains one set of Fire and Fault relays that is common to all detectors that are installed. The FR5000 MultiHead is supplied with one detector head and reflector for single beam operation from 8 to 50 meters. Up to 3 additional detector heads can be added to the controller to enable larger or more complex areas to be protected (Subject to local codes and standards). The Fireray 5000 when used in its low power mode can be interfaced to the MZX Fire Controller using the BDM800 module.

Technical Specification
Controller: 202w x 230h x 81d mm 0.9 Kg Detector: 134w x 135h x 134d mm - 0.5 Kg Additional detector head 2mA @ 24VDC Operating Current (low power mode): 10mA @ 24VDC Operating Voltage: 14 to 28VDC IP Rating: IP54 Operating Temp: -20 to +55oC Humidity: 93% RH (non condensing) max

Product Codes
516.015.020 516.015.021 516.015.007 FireRay 5000 System (50m) FR 5000 Detector Head (50m) FireRay Reflector 100 x 100mm 4 reflectors are required for distances from 50 to 100m

Chapter 2 Page 32

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Range 5 metres up to 100 metres Area coverage up to 1400m2 Selectable sensitivity Self-check and automatic compensation Manual or automatic reset Optional Mx Technology loop powered interface module (BDM800) Suitable for both conventional and addressable fire systems Fire/fault interface to MX controller Low current consumption Flexible system design options Robust metal construction Designed to conform to BS5839 Part 5

Optical Beam Smoke Detectors


The FIRE-RAY 2000 is an active infra-red smoke detector. The system comprises of three base elements i.e. a transmitter, receiver and Control Unit. Analysis of the modulated infra-red beam by the Control Unit determines whether smoke is present, and if so generates an alarm signal.

Technical Specification
Technical Specification Dimensions(mm) Height Width Depth 95 75 115 260 210 80 87 148 14 Weight (Kg) 0.4 2.25 0.1

Product Codes
516.015.006.A 516.015.006.T 920450 516.015.007 516.015.008 FireRay2000 optical beam smoke detector VdS approved, ADT Branded FireRay2000 optical beam smoke detector VdS approved, Thorn Branded FireRay2000 -UL Optical beam smoke detector - UL approved FireRay2000 Retro-Reflector 100 x 100mm FireRay2000 Alignment tool

Transmitter/Receiver Control Unit BDM800 (with M520 encl.) Voltage Range-

Fireray 2000 BDM800 Fireray 2000 Quiescent Current Fireray 2000 Alarm Current Operating Temp. Range Humidity (Fireray 2000 & LPBD521) Fireray 2000 Enclosure Fireray BDM800

+11.5 to +28Vdc 40V Loop Power <13mA <20mA -10oC to +55oC -10oC to +55oC up to 95% RH (Non-condensing) IP54

FireRay Optical Beam Smoke Detector Mounting Accessories


There are a range of mounting accessories available for use with FireRay Optical Beam Smoke Detectors. These accessories will help reduce installation times and provide a professional mounting solution when faced with challenging building internals. The large prism plate will securely The Universal Mounting bracket can be used mount 4 prisms and is designed with the Fireray 5000 detector head and the 1 to be used in conjunction with the or 4 way prism plates to enable the detector Universal Mounting Bracket (not head or prism plates to be easily mounted included) and adjusted when fixing to angled walls or cladding. The Flat Mounting plate is a metal plate which will support a single prism or 4 prisms, the side mounting holes are compatible with Unistrut racking systems. The small prism plate will securely mount a single prism and is designed to be used in conjunction with the Universal Mounting Bracket (not included)

Product Codes
5000-005 5000-006 5000-007 5000-008 02/12 Fire Catalogue Universal Mounting Bracket Flat Mounting Plate for 1 to 4 Prisms Prism Mounting Plate for 4 Prisms Prism Mounting Plate for 1 Prism Chapter 2 Page 33

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Linear Heat Detectors


Features
Easy and cost effective installation Good sensitivity with adjustable alarm threshold Open and short circuit monitoring Suited for outdoor and indoor applications Can be used in hazardous areas Mechanical protection is provided for cables in areas where damage may occur Chemical resistance sheathing is available for areas where petro-chemical corrosion may occur.

Linear Heat Detection


The LD40 linear heat detection system is used to monitor fire (or overheat) conditions in confined or polluted areas or where there are adverse or unusually variable environmental conditions. The sensor cable is unaffected by dust, moisture or vibration and requires little maintenance.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Operating Temp: Relative humidity: Rating: Operating Voltage: Quiescent Current: 178H x 130W x 75D mm 0.55Kg -25C to +70C Up to 98% RH non-condensing IP55 +8 to +30Vdc 60-80A

Product Codes
516.016.005 516.016.006 LD40 High resistance sensor cable blue - 200M reel LD40 High resistance sensor cable black - 200M reel (Nylon sheath suitable for petrochemical exposure) LD40 EOL Termination kit (PK10) LD40 In-line Jointing kit (PK10) LD40 Analyser module with conventional detection zone interface B6782-003 EDGE CLIP 2-3mm WEB B6782-024 EDGE CLIP 3-8mm WEB B6782-025 EDGE CLIP 8-13mm WEB B6782-026 EDGE CLIP 14-20mm WEB B6782-004 'T' CLIP B6782-005 PIPE CLIP B6782-023 'V' CLIP B6782-008 NEOPRENE SLEEVE

516.016.010 516.016.011 516.016.012 516.016.201 516.016.202 516.016.203 516.016.204 516.016.205 516.016.206 516.016.207 516.016.208

Ceiling Clip

Edge Clip

Pipe Clip

V Clip

Chapter 2 Page 34

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Detector Bases & Accessories


To complement the new 850 range and 830 range of detectors, a number of bases and detector accessories are available. They are designed to further enhance the installability and serviceability of the range with an emphasis on reducing engineering costs. The detector bases are designed to snap-fit to the ceiling tile adaptor or can be screw fixed to a ceiling or electrical box in the traditional manner. A park position allows the detector to be mechanically attached to the base without making electrical connection to facilitate the testing of electronic free bases. 4B-C 4" Continuity Base
The new 4B-C 4 continuity base is designed to snap-fit to the ceiling tile adaptor or it can screw fix to a ceiling in the traditional manner. The 4B-C 4 continuity base is designed specifically for use with the 850 series detector and provides a switching mechanism that ensures continuity when the detector (and built-in short circuit isolator) is removed. When used with the time saver ceiling tile adaptor, the 4B-C 4 continuity base uses a snap-fit mechanism that saves installation time. Features For use with the 850 series detectors Compact rigid design that improves the appearance and is easy to install Built-in continuity switch that closes on detector removal Electronics free, permits in circuit testing Snap fit to the time saver ceiling tile adaptor Detector locking pin included Detector park position for service and commissioning, holds the detector mechanically in place whilst disconnected from the loop and continuity switch is closed Choice of 8 mini-trunking break-outs Product Code 517.050.042 4B-C 4" Continuity Base

4B 4 Detector Base
The new 4B 4 detector base is designed to snap-fit to the ceiling tile adaptor or it can be screw fixed to a ceiling in the traditional manner. Features Compatible with 830 series detectors Drives a remote indicator Detector locking pin provided with every base Snap fits to the Time Saver Ceiling Tile Adaptor Fits directly to a British or European electrical back box Temporary park position Break-outs for surface mount Product Code 517.050.041 4B 4 Detector Base

4B-I 4" Isolator Base


The new 4B-I 4 Isolator base is designed to snap-fit to the ceiling tile adaptor or it can screw fix to a ceiling in the traditional manner. The 4B-I 4 base is designed specifically for use with the 830 series detectors and provides protection against short circuit faults on the MZX digital addressable loop. Features For use with the 830 series detectors Compact rigid design that improves the appearance and is easy to install Up to 250 x 4B-I 4 isolators can be connected on each loop Snap fit to the time saver ceiling tile adaptor Detector locking pin included Detector park position for service and commissioning, holds the detector mechanically in place whilst disconnected from the loop Choice of 8 mini-trunking breakouts Product Code 517.050.043 4B-I 4" Isolator Base

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 35

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Ceiling Tile Adapter
The Time Saver Ceiling Tile Adaptor is used with the 4 snap fit base and consists of three parts, a bezel and clamp that are fitted to the ceiling tile and a back-box that carries the detector and base assembly. It is available as a complete unit or alternatively, the back-box can be ordered separately, as can the bezel and clamp assembly. Ordering the parts separately may be preferred if there is an extended period before the false ceiling is installed e.g. shell and core projects. Requires a 127mm diameter hole. The CTA adaptor plate allows the Time Saver Ceiling Tile Adaptor to be used with other devices such as the AV Base, 802SB or Mini Firecryer. Features Cuts installation time by 30% Commission the system before the suspended ceiling is installed Suitable for ceiling tiles from 1mm to 30mm thick Made from flame retardant material No additional back-box is required Time saver is designed for use with a new snap-fit 4 detector base Adaptor available for use with the AV base & other devices Product Codes 517.050.060 Ceiling Tile Adaptor Kit consists of 1 x 517.050.056 and 1 x 517.050.057 517.050.056 CTA-BB CTA Back Box 517.050.057 CTA-BC CTA Bezel and Clamp 517.050.058 CTA-AP CTA Adaptor Plate

4B-6A 4 to 6 Adaptor
The 4B-6A 4 to 6 Adaptor is designed for use with U.S. style 6 electrical back boxes and provides a flush architectural trim between the electrical box and the 4B-C 4 continuity base. It can also be fixed directly to a ceiling and used to conceal marks left when older, large diameter detectors are replaced with MZX Technology. Features Adapts 6 electrical boxes to fit the 4B-C 4 continuity base Architectural trim for neat appearance Concealed fixings Use to conceal marks left by old detectors when replaced by MZX Technology Product Code 517.050.054 4B-6A 4" to 6" Base Adaptor

Chapter 2 Page 36

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


The range of standard bases is supplemented by this selection of sounder bases, relay bases and accessories, including loop powered sounder base for use on MX technology controllers. In addition, changes to the building during its life can be easily adapted to, by retrofitting sounders and relay outputs to existing detection points. When functional bases are fitted to universal bases, they automatically lock into position. Removal is then achieved using the detector removal tool. This feature ensures that the detector and functional bases are removed separately.

Tyco MKII Sounder Base


A new low current range of sounder bases for use with Conventional and Addressable Fire Alarm Control Panels. Features Manufactured to EN54 part 3 Integral sounder and detector base Volume and tone adjustable after installation Low Power Synchronisation Do not require use of a standard base (maybe installed directly onto a standard besa box) Product Codes 516.800.911 901SB Universal Sounder Base 516.800.910 802SB MX Loop Powered Sounder Base 516.800.913 812SB MX Loop Powered UL Sounder Base 516.800.912 912SB Universal UL Sounder Base 517.050.022 Volume Pot Spare Cover (1 sheet of 144) 517.050.005 4 Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)

SAB 801 Sounder Addressable Beacon


The SAB 801 Sounder Addressable Beacon is an MX Addressable Beacon that fits into the Standard Minerva Universal Base. Alternatively the SAB may be fitted to the 802SB, 812SB, 901SB and 912SB Sounder Bases to enable the MX Control Panel to communicate with and control these sounder bases and also provide a Flashing Beacon effectively turning the 802SB, 812SB, 901SB and 912SB into a combined addressable loop powered sounder and beacon. The SAB is suitable for wall or ceiling mounting. Sound selection and tones will be as per the 802SB, 812SB, 901SB and 912SB. Product Code 516.800.956 SAB 801 Low Power Sounder Addressable Beacon (Compatible with Consys Version 8.1 and above)

801RB - Functional Relay Base


The 801RB provides dual relay contacts for signalling external devices on MX addressable systems. A very low operating current even when the relay is energised enables the relay base to be used without any additional power. The dual contacts are under the control of a programmable output, through the powerful cause and effect software. Features Dual pole 24V DC relay contact (60VA) Very low power consumption (<20A except startup) Product Code 516.800.905 801RB Relay base

Volume Adjustment Tool


A simple Volume Adjustment Tool, specific to the task of sounder volume selection on the variablevolume range of Tyco MKII Sounder Bases. Sounder volume can be easily varied between the maximum 90dBA and minimum 68dBA-volume settings, using this simple, functional tool. Note: Sounder Bases are supplied with the volume pre-set to maximum volume. Product Code 517.050.015 Volume Adjustment Tool

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 37

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


801RIL - Remote Indication LED
All detector bases have the ability to drive a remote LED in the event that the installed position of the detector is not easily visible. The 801RIL is primarily designed for LPCB influenced markets but is compatible with all 800 Series detectors. Features UK Single gang mounting High intensity red LED Product Code 516.800.908 801RIL remote indication LED

800HL - Indication Lamp


The 800HL remote indicator lamp provides a larger indicator for use in place of the RIL when longer distances are involved or in VdS influenced markets. Typically used to indicate the source of an alarm in buildings with long corridors eg. Hotels, hospitals, apartments. Product Code 516.800.909 800HL indication lamp

4B-EM 4" Euro Mount


The euro-mounting base provides a matching back box, which allows the 4 bases to be ceiling mounted with conduit entries for standard 18 and 21mm conduit. Features 2 x 18mm conduit entries 2 x 21mm conduit entries Fits all 4 Bases Accepts up to 8 accessory terminals Product Codes 517.050.052 4B-EM 4" Euro Mount 517.050.612 Base Accessory terminal kit (pack of 10)

4B-DHM Deck Head Mounting


Where the detectors are mounted in humid and environmentally challenging situations such as marine or offshore installations, the 4B-DHM deck head mount provides a sealed waterproof mounting which protects the electrical connections in the base. Can be screwed, bolted / welded to the deckhead. Supplied with 1 terminal. If more are required, use the optional base accessory terminal kit. Features 4 x 20mm gland entries Fits ALL 4 bases IP55 with supplied gasket Product Codes 517.050.051 4B-DHM Deckhead Mount 517.050.612 Base accessory terminal kit (pack of 10)

Protective Detector Cage


Robust steel protective cage for Series 800 detector ranges using the 5 bases. Ideal for schools and sporthalls or whenever detectors need protection. Strong coated steel construction with 4 point fitting. Product Code 517.050.614 CW-5B Detector Cage

Protective Detector Sounder Base Cage


White powder coated steel protective cage for Series 800 Detectors fitted with a sounder base. Internal dimensions: 120mm dia x 80mm deep. Product Code 517.050.011 Steel Protective Detector Cage

Chapter 2 Page 38

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Detector Ancillaries


Features
Provides clear identification of address Colour coded Flag remains on base

800 Series MX Address Flag


The 800 Series detectors incorporate a feature, which automatically transfers the address flag to the detector base, when the detector is plugged into the base. On removal of the detector the address flag remains on the ceiling, thus ensuring that detectors are not accidentally returned to the wrong detector base following service routines. Most MX detection panels incorporate additional fail safe software features to ensure that incorrect detector positioning does not compromise the system. Address flags are supplied in packs of 100. Labels are provided on sheets of 250 in eight colours to enable quick identification between different loops.

Product Codes
516.800.915 516.800.931 516.800.932 516.800.933 516.800.934 MX Address flags (pack of 100) Address flag labels Loop A - White Address flag labels Loop B - Yellow Address flag labels Loop C - Purple Address flag labels Loop D - Green 516.800.935 516.800.936 516.800.937 516.800.938 Address Address Address Address flag flag flag flag labels labels labels labels Loop Loop Loop Loop E - Grey F - Blue G - Orange H - Red

Features
Colour coded for Easy Loop Identification Space for Zonal Label Strong Adhesive Backing

Callpoint & Ancillary Address Labels


Detectors have a special address flag for carrying the address labels - detailed in the detector section. For other devices or on detectors where zone information is also required a series of address labels are available. Numbered 1 to 250, the address labels are available in 8 different colours to distinguish between different loops. In addition small zone labels can be fixed to the address labels.

Product Codes
Zone Labels 599.047.011 599.047.012 599.047.013 599.047.014 599.047.015 599.047.016 599.047.018 599.047.019 599.047.020 599.047.021 599.047.022 02/12 Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone Zone labels labels labels labels labels labels labels labels labels labels labels Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones Zones 1 - 16 17 - 32 33 - 48 49 - 64 65 - 80 81 - 100 101 - 120 121 - 140 141 - 160 161 - 180 181 - 200 599.047.023 599.047.024 Address Labels 599.047.030 599.047.031 599.047.032 599.047.033 599.047.005 599.047.006 599.047.007 599.047.008 Fire Catalogue Zone labels - Zones 201 - 220 Zone labels - Zones 221 - 240 Address Address Address Address Address Address Address Address Labels Labels Labels Labels Labels Labels Labels Labels 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 250 250 250 250 127 127 127 127 Loop Loop Loop Loop Loop Loop Loop Loop A - White B - Yellow C - Purple D - Green E - Grey F - Blue G - Orange H - Red

Chapter 2 Page 39

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Duct Probe Air Sampling


Where smoke within duct work needs to be detected these duct probe units provide an economical solution, for use with 800 series detectors. SMP Duct Probe Units The SMP Duct Probe Units are designed to be installed in air conditioning supply and exhaust ducts for the purpose of monitoring the airflow for smoke and combustion products. The SMP69 probe units are designed to accept and operate with the 800 series detectors. For general applications it is recommended that photoelectric smoke detectors rather than ionisation smoke detectors are used. The SMP stainless steel probe unit is designed to withstand the more demanding environments of the offshore oil and gas industries. The units are designed to operate in airspeeds of 1.5 to 25 metres per second. A range of sampling tubes from 525mm to 1575mm is available

Warning Duct probe units sited in the common duct work to several extract grills may fail to respond to smoke from any one extract due to the effect of dilution. The SMP units will not respond to airflow of less than 1.5m/sec.

Height Width Length Weight

SMP69 90mm 150mm 225mm 1.2Kg

Technical Specification Operating temperature: -20C to +70C Storage temperature: -25C to +80C Relative Humidity: 0 to 95% SMP69 Stainless steel 316 housing with transparent polycarbonate cover

SMP69 Duct Probe Air Sampling - Stainless Steel


Product Codes 517.025.035 SMP69 Stainless Steel Duct Probe unit and universal detector base for Series 600/800 Detectors. 517.025.028 DPS450 Probe tube stainless steel 450mm and exhaust 517.025.029 DPS600 Probe tube stainless steel 600mm and exhaust 517.025.030 DPS750 Probe tube stainless steel 750mm and exhaust 517.025.031 DPS900 Probe tube stainless steel 900mm and exhaust 577.025.032 DPS1200 Probe tube Stainless Steel 1200mm and exhaust 517.025.033 DPS1500 Probe tube stainless steel 1500mm and exhaust Datasheet - Product Code PSF92 SMP69 Duct Probe Unit Manual - Vol01B-06-D1 Detectors Fire Manual

Chapter 2 Page 40

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Built-in MZX Detector base DPK4 - with built-in MZX detector base 5" - 5B DPK4I - with built-in MZX detector base 5" - 5BI DPK4 is suitable for addressable and conventional systems DPK4I with built-in line isolator for use with MZX Technology systems Suitable for air velocities from 1 m/s to 20 m/s Can be used in combination with a wide range of optical smoke detectors e.g. 801PH, 813P 601P or 601PH , One-pipe air sampling system simplifies installation Range of aluminium probe tubes are available for ducts up to 2700 mm Transparent lid allows detector to be seen Test hole on cover Sensitive flow indicator Simple service and maintenance Installer friendly connection of cables Easy installation of duct probe tubes

DPK4 Duct Probe


The DPK4 and DPK4I duct probe units have been developed to detect smoke in ventilation ducts. They offer significant benefits in terms of performance and installation. The system comprises a single duct probe tube and housing specially designed for optimum airflow through the smoke detector and suitable for use in incoming, outgoing and circulation air ducts of ventilation and conditioning systems. The duct probes can operate across a wide range of airflow speeds and are especially recommended for installations in ducts with air flow velocities between 1 m/s and 20 m/s. Unlike more traditional duct probe units that employ an inlet and exhaust tube with sampling holes, the DPK4 and DPK4I units uses a highly efficient single sampling tube that is slotted along its length. This allows the sampling tubes to be cut to the desired length whilst maintaining maximum efficiency. The transparent cover gives clear visibility of the detector, its LED indication and airflow indicator. A red plastic flag is fixed inside the housing providing a simple but effective confirmation that there is no leakage and that the air flow from the air duct is in fact passing through the housing. In order to reduce the time required to test the duct probe detector during routine maintenance, an aperture is provided that allows aerosol test gas to be directed at the detector without having to dismantle the unit. Accessories Tyco Safety Products offer 3 lengths of the duct probe tubes. The tube is made of aluminium and can easily be shortened to suit the span of the air duct. Where the unit is mounted on insulated or circular air ducts, the DPKM mounting bracket is required.

Product Codes
517.025.049 517.025.050 517.025.051 517.025.052 517.025.053 517.025.054 517.025.055 DPK4 - Duct Probe with MZX detector base 5" - 5B DPK4I - Duct Probe with MZX detector base 5" with isolator - 5BI DPK600 - Duct Probe Tube 600 mm DPK1500 - Duct Probe Tube 1500 mm DPK2800 - Duct Probe Tube 2800 mm DPKM - Duct Probe Mounting Bracket Spare Filters for DPK4/DPK4I (PK of 10)

Detector supplied separately

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 41

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology MX Addressable Input/Output Modules


APM800 Addressable Power Supply Monitor
The APM800 is an MX addressable power supply monitoring module which is usually used with the PSM800/820/821 power supply module to make an addressable power supply. The APM800 is designed to fix to studs on the top of the PSM800/820/821 The APM800 monitors the PSM800/820/821 for mains failure, earth fault, battery charger fault and battery fault. It can reset the PSM800/820/821 resettable 24Vdc output and initiate a battery test which then reports battery voltage and current to the controller. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN50081- 1 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 24H x 127W x 57D mm Weight: 0.794Kg Product Code 557.202.027 APM800 addressable power supply monitor

MIM800 Mini-Input Module


The MIM800 is a small MX addressable module designed for monitoring a single input circuit. The MIM800 can monitor normally open or normally closed inputs and provides open and short circuit monitoring of the line. The MIM800 is designed for fitting in small devices such as flow switches, special detection devices and explosion proof callpoints. A variant of the MIM800 is used in all callpoints and pullstations. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN500811 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 13H x 48W x 57D mm Weight: 100g EOL resistor: 200 Ohm Monitor Resistor: 100 Ohm Product Code 555.800.001 MIM800 mini-input module

CIM800 Contact Input Module


The CIM800 is a flexible addressable input-monitoring device that fits in the standard ancillary housings. The CIM800 provides two inputs to current MX panels though this can be implemented as two separately wired spurs (Style B) or as a loop (Style A). Both spur and loop input wiring can be configured to monitor normally open or normally closed inputs. In addition both can be configured to initiate an alarm or short circuit fault message in the event of a short circuit on normally open monitoring circuits.

Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN500811 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 100g EOL & monitor resistor: 10k Ohms

Product Codes 555.800.002 CIM800 contact input monitor 555.800.032 CIM800 Module c/w Front Cover

DIM800 Detector Input Module


The DIM800 is designed to power and monitor a circuit of low voltage conventional detectors and callpoints. The detection circuit is powered from an external 24V d.c. supply and is reset by the MX addressable panel. The DIM800 monitors the external 24V d.c. and provides a fault signal if it is lost. The input detection circuit can be wired as one or two spur circuits (Class B), one loop configured circuit (Class A) or one 4 wire detection circuit.The DIM800 is designed to be compatible with most conventional detection products. Compatibility has been tested to date on the following products: Compatible Thorn detectors: M300 Series , M601 Series , S100 Series, H Series, S231F, S231F+, CP200, Series 600Compatible Zettler detectors: M613 Series. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN500811 & EN50130-4 -20oC to Operating Temp.: +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 100g Product Codes 555.800.012 DIM800 detector input monitor 555.800.042 DIM800 Module c/w front cover

Chapter 2 Page 42

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


LIM800 Line Isolator Module
The LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator Module is designed to be used on all MX addressable loops. It monitors the line condition and upon detection of a short circuit it isolates the affected section whilst allowing the rest of the addressable loop to function normally. The LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator Module ensures that on a looped addressable system a short circuit fault cannot disable more detection devices than would be lost on a conventional non-addressable system in accordance with BS5839 Part 1. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000-6-3 & EN50130-4 Operating Temperature: - 25C to +70C Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 100g Product Codes 545.800.004 LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator Module 545.800.033 LIM800 Ancillary Line Isolator Module c/w front cover

TM520 Timer Module


The TM520 provides 2 x outputs that can be activated based on a delay time. If either the key-switch on the module is activated, or a predefined event within the control panel occurs then a timed delay (set between 10 minutes and 2 hours 10 minutes) is started. When the delay reaches zero the TM520 outputs are activated. The unit sounds an internal buzzer and shows a red LED when the outputs are active, and shows a yellow LED when the timer is counting down. To provide a warning that the delay is nearly over, the red LED and the buzzer will pulse 5 minutes before the end of the delay . The TM520 requires a separate 24V DC supply to operate. The module is not addressable and will therefore not take an address on the loop. Technical Specification Powered: 24Vdc Temperature Range: -10C to +70C Operating Humidity: <95% RH Dimensions: 87H x148W x 14D mm Product Code 557.180.423 TM520 timer module - non addressable

SIO800 Single Input/Output Module


The SIO800 Single Input/Output Module is designed to provide a monitored input and a volt free relay changeover output. It consists of an input for monitoring the status of a normally open contact and a single changeover relay contact. The relay is controlled by a command sent from the Minerva MX Fire Controller via the addressable loop. The state of the relay (activated,deactivated or stuck) is reported to the Minerva MX Fire Controller. The LED may be turned ON or OFF by the controller during a relay activated condition. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Product Family standard EN50130-4 in respect of Conducted Disturbances, Radiated Immunity, Electrostatic Discharge, Fast Transients and Slow High Energy. 61000-6-3for Emissions. Operating Temperature: -25C to + 70C Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 105g Product Codes 555.800.063 SIO800 Single Input/Output Module 555.800.064 SIO800 Single Input/Output Module c/w Front Cover

DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Module


The DDM800 provides the ability to connect and interface 2 zones of conventional 2 wire fire detectors or two 4-20mA sensors to the MX Fire alarm controllers. When used to interface conventional detection devices, Open & Short circuit and device removal monitoring is provided. Intrinsically safe (IS) detection is supported when used with a galvanic isolator An integral line isolator is incorporated in the module. Loop powered or 24vdc operation. The 4-20mA interface can be used to monitor devices such as gas detectors, temperature alarms or any 4-20mA interfaced device. Compatible with MXConsys version 15 or later Technical Specification EMC/RFI Equal or exceeds EN61000-6-3 & EN50130-4 Operating Temperature -25C to +70C Operating Humidity Up to 95% RH non-condensing Product Codes 577.800.006 DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Module 577.800.036 DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Module c/w front cover 577.800.056 DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Module housed in IP55 D800 enclosure 557.800.057 DDM800 Detector Removal End of Line Resistor (pack of 10)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 43

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


RIM800 Relay Interface Module
The RIM800 provides a single programmable relay output from the MX DIGITAL addressable loop which can be programmed for a variety of applications including signalling fire conditions to plant, machinery, fire doors, dampers & security systems. The RIM800 relay coil is monitored. The RIM800 relay contact is rated for 2A @ 24V d.c. but can be used to switch mains voltage when used with the HVR800. This unit has two optoisolated terminals specifically for driving the HVR800. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000.6.3& EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH noncondensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 100g Quiescent Current: 200A Relay contacts: 2A @ 24V d.c. Product Codes 568.800.003 RIM800 relay interface module 568.800.033 RIM800 Module C/W Front Cover

HVR800 High Voltage Relay Module


The HVR800 module is a non-addressable device which allows a low current mains rated relay to switch up to 10A. Alternatively a low voltage drive signal such as that provided by the RIM800 or 80 way mimic can be used to switch the integral mains relay via the opto-isolated input. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000.6.3 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH noncondensing Dimensions: 26.5H x 42W x 74D mm Relay Contacts: Up to 10A @ 250Va.c. Product Codes 568.800.004 HVR800 high voltage relay 568.800.034 HVR800 in isolated D800 housing

SNM800 Sounder Notification Module


The SNM800 is a remote addressable sounder circuit output device capable of switching sounder and speaker circuits up to 2A @ 24V d.c. or provide a monitored output facility for other applications. These can be used in addition to the two circuits provided as standard on most MX detection panels. The SNM800 can support sounder circuits wired as a spur (Class B Style Y) or in a loop configuration (Class A Style Z). The SNM800 can be configured with a RIM800 to provide a secure monitored extinguishing release solenoid control. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000.6.3 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH noncondensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 100g Output rating: 2A @ 24V d.c. EOL resistor: 27k 1/2W Product Codes 577.800.005 SNM800 sounder notification module 577.800.035 SNM800 Module c/w Front cover

LPS800 Loop Powered Sounder Module


The LPS800 provides a single monitored sounder output circuit with up to 75mA of power sourced from the MX panel. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000.6.31 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non- condensing Dimensions: Weight: Output rating: 14H x 148W x 87D mm 100g 75mA @ 24V d.c. max Product Codes 577.800.011 LPS800 Loop Powered Sounder module 577.800.041 LPS800 Module c/w front cover NOTE: Each MX Digital Loop can provide up to 495mA for loop powered sounders and modules

SB520 Sounder Booster Module


The SB520 sounder booster module enables the SNM800 to drive circuits with higher currents whilst maintaining the reverse polarity integrity line monitoring. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000.6.31 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp.: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: Dimensions: Weight: Output rating: Non addressable up to 95% RH non--condensing 14H x 148W x 87D mm 100g 15A @ 24V d.c./10A Max. per terminal Product Codes 577.001.023 SB520 Sounder Booster Module 577.001.033 SB520 Module c/w Front Cover

Chapter 2 Page 44

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


BDM800 Beam Detector Module - Loop Powered
The BDM800 Beam Detector Module is designed to interface the FIRERAY 50R or the 100R reflective beam detector to the MX Digital Addressable Loop. The BDM800 provides power from the loop, monitors the Fire and Fault outputs of the detector and also monitors inter-connections for open and short circuit faults. The BDM800 can also be used with the FIRERAY 2000 active infrared beam detector. Supplied fitted in a standard double gang ancillary housing, the BDM800 greatly simplifies the wiring normally associated with beam detection. The considerable cost of providing local power supplies that satisfy the stringent requirements of BS5839 part 1 is eliminated. Features Power Beam detectors directly from the MX Digital loop Reduced wiring and installation costs Monitors beam detector for fire and fault Inter-connection monitored for open and short circuit faults LPCB and VdS approved (pend ing) Can be installed to BS5839 part 1 2002 On board LED indicates polling and active Use with reflective beams FIRERAY 50R or 100R for greater savings on installation Compatible with FIRERAY 2000 + FIRERAY 5000 beam detectors Optional BTM800 beam terminal tion module to further simplify installation Product Code 555.800.066 BDM800 Beam Detector Module c/w Cover

BTM Beam Termination Module


In many cases it will be necessary to site the BDM800 Beam Detector Module some distance from the beam detector itself. To minimise and simplify wiring in such cases an optional unit, the BTM800 beam termination module is available. The BTM800 is also housed in a standard double gang ancillary cover and has all the connections and components required to minimise installation time. Features Simplifies the wiring between Beam detector and BDM800 Allows BDM800 to be sited up to 40m from the beam detector Product Code 555.800.067 BTM800 Beam Terminal Module c/w Cover

MIO800 Multi-Input Output Module


The MIO800 is a general purpose interface module for use with MX technologyTM fire detection systems. It allows multiple input and output connections to be made between external equipment and the MX Digital loop. Three input and four outputs are provided. Each input and output can be programmed independently using the MX Consys configuration tool to provide customised functionality. An IP55 rated D800 style housing is used as the standard enclosure with the option of a DIN-rail mounting kit for in-cabinet installations. Features Normally open or normally closed inputs Inputs monitored for open or short circuit faults. STYLE B (short circuit gives an alarm) or STYLE C (short circuit gives a fault) selectable for inputs Provides four digital outputs All four outputs can drive a selfpowered high voltage relay HVR800 Two outputs have both volt free change over contacts and HVR Drivers. Technical Specification Operating Temperature -25C to + 70C Storage Temperature -40C to +80C Operating Humidity Up to 95% non-condensing Dimensions (HWD): Module 72 x 110 x 18mm Boxed: 124.5 x 166.5 x 84.5mm Weight: Module 70g Boxed 271g Relay Contact Rating DC - 2A @ 24V dc Product Codes 555.800.065 Multi I/O Module 557.201.401 D800 Ancillary Housing 557.201.303 Din Rail Mounting Kit

TSM800 Door Control Module


The TSM800 is used to control fire doors in accordance with BS7273 Part 4. When activated, either by a fire signal or by a fault or isolation within the fire door zone, the TSM800 will interrupt the supply to the door holders and the doors under control of the module will close. The module has the provision to monitor a contact to report to the fire controller if the door fails to close. The module also includes a built-in line isolator. This module requires MX Consys 10 or later to function. Technical Specification EMC/RFI: Equal or exceeds EN61000.6.3 & EN50130-4 Operating Temp: -20oC to +70oC Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 14H x 148W x 87D mm Weight: 100g Relay contacts: 2A @30VDC Product Code 555.800.069 TSM800 PCB

VIO800 MX Vesda Interface


The VIO800 MX Vesda Interface will enable all versions of the popular LaserPLUS Detectors and 7 relay versions of the Laser SCANNER Detectors to be interfaced directly to the MXDigital detection loops. 3 configurable inputs and 1 output signal are available from the interface enabling it to integrate fully with the Vesda detector. This module is designed to fit in bay one of the Vesda Detectors. Product Code 516.018.014 VIO800 MX VESDA Interface

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 45

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Connects directly to the MX Digital Loop. Reduced installation time and cost since no external module is required. Easier Programming and Commissioning predefined in MXconsys. EN60950:2000 Compliant PSU. EN50130-4:1996 & EN50081-1:1992 Compliant PSU. Mains and Fault LED Indicator on front cover. Output fuse protected. 24VDC Voltage Door Release Relay. Specifically designed for the safe actuation of release mechanisms for doors. Satisfies the requirements of BS7273 Part 4 for category A actuation of Fire Doors. Built in line isolator. Self monitoring operation. Approved to EN54-18 (Input/Output Devices) and EN5417 (Line Isolators).

MZX Compatible 4 Amp 24VDC Addressable Door Holder PSU


The MZX compatible ELM24TSM 4 Amp 24VDC Addressable Door Control & Power Supply Unit, is designed to provide monitoring and activation in compliance with the most stringent local door control standards. This Door Holder PSU is interfaced to the MZX Panels via an integral TSM800 Door Control Module which is field mounted inside the Door Holder PSU and connects to the MZX Detector Loop.

Technical Specification
Input Voltage: Output Voltage: Output Current: Temperature: Relative Humidity: IP Rating: Material: Dimensions:

Product Code
ELM24TSM 4 Amp 24VDC Addressable Door Holder PSU

558.004.011 230VAC 50Hz 22 - 30Vdc 4 Amps Continuous -10C to + 40C 95% RH IP41 (excluding rear face) 1.2mm white powder coated steel 230mm (W) x 200mm (H) x 80mm (D)

Chapter 2 Page 46

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Housings MX Ancillary Housings


A variety of ancillary housings are available to fit the 800 Series MX ancillaries. The standard sized modules are mechanically compatible with all options. LPCB approvals are with the M520 double gang cover plate or ancillary housings. The M520 double gang cover provides external access for the MX SERVICE TOOL to plug into the ancillary module which is mounted in the cover. All options allow the ancillary to be programmed and tested when the cover is removed.

M520
M520 Ancillary cover for use with 800 series modules. Will fit onto a MK style double gang back box. Product Code 517.035.007 M520 Ancillary Cover

D800
D800 IP55 ancillary housing 140W x 120H x 70mmD incorporates window to view module LED Product Code 557.201.401 D800 IP55 Ancillary Housing

ANC-3 Ancillary Housing


ANC-3 MINERVA ancillary housing - for use with M800 ancillary modules (can accommodate up to 3 M800 modules). 340W x 290H x 90mm D Product Code 557.180.097.A ADT Branded

ANC-8 Ancillary Housing


ANC-8 MINERVA ancillary housing - for use with M800 ancillary modules, houses 8 modules, expandable to 16 using the STK8 stacking kit. 440W x 320H x 140mm D Product Codes 557.180.096.A ADT Branded 557.180.095 STK8 stacking kit

DIN Rail Mounting Bracket


DIN Rail mounting bracket enables any module which can be mounted to a M520 ancillary cover to be DIN rail mounted using this bracket. Clip-on PCB mounting pillars are included. Will fit standard 35mm DIN Rail bracket. Product Code 547.004.002 DIN rail mounting bracket

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 47

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


QFB/2
QFB/2 Dry lining flush mount (for plasterboard etc) MK backbox for use with 800 Series addressable ancillaries using 517.035.007 cover. Product Code 517.035.015 QFB/2 Dry lining flush mount backbox

K2214 ALM
K2214 ALM Metal surface mount MK backbox for use with 800 Series addressable ancillaries using 517.035.007 cover. Product Code 517.035.011 K2214 ALM Metal Surface Mount MK backbox

MK K2142
MK K2142 White plastic surface mount MK backbox for use with 800 Series addressable ancillaries using 517.035.007 cover. Product Code 517.035.010 MX K2142 White plastic surface mount backbox

8621C
8621C Steel flush mount MK backbox for use with 800 Series addressable ancillaries using 517.035.007 cover.

Product Code
517.035.014

8621C Steel Flush Mount MK Backbox

Technical Specification
Product Code 517.035.011 517.035.010 517.035.014 517.035.015 MK Ref K2214 K2142 8621C QFB/2 Mounting Surface Surface Flush Flush/ Dry Lining Dimensions 146x86x40mm 146x86x34mm 132x72x26mm 146x85x38mm Knockouts 1x20mm rear/7x20mm sides One rear (25x35mm) 4x20mm rear/12x20mm sides 2 top & bottom Earth Screw Material Yes Steel N/A Plastic Yes Steel N/A Plastic

Chapter 2 Page 48

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Callpoints


Features
Integral LED indicator for easy identification of operation Surface or flush mounting Extensive range of digital addressable callpoints Test key facility, speeds maintenance visits Hazardous areas models available (See Special Hazards Section) IP67 Waterproof models for external applications

CP Series Callpoints
A comprehensive range of callpoints for use with addressable systems. All the callpoints are designed to enable an alarm signal to be given by breaking a glass element. This operates a switch and is indicated by an LED indicator. If required, an optional transparent hinged cover may be installed to guard against accidental operation.

Technical Specification
(Indoor & Outdoor) Housing: Operating Temp.: Outdoor Indoor Relative Humidity: PC/ABS -25oC TO +70oC -10oC TO +55oC up to 95% RH (non-condensing)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 49

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Callpoints CP820/CP830 Indoor/Outdoor
Indoor Callpoint Weight: 110g Outdoor Callpoint Weight: 240g
73mm

CP820 Indoor Callpoint


The CP820 is an indoor MX addressable manual callpoint with programmable status LED. The CP820 is designed for LPCB approvals and the CP820M for Marine approvals. The CP820 provides high speed communication to the MX panel of a manual fire alarm. Technical Specification Meets BS5839 Pt.2 and pr EN54 Pt:11 EN50130-4/ EMC/RFI: EN61000-6-3 Operating Temp.: -10to +55C Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 93H x 89W x 59.5D (27.5 mm flush mount) Weight: 110g IP Rating 24D Product Codes 514.800.603.T CP820 Indoor Callpoint (Thorn Branded) 514.800.603.A CP820 Indoor Callpoint (ADT Branded) 514.800.603.Y CP820 Indoor Callpoint (TYCO Branded) 514.800.605.T CP820M Marine Indoor Call Point (Thorn Branded)

CP830 Outdoor Callpoint


The CP830 is an outdoor MX addressable manual callpoint with programmable status LED. The CP830 is designed for LPCB approvals and the CP830M for Marine approvals. The CP830 provides high speed communication to the MX panel of a manual fire alarm. Technical Specification Meets BS5839 Pt.2 and pr EN54 Pt:11 EMC/RFI: EN50130-4/ ENG61000-6-3 Operating Temp.: -25 to +70C Relative Humidity: up to 95% RH non-condensing Dimensions: 93H x 97.5W x 73Dmm Weight: 240g IP Rating 67 Product Codes 514.800.604.T CP830 Outdoor Callpoint (Thorn Branded) 514.800.604.A CP830 Outdoor Callpoint (ADT Branded) 514.800.604.Y CP830 Outdoor Callpoint (TYCO Branded) 514.800.606.T CP830M Marine Outdoor Callpoint (Thorn Branded)

Chapter 2 Page 50

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Callpoint Ancillaries
Product Codes 90-107 Red M141 spacer for red CP200/800 KAC callpoints 515.001.045 Test key for all MCP and CP style callpoints

515.001.128 Callpoint hinged cover for use on MCP callpoints models (Colour Clear)

515.001.026 Black callpoint bezel for CP200/800 models.

Ancillaries - Back Boxes


Product Codes 515.001.021 Standard Red surface mounting back box for MCP & CP indoor callpoints 10-115 SR2-T Optional Back Box (2 terminals)
Unless stated the indoor callpoints are supplied as flush mount units. The range is approved for use with the standard backbox. However, SR2-T backboxes are also available.

Callpoint Spare Glasses - Current


Product Codes 515.001.119 EN54 Part 11 Spare Glass for MCP and CP series Callpoints (Pack of 5) 515.001.025 CP200/500/900 Glasses, clear English text on white background. No logo (Pack of 5). 515.001.127 Deformable operating unit "glass" for use in place of glasses, for kitchens or other areas where glass is not acceptable. For MCP callpoints only.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 51

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Prevents accidental operation of callpoints Strong polycarbonate construction Optional break seal kit

STOPPER
The callpoint STOPPER provides protection from malicious or accidental activation of manual callpoints. Available for flush or surface mounted callpoints the STOPPER is also available with optional high pitch sounder which is activated when the lid is lifted. An optional Break-Seal fitting kit allows Break-Seals to be used to provide extra protection.
Product Code 515.001.029 515.001.030 515.001.036 515.001.034 515.001.035 515.001.031 515.001.032 Ref STI6530 STI6531 STI6535 STI1230 STI3150 STI6532 STI6533 STOPPER Flush Surface 4 4 4 4

WARNING:- Break seals only to be fitted by agreement with relevant fire authorities. The STOPPER is suitable for all callpoints up to 100mm square.

STOPPER II

With Sounder

Weatherproof

4 4

4 4 4 4

STOPPER Dimensions

Product Code
515.001.033 IPO36 Break Seal Kit (pack of 1)

Flush Fit Millimetres A 137 B 140 C 104 D 45 E 12.5 F 12.5 G 185 H 12.5 Stopper STI6530 Stopper with Sounder STI6532

Surface Fit
(+30mm)

STI6531 STI6533

STOPPER STOPPER II Max. Callpoint Size 100 x 100mm 160 x 160 mm Max. Callpoint Depth 57.5 120 (+30mm Surface)

STOPPER II Dimensions

Millimetres A 70 B 16 C 197 D 50 E 178 F 146 G 228 H 254

Stopper II Surface Fit - STI1230

Chapter 2 Page 52

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Strong polycarbonate construction Will accommodate weatherproof callpoints Tamper resistant

STOPPER II
STOPPER II is constructed as the STOPPER from tough injection moulded polycarbonate. Physically larger than the STOPPER the STOPPER II extends the number of products to which these tough multi-purpose covers can protect. It consists of a strong tamper-proof clear polycarbonate cover and frame that fits easily over such products as break glass callpoints. STOPPER II can also be fitted with an integral battery powered sounder which activates if the cover is lifted. The STOPPER II is suitable for callpoints up to 160mm square.

Product Code
515.001.034

STI1230 Surface Fit STOPPER II

Features
Strong polycarbonate construction Provides environmental protection Ideal for offshore environments

Weather STOPPER & Weather STOPPER II


The Weather STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II extends the life of weather exposed devices, such as break glass callpoints, by offering protection against harsh conditions and environments. Experience has shown that this protective cover can extend the life of products installed in saline atmospheres, such as oil rigs and ship decks. While offering environmental protection the Weather STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II are constructed from tough durable polycarbonate which will also guard against tampering, vandalism or accidental operation of devices such as emergency switches.

Product Codes
515.001.036 515.001.035

STI6535 Surface fit Weather STOPPER STI3150 Surface fit Weather STOPPER II
Chapter 2 Page 53

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard
The Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard is manufactured from tough coated steel rod and is designed to protect projected beam detectors or CCTV cameras from vandalism or accidental damage. Suitable for use with System Sensor, Hochiki and Fireray 2000 detectors. Technical Specification Dimensions: 260H x 200W x 321D mm Product Code 516.015.009 STI9625 Smoke beam/CCTV guard

Keybox
This tough polycarbonate breakglass keybox is available to protect emergency keys. Product Code 515.001.043 STI6720 Keybox with printed glass

Chapter 2 Page 54

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Sounders & Beacons


Features
Wide range of both bells and electronic sounders High sound output characteristics Low current consumption Clean lines, modern styling Easy to install, low installation costs Weatherproof units for outdoor use Distinct sounds are available Motorised and Solenoid bells available Wide range of voltages available

Sounders
A range of sounders to meet a wide variety of alarm applications where loud, penetrating and distinctive warnings must be given to alert people of fire situations. In addition, multi-tone electronic sounders can give a variety of sounds to signal other conditions e.g.extinguishing gas release imminent, etc.

Note: For I.S. & Flameproof sounders, please see the special hazards section in Chapter 10.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 55

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
High output programmable sounder base and sounder beacon base One point of installation for detector, isolator, sounder & beacon Loop powered from the MX Technology Digital Loop High brightness Multi-LED Beacon Software programmable 15 Tones and 2 Flash Rates Integral line isolator RSM (Reflective Sound Monitoring) Can be used as a standalone device using the sounder blanking cap Optional surface mount plastic conduit adaptor

Sounder/Beacon and Sounder Bases


One Point of Installation Unique Solution with Huge Savings Combining a detector base, sounder, beacon and line isolator in one low cost unit will result in a dramatic reduction in the final installation cost. Typically 40% to 55% of the installation costs per point can be saved. This presents an exciting opportunity for sellers in the DDA compliant market. This is achieved without the need for specialist high cost detector heads as standard 800 series Minerva MX detectors are used. Unique When used with the 801PC 3oTec detector ADT can provide a completely unique solution combining fire detector, toxic gas detector, isolator, sounder and beacon into a single very cost effective point of installation. Reflective Sound Monitoring (RSM) Patented* Solution significantly reduces Risk Reflective Sound Monitoring is employed to monitor the audio output of the LPSB3000 and LPAV3000 by listening to the output and reporting any sounders that are not working. RSM is a Tyco patented* technology and was successfully introduced with the Minerva MX Loop powered Symphoni sounders. It is particularly beneficial during regular weekly sounder tests where users can be satisfied that all their sounders are working, even if the building is not fully occupied at the time of the test. Failure of the beacon would also generate a fault at the Minerva MX control panel. Loop Power Capacity The advanced 3000 series sounders and beacons are independently addressed and are therefore separately controllable from the Minerva MX Digital loop. The maximum number that can be driven from a single loop is dependant on the number of addresses available, the volume selected and the flash rate of the beacon. MXDesigner version 5.0 should be used to accurately determine loop loading and battery size. Typically, at full volume of 90dBA, 50 x LPSB3000 sounders or 35 x LPAV3000 sounder beacons at 0.5Hz flash rate can be driven by a single 1Km loop. That gives a typical maximum of 280 sounder beacons at full volume from a single 8 loop Minerva MX panel. Built-in Isolation As the line lsolator is now integral to the device the need for separate line isolation devices is reduced. Tones 15 Tones are available from the sounder, which include tones compatible with the LP Symphoni range, 802SB sounder base and the LPBB520 (loop powered Besson Banshee). 4 sound levels 60dB to 90dB (3dB) and 2 flash rates 1/2Hz & 1Hz are available MXConsys The AV base range of devices are fully supported by Consys Version 14 and later, the point input dialog box provides an easy method for setting the Tones, Volume and Flash rate of the device. The only operation required at the device is to set the address using the 850EMT device programmer.

Technical Specification
System Environment Temp- Operating Temp - Storage Dimensions Weight: Materials EMC For use with MX/ZX fire alarm controllers Up to 95% RH (non condensing) IP Rating 21 C EN60529 -20C to +70C -25C to +70C 102 mm dia x 42 mm high LPSB3000 0.160 kg LPAV3000 0.170 Kg Housing ABS FR & Polycarbonate The range complies with the following: Product family standard EN50130-4 in respect of conducted disturbances, radiated immunity, electrostatic discharge, fast transients and slow high energy EN61000-6-3 for emissions

Product Codes
516.800.957 516.800.958 516.800.959 557.001.040.A 557.001.040.Y LPSB3000 Sounder only L/P addressable base LPAV3000 Sounder beacon L/P addressable base DAB3-4 Mounting flange type B for conduit (supplied in packs of 10) Mark 2 Sounder Cap (ADT Branded) Mark 2 Sounder Cap (Tyco Branded)

Note: Detectors supplied separately

Chapter 2 Page 56

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Loop Powered Reduced installation costs High Output/Low consumption Lower lifetime costs Indoor and Outdoor models Same sounder tones in all areas Sounder/LED Beacon Version DDA Compliant 16 Tones and 2 Flash rates Suits individual requirements Reflective Sound Monitoring RSM - Reassurance that ALL sounders are working Integral Line Isolator Saves cost and installation time

Loop Powered Symphoni Sounders and Sounder Beacons


Models Available The Sounder only models are available with a red or white housing suitable for indoor use and an IP65 rated red housing for outdoor applications. The Audio / Visual models, which incorporate a highly efficient LED beacon, are also available with a red or white housing for indoor use and an IP65 rated red housing for outdoor applications. Reflective Sound Monitoring Up to now sounder circuits have been monitored up to the EOL but not the individual sounders, fault detection has relied on human feedback from the weekly tests that should be carried out to meet the requirements of BS5839. The LP Symphoni utilising Reflective Sound Monitoring (RSM) employs a transducer to actively monitor the units sound output during the weekly sounder test and will report back to the MX controller if it fails to detect the sounder operating when it has been commanded to, this ensures that the LP Symphoni range of sounders will in the unlikely event of a fault, display it immediately on the fire controller and is therefore not dependant upon the staff within a building reporting a sounder failure. Built-in Isolation As the line lsolator is now integral to the device the need for separate line isolation devices is reduced. Tones 16 Tones are available from the sounder, which include tones compatible with the 802SB sounder base and the LPBB520 (loop powered Besson Banshee). Dutch slow whoop and the DIN 1Hz sweep are included.Two sound levels 103dB & 90dB (3dB). MXConsys The LP Symphoni range of devices will be fully supported by Consys Version 10 and later, the point input dialog box provides an easy method for setting the Tones, Volume and Flash rate of the device. The only operation required at the device is to set the address using the 850EMT device programmer.

Technical Specification
Operating temp Indoor devices -10C to +55C Outdoor devices -20C to +70C IP rating Indoor devices IP21C Outdoor devices IP65 EMC Product family standard EN50130-4 in respect of Conducted Disturbances, Radiated Immunity, Electrostatic Discharge, Fast Transients and Slow High Energy EN61000-6-3 for Emissions

Product Codes
516.800.960 516.800.961 516.800.962 516.800.963 516.800.964 516.800.965 LPSY800-R L/P Symphoni (indoor use) red LPSY800-W LP Symphoni (indoor use) white LPSY865 L/P Symphoni IP65 (out door use) LPAV800-R L/P Symphoni Sounder/Beacon (indoor use) red LPAV800-W L/P Symphoni Sounder/Beacon (indoor use) white LPAV865 L/P Symphoni Sounder/ Beacon IP65 (outdoor use)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 57

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Solenoid Operated Designed for Long Life Stove Enamelled Dome

6 Red Solenoid Operated Friedland Bell


The bells are the underdome type, with a high resonance pressed alloy-steel gong to ensure a loud clear ring tone. The operating mechanism is fully enclosed and the gong is red stove enamelled for long life. The bells are designed for internal use, but gasket sealed conduit boxes can be provided for external use.

Product Code
576.500.014 240V Red bell 6 240Vac solenoid operated. Fire text

Features
CE marked Low current 6 bell (ONLY 11mA) Low cost Extra high 95dBA/m Slim profile (53mm) Fully suppressed and polarised Quick and easy to install LPCB approved to EN54 Pt 3

6 & 8 Motorised Bells


Model MBF-6EV MBF-8EV MBA 8EV Rated Voltage 24V d.c. 24V d.c. 24V d.c. Rated Current 11mA 17mA 18mA Sound output 90-95dBA 90-97dBA 91-97dBA Operating Temp -12 to +50C -10 to +50C Colour Red Weight 410g 640g 1100g with back box

Product Codes
576.501.039.A 576.501.039.T 576.501.040.A 576.501.044.A 576.501.044.T 576.501.045 MBF-6EV ADT Branded MBF-6EV Thorn Branded MBF-8EV ADT Branded MBA-8EV ADT Branded MBA-8EV Thorn Branded BBX4 (2) W/P Backbox for MBA-8 Bell

Chapter 2 Page 58

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Weatherproof Option Flexible Mounting Option Attractive Design

Electronic Solenoid Bell


Unique patented alarm bell with miniature solenoid and integrated electronic control. No backbox required for surface wiring.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Voltage: Typical Current: Typ. Sound Output: 6 diameter 18-30Vdc 24Vdc@30mA 94dB (A)@1m

Product Codes
20-100 20-101 20-111 576.501.407 576.501.408 6 24Vdc Electronic bell, weatherproof IP33C - Wormald Branded 6 24Vdc Electronic bell - red IP21C - Wormald Branded 6 24Vdc Electronic bell - white IP21C MED 6 24Vdc Electronic bell, weatherproof IP33C MED 6 24Vdc Electronic bell - red IP21C

Marine Approved Products

Features
Low Current Concumption Suppressed and Polarised Sturdy Construction

CF Motorised Bells
The CF Motorised bells are low current, fully supressed and polarised.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Colour: Output Voltage: Typical Current: Tycpical Sound Output: 6 & 8 Diameter available Red 20-28Vdc 25/28mA @ 24Vdc 95/97dB (A) @ 1m

Product Codes
Marine Approved Products

576.501.405 576.501.406

MED 6 Red 24Vdc Motorised bell, Fire text with Thorn Branding MED 8 Red 24Vdc Motorised bell, Fire text with Thorn Branding

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 59

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Modern aesthetic design 32 Selectable tones 3 Volume settings Push and twist mount Shallow and deep bases Available in red or white Low current consumption 2 Stage alarm available Independently switched sounder or beacon Xenon beacon with the Excel Lite

Banshee Excel Sounders


The Banshee Excel sounder replaces the Banshee Multi Tone range of Sounders. It uses the same technically superior rocking arm transducer to reproduce the familiar 32 tones of the previous Banshee and Bedlam ranges.

Banshee Excel Lite Sounder Beacon


The new Banshee Excel adds the Banshee Excel Lite Sounder Beacon to its range using a high output xenon with the familiar sounder. The Banshee Excel Lite can be used as a multi stage device by switching the beacon and the sounder independently using a third wire.

Technical Specification
Approvals: LPCB & VdS approved to EN54-3 Tones available: 32 Operating voltage: 9-30Vdc Tone current consumption: See Tone Table in Chapter 11 Flash current consumption: 40mA Operating temperature range (Deg C): -40 to +70 Volume control via DIL switch: Maximum, Medium (-10dBA), Low (-20dBA) Flash rate per second: 1 Ingress Protection: IP45 or IP66 Termination: Screw terminals for 028mm2 to 2.5mm2 wire conductor

Product Codes
576.501.060 576.501.061 576.501.062 576.501.063 Banshee Excel sounder, red, IP45 (replaces 576.501.005.A & 576.501.005.T) Banshee Excel sounder, white, IP45 (replaces 576.501.009 & 576.501.025.A) Banshee Excel sounder, red, IP66 (replaces 576.501.016.A & 576.501.016.T) Banshee Excel Lite, red sounder, red xenon beacon, IP45

Chapter 2 Page 60

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Accessories
The combined mounting bracket for the Besson Multi-tone Banshee and Xenon Beacon allows quick and neat installation of combined sounders and beacons. The bracket allows the following electronic sounders to be mounted with the range of 1W Xenon Beacons: Besson Banshee MINERVA FIRECRYER voice enhanced sounder The bracket can be used with any of the 24Vd.c 1W Xenon beacons in red, clear, amber or blue (Part no.'s 540.001.030/031/032 & 033) Product Code 576.501.047 Banshee/Xenon bracket

Besson Wafer Sounder


The standard Besson Wafer sounder is supplied in white with a blank cover included. The specification is as follows: Input voltage: 24V d.c. (+/-25%) Sound Output: 60dBA/90dBA at 1m typical (pot. Adjustable) offering the same sound formats as the Banshee sounder range. It can therefore be used in conjunction with the Banshee sounders on the same site. Technical Specification Current: 4mA to 15mA Temperature Range: -40C to + 70C Dimensions: Dia 103mm, Height 22mm (excluding coverplate) Product Code 576.501.038 Besson wafer sounder and blank cover in white

Flush Mount Bedroom Sounder


Meeting the requirements for BS5839 part 1, the Bedroom Sounder range is well suited to hotels and residential environments where aesthetics is a prime concern. Matching the sound output of the Banshee range of sounders so therefore they can be mixed on the same site. Features Low current consumption 7mA Dual sound options selected via a jumper switch: Continuous and Fast Sweep 90dB Can be both Flush and Surface mounted Robust terminal connectors to accommodate up to 2.5mm2 conductors Product Codes 576.501.032.A Flush Mount Sounder ADT Branded 576.501.032.T Flush Mount Sounder Thorn Branded

Yodalarms
This versatile range of sounders are ideally suited for fire, safety and security hazard warning. Technical Specification Dimensions: YO3: 89H x 89W x 85D mm YO5: 134H x 134W x 128D mm YO8: 216H x 216W x 153D mm Product Codes 576.501.001 YO3 Yodalarm 3 24Vdc 100dB @ 1Mtr 576.501.002 YO5 Yodalarm 5 24Vdc 106dB @ 1Mtr 576.501.003 YO8 Yodalarm 8 24Vdc 112dB @ 1Mtr

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 61

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


24Vdc Symphoni Sounder
The 24Vdc Symphoni Sounder is a general purpose internal sounder, available either as a very high output sounder for noisy areas, or a high output low current sounder for applications where power is limited. Both versions share the same horn and backbox which has double cable entries for ease of installation. The low power version has 3 selectable tones which may be employed for one, two or three stage alarm applications. The high output version has 32 selectable tones and retains full tone compatibility with the Roshni, Squashni and Askari product ranges. Product Codes 576.501.200 SY/R Low Power Red Symphoni Sounder (3 tone) 576.501.201 SY/W Low Power White Symphoni Sounder (3 tone) 576.501.202 SYHO/R High Output Red Symphoni Sounder (32 tone) 576.501.203 SYHO/W High Output White Symphoni Sounder (32 tone)

Technical Specification
Model Operation Operating Voltage Range Sound Output @ 1m Volume Control Current Consumption Tones Symphoni High Output 2 Hours Continuous 9-28Vdc Up to 120dB(A) 240mA +/- 20mA on Tone 3 1 to 32 Symphoni (Low Power) Continuous 12-30Vdc 100dB(A) +/- 2dB(A) @24Vd. c. Down to 80dB approx. 5mA +/- 1mA at all volumes Alternating 990Hz/650Hz@2Hz Continuous 990Hz Intermittent 990Hz, On/Off@1Hz Synchronised Start +/- 0.5% -25C to +70C Polarised Input ABS Plastic Case IP42 0.212Kg

Synchronisation Frequency Stability Operating Temperature Line Monitoring Method Construction Ingress Protection Weight

Synchronised Start +/- 0.15% -25 C to +55C Polarised Input ABS Plastic Case IP42 0.58Kg

Roshni
A flexible alarm sounder for Fire and Security applications complete with volume control and dil switch to provide 32 tones. Low profile Roshni with Deep base offers IP65 protection. All Roshni sounders have synchronised start for self synchronisation without third wire. Product Codes ROSHRDSR ROSHNI Sounder c/w deep base red 576.501.220 ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base red 576.501.221 ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base white 576.501.222 ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - Red 576.501.223 ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - White Marine Approved Products 576.501.401 MED W/P ROSHNI Sounder c/w deep base-red 576.501.402 MED ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base-red

Technical Specification Dimensions: 93 Dia x 105D mm (Deep base) Red or white Colour: Output Voltage: 9-28Vdc Typical Current: 24Vdc@16mA Typ. Sound Output: @1m 102dB

Chapter 2 Page 62

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Single Message or Multiple Message using the same sounder Multi Message facilitates multi evacuation strategies Clear and unambiguous alarm messages Voice Alarm Messages provoke an immediate response Sound Output Up to 100db(A) (Fire-Cryer Plus), 90db(A) (Mini Fire-Cryer Plus), 110db(A) (Midi FireCryer Plus) Optional integral Red Strobe Low current consumption average 20mA No special wiring easily retro fitted Fully synchronised over multi zones Deep base version available to IP66 Ultra slim base sounder to fit industry standard detectors Suitable for ceiling or wall mounting (Mini Fire-Cryer Plus) Optional front plate for stand alone use (Mini Fire-Cryer Plus) Voice Message Controller makes manual message switching easy

Fire-Cryer Plus - Voice Enhanced Sounders


The Fire-Cryer Plus range of voice sounders are electronic sounders which are pre-programmed with 9 messages. Each of the Fire-Cryer voice sounders can be used as a single message voice sounder by simply installing them on to a conventional 24Vdc sounder circuit or by using a sounder controller on a loop. The choice of message(s) broadcast can be selected using a DIL switch on the rear of the sounder. See Table A The Fire-Cryer Plus offers an excellent service upgrade opportunity for systems as well as a highly flexible and cost effective solution to providing a voice evacuation system to many buildings. The choice of Fire-Cryer voice sounders can be selected using Table B Messages 1 to 7 in Table A can be used in a multi message installation with the addition of a Multi Message Switching PCB (576.501.171) or a Voice Message Controller (576.501.181 or 576.501.182) interfaced between the fire alarm control panel and the sounder circuits. The Voice Message Controllers can be supplied with a 2.5A or 5.25A power supply built in. A Zone Extension PCB (576.501.172) is available to extend the system to 4 zones or 8 sounder circuits. See Table C A special Extinguishing PCB (576.501.173) used with the 576.501.135 will enable 1st, 2nd Stage, Hold and Gas Released messages to be automatically broadcast dependent on the state of the alarm. See Table A1

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 63

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Fire-Cryer Plus Multi Message PCB
Product Code

576.501.171

Fire-Cryer Plus Multi Message PCB

Fire-Cryer Plus Zone Extension PCB


Product Code

576.501.172

Fire-Cryer Plus Zone Extension PCB

Fire-Cryer Plus Extinguishing PCB


Product Code

576.501.173

Fire-Cryer Plus Extinguishing PCB

VMC / Multi Message PCB and 2.5A PSU


Product Code

576.501.181

VMC / Multi Message PCB and 2.5A PSU

VMC / Multi Message / Zone Extension PCB and 5.25A PSU


Product Code

576.501.182

VMC / Multi Message / Zone Extension PCB and 5.25A PSU

Chapter 2 Page 64

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Technical Specification
Fire-Cryer Plus Model Fire-Cryer Plus VDC Operating Voltage 20-28 Current mA @ 24VDC Peak/Avg - Sounder only 27/20 Current mA @ 24VDC Typical: Sounder with low current strobe 33/26 Current mA @ 24VDC Typical: Sounder with high current strobe 52/60 Current mA @ 24VDC Low current strobe only 13 Current mA @ 24VDC High current strobe only 32 Strobe Output Cd (LOW) 2 Strobe Output Cd (HIGH) 6 Volume Adjustment from Max. dBA Output to max output -18dBA 82 to 100 Weatherproofing (IP66 requires Deep Base) IP45 or IP66 Housing Material ABS Temperature Range C Colour Connections Midi 20-28 180/100 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 101 to 110 IP44 Aluminium/ Plastic Base -25 to +70 -10 to +55 -25 to +70 Red or White White Red Screw TB 1.5mm Screw TB 1.5mm Clamp 2.5mm2 Mini 20-28 27/20 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 72 to 90 n/a ABS

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 65

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Standard Message Set which consists of 9 pre-programmed messages with tones (See Table A)

When used as a Multi Message sounder DIL Switches 4, 5, 6, 7 and 8 are OFF. When used as a single messa sounder use the DIL Switch settings in the table below 1 = ON, 0 = OFF When used as a Multi Message Sounder the Multi Message Switching PCB (576.501.171) will assign the messages to the following triggers: Starting Tone (See Table (A2) below)

Table A

Two Letter Message Code

Beacon Flashes Y/N

Speech Message

SW6

SW4

SW5

Message 1 1 AK Y Fire emergency. Please remain calm and evacuate the building immediately S1A/S1B 1 Message 2 2 AB Y This is a fire alert. This is a fire alert. Await further instructions. Await further instructions. MA 0 Message 3 2 MA Y Standby alert. Close all blinds and move to the middle of the room. MB 1 Message 4 0 AD N All clear. All clear. No further action required. MC 0 Message 5 0 SP N This is an ADT fire test. No action required. MD 1 Message 6 3 CC N This is a class change announcement. ME 0 Message 7 1 AF Y Fire detected. Keep calm. Leave the building by the nearest exit. MF 1 Message 8 2 AZ Y Ladies and gentlemen due to unforeseen circumstances we must ask you to leave the building immediately by the nearest exit or as directed by members of staff. 0 Message 9 2 AX Y We have an emergency situation. Please leave the building by the nearest exit. Members of staff will assist you. 1

0 1 1 0 0 1 1

0 0 0 1 1 1 1

SW7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1

0 0

0 0

Table A1

GAS EXTINGUISHANT MESSAGES (Used with 576.501.135) Starting Tone (See Table (A2) below)

Two Letter Message Code

Beacon Flashes Y/N

Speech Message

1st Stage 2nd Stage Hold Gas Released

2 2 0 1

CG CH LU CJ

Y Y N Y

First stage extinguishant release warning. Second stage extinguishant release warning. Extinguishant gas release on hold. Extinguishant released.

Table A2 Tone 0 1 2 3

No tone Banshee LF Fast Sweep. 800Hz to 950Hz swept @ 9hz Banshee LF Fast Sweep. 800Hz to 950Hz swept @ 9hz Pulsed at 1 second ON, 1 second OFF Bell tone, pulsed

SW8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Chapter 2 Page 66

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Ordering Fire-Cryer Plus Voice Sounders
Step 1 - Choose your Fire-Cryer Sounder

Table B Type Wall Mount Body Colour Beacon Red Red None Wall Mount Wall Mount White Red Red None Red Base Shallow Deep Shallow Deep Shallow Shallow Shallow Part Ref. 576.501.131 576.501.132 576.501.133 576.501.134 576.501.141 576.501.142 576.501.135

Wall Mount Base Mount

Red White

None None

Deep n/a

576.501.151 576.501.161

Step 2 - Choose your Interfaces for Multi Message Systems Table C Standard Multi Message Switching PCB Zone Extension PCB (adds 3 Zones of 2 Sounder Circuits i.e. 6 sounder circuits. Must be used with 576.501.171) Extinguishant Interface PCB 576.501.171 576.501.172 576.501.173

Voice Message Controllers & PSUs (All VMC enclosures include a 576.501.171) 576.501.171 576.501.172 PSU Box Size Part Ref Yes No 2.5A M2 576.501.181 Yes Yes 5.25A M3 576.501.182 Box Sizes M2 Enclosure 385W x 310H x 90D mm M3 Enclosure 385W x 520H x 90D mm

Product Codes
576.501.131 576.501.132 576.501.133 576.501.134 576.501.135 576.501.141 576.501.142 576.501.151 576.501.161 576.501.171 576.501.172 576.501.173 576.501.181 576.501.182 576.501.191 Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red wall mounted, shallow base, red beacon Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red wall mounted, deep base, red beacon Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red, wall mounted, shallow base Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red, wall mounted, deep base Standard Fire-Cryer Plus (for use with 576.501.173 in Gas Extinguishant systems) Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, white wall mounted, shallow base, red beacon Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, white, wall mounted, shallow base Midi Fire-Cryer Plus, c/w back box, red Mini Fire-Cryer Plus, base mounted, white, c/w cover Fire-Cryer Plus Multi Message PCB Fire-Cryer Plus Zone Extension PCB Fire-Cryer Plus Extinguishing PCB Voice Message Controller c/w Multi Message PCB and 2.5A PSU Voice Message Controller c/w Multi Message PCB, Zone Extension PCB and 5.25A PSU Fire-Cryer Plus Demo Unit

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 67

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Single Gang Lamp/Buzzer Units
Lamp Buzzer units may be used for local alarms when high level audible warnings may not be appropriate. Available in flush and surface mount versions to fit standard single gang backboxes. Features Low Current Flush or Surface Mount Hi-Brightness LED Technical Specification Dimensions: 90H x 90W x 40D mm Current Rating: 15mA at 24Vdc nominally Product Codes 540.011.012 Single gang flush mount LED (red)/Buzzer Unit labelled Fire Alarm 540.011.013 Single gang surface mount LED (red)/Buzzer Unit labelled Fire Alarm c/w surface backbox.

Solista LED Beacon


Ultra low power requirement 3mA or 6mA at 24Vdc. Long life low profile design. Protected to IP54, supplied complete with base. Product Code 576.501.230 Solista LED Beacon (Red)

Easy AVTM Retrofit LED Beacon


This low power LED beacon is designed to be retrofitted to existing Banshee electronic sounders. Easy and fast installation typically 3 min. Low power 6mA max at 24Vdc.High Output LEDs. Product Code 576.501.012 Easy AV strobe for Banshee Sounders

Chapter 2 Page 68

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Available in 1, 2, 3 and 5 watts Protected to IP65 Attractive low profile design Optional bracket for mounting both Beacon and Banshee Sounder

Xenon Beacons - 24V Including Surface Mount Adaptor


This high quality range of Xenon beacons are tested to IP 65 making them ideal for the most stringent applications. Each beacon incorporates a low profile Fresnel lens designed to give maximum light output.

Technical Specification
Voltage V d.c. 24 24 24 24 Power Output Alarm Current Watt(s) mA 1 42 2 84 3 126 5 210 Flash Rate 60/min 60/min 60/min 60/min Rating IP65 IP65 IP65 IP65 Temp. Range Height -30 to +70C -30 to +70C -30 to +70C -30 to +70C Dimensions (mm) Diameter 51 75 51 75 51 75 75 90

Product Codes
540.001.030 540.001.031 540.001.032 540.001.033 20-112 20-113 20-120 Low Low Low Low Low Low Low profile profile profile profile profile profile profile clear 24Vdc 1 watt blue 24Vdc 1 watt amber 24Vdc 1 watt red 24Vdc 1 watt red 24Vdc 2 watt red 24Vdc 5 watt red 24Vdc 3 watt

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 69

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
Combined strobe & sounder Matches Roshni sounders Weather Resistant to IP65

Flashni
A combined sounder and beacon which combines the features of the Roshni electronic sounder with a fully integrated Xenon beacon. These sounders are fully compatible with all Roshni tones.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: 93 Dia x 92D mm (Shallow base) 93 Dia x 121D mm (Deep base) 18-30Vdc 68mA@24Vdc 101dB (A)@1m

Product Codes
20-118 576.501.224 Combined Roshni sounder/strobe complete with deep base (IP65). Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red Body/Red Lens complete with shallow base & tone switch. Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red Body/Red Lens, deep base, tone switch & separate sounder/strobe operation.

Output Voltage: Typical Current: Typ. Sound Output:

576.501.227

Marine Approved Product

576.501.403

MED Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red Body/Red Lens complete with shallow base

Features

.

Combined Sounder and LED Beacon Low Current -10mA @ 24VDC 6 selectable tones Volume control (2 levels) White housing, clear lens with red LEDs DDA compliant audio visual solution for UK Neat unobtrusive design Ideal for hotels, care homes, schools & offices Independent power cables allow a large number of AV platform sounders to be driven from a single 24V circuit 90dB sound output >1Cd light output at 1 Hz Approved to EN54-3

Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon


This low current combined sounder/beacon is ideal for standalone usage utilising the optional blanking cap or can be used in conjunction with a 4 base and detector. When used with a detector it will provide a single point of installation for the detector, sounder and beacon. This is a conventional sounder / beacon and needs to be powered from the panel sounder outputs or a sounder module.

Product Codes
576.501.250 576.501.255 517.050.401 517.050.005 Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon Squashni G3/AV Blanking Cap Pack of 5 4 Universal Base 4 Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)

Chapter 2 Page 70

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology Software Tools & Accessories


MX Technology Fire controllers are supported by a comprehensive suite of software programmes which provide key features to enable fast and accurate configuration and commissioning of the MX systems.

MXChecker
MXChecker - MXChecker replaces, in software, all configured MX loop devices on a single panel. It offers a user the following major functionality: Connection to a panel directly, or indirectly via the MXNetwork (in the same way Consys does to perform a download/upload). Provides the input status of each and every device configured on the Loops, e.g. make a Sounder go No Response, a detector appear active, etc. The ability to display the General Status of each and every Point configured on the Loops, e.g.indicate a Sounder is Isolated, a Callpoint is Disarmed, a Detector is Resetting, etc. The ability to display the Output Status of each and every Point configured on the Loops, e.g. indicate a Sounder is being driven to P1, a Relay Module is not being driven, etc.

MXConsys
MXConsys, the highly flexible and extremely powerful programming tool that has been used successfully with MX systems since day one. Specially designed for MX it is constantly being extended and refined to meet ever changing demands. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and Security Website but requires a dongle and license to operate. Incorporated into MXConsys is MXConsys-Express An alternative approach to system configuration that simplifies the programming effort by automating many of the processes. Its heart lies in a number of pre-defined templates that have been expertly designed to match a selection of building types. The demands on users in terms of experience and training are considerably reduced.

MXLogger
MXLogger MXLogger enables the engineer to selectively monitor any device or devices on the addressable loops. The returned values are displayed on a PC screen and can be saved to a file for later analysis. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and Security Website.

MXDesigner
MXDesigner is a sophisticated engineering design tool that not only ensures system parameters and design rules are obeyed but are key to the ordering and documentation processes. Battery calculations, loop loading calculations, remote bus parameters, system schematics and parts lists are all included. The extensive use of graphics and 'drag and drop' techniques makes the system easy and quick to use. In addition, a design module for the intrinsically safe MXDigital detectors and associated system 800 components is included. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and Security Website.

MXRemote
MXRemote - Remote communications software provides a fast and efficient means of diagnosis without anyone having to leave the office. In situations where access to a site may be difficult or where an attending technician requires high level assistance then MXRemote is the tool for the job. Using modems, MXRemote can link to the MXDigital fire system via PSTN or IP and once connected, becomes an integral part of the fire system, acting as a fully functional repeater. All system functions are then available to the MXRemote operator. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and Security Website but requires a dongle and license to operate.

MXFlow
MXFlow - If you have ever been involved in the configuration process for a complex 'cause and effect' programme, you will appreciate the benefits of an automated method of documenting your work. MXFlow does just that; it takes your MXConsys 'event action' and transcribes it into a graphical format that is comprehensive and easy to follow. It can be a valuable commissioning tool that saves time and effort as well as an easily understood form of documentation for future service use. Available for free download from the Tyco Fire and Security Website to authorised personnel.

MXService Tool
The TYCO MXService tool is a powerful and flexible tool for assistance in the installation, commissioning, diagnostics and service of Tyco MX detection systems. The MXService tool allows all MX addressable devices to be interrogated, tested and programmed. Suitable for desktop or single handed operation the MXService tool is battery operated using standard rechargeable batteries.

MXLoop Tester
The MXLoop Tester can test, commission and fault-find a loop of up to 250 MX analogue addressable detectors/devices, without a fire panel. A laptop is generally used for operation & display, but a One Person Installation Mode is automatically enabled on power up. Identifies all devices on the loop, determining addresses and types. Over-addressed (>250), unknown device types, and, generally, duplicate addressed devices are recognised. Monitors analogue values of all detectors/modules on the loop to determine device status: normal/alarm/fault/dirty etc.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 71

Chapter 2 - MZX Technology


Features
MZX Product Line Overview. Key Terms & Conditions. Key Functions & Features. System Display and Controls. Set Time and Date. Enter Pass Codes Customer Operator Access Levels. Accept Fire Alarm Events. Accept Incoming Events. Walk Test. Isolate Detectors. Isolate Field Devices. View Status of a Loop Device. View Event Log. Interpret System Faults. Carry out Routine Testing.

MZX Interactive Training CD


An Operator Training CD which contains an interactive training programme that provides information on the MZX Fire Detection System.

Product Code
TCD-1 MZX Interactive Training CD

Chapter 2 Page 72

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Features
Programs the system across multiple sub-panels Downloads to the system from one point Provides Firmware download as well as configuration download Dongle protected Provides full project configuration printouts. Includes MX consys express

MXConsys
MXConsys is a powerful Windows programming tool which provides full system programming functions and project configuration and issue control. MXConsys is used on MINERVA MX, MX2,T2000 & MZX panels. It also supports automatic data transfer to MXGraph & TXG graphical mimic and alarm management systems. MXConsys is available under document control from authorised personnel in the Tyco businesses.

Product Codes
557.203.001 557.203.003 557.202.118 MXConsys Dongle and license (parallel) MXConsys Dongle and license (USB) MXConsys Download lead

Features
Facilitates remote diagnostics Display identical to panel view Remote Assistance

MXRemote
MXRemote is a Windows based software tool for remote service and support of MX detection panels. MXRemote provides a full function fire panel repeater running on a PC either locally or over dial up telephone lines or via the internet. Providing the operator has the correct passwords MXRemote allows all operator, manager, service and engineer functions available at the panel to be provided at the PC. This allows the customer or the Tyco service organisation to provide remote assistance, service and limited configuration assistance to the installation. MXRemote is available as a stand-alone software application for Tyco service operations. Alternatively Tyco Safety Products are able to provide consultancy and assistance in implementing MXRemote as an integrated part of a central station and service centre system.

Product Codes
557.203.002 557.203.004 557.202.116 UDS1100 MXRemote dongle and license (parallel) MXRemote Dongle and license (USB) MX-FIM Modem Lead Lantronics Device Server LAN

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 73

Chapter 2 - MX Technology Programming and Service Tools


Features
Simplifies installation and commissioning Reduces the possibility of engineer error Improves health and safety by removing the need to work at height Provides peace of mind through evidence based digital reporting

850EMT Engineering Management Tool


The engineering management tool communicates with the 850 series and 830 series devices using a 2 way infrared wireless link. Commissioning data is held within the 850 EMT and the technician will be prompted to select and confirm configuration details resulting in an evidence based commissioning document that can be downloaded from the programmer.

Technical Specification
2 way wireless infrared communication with detectors TFT colour touch screen display Save time with One Visit Commissioning (OVC) Facilitates evidence based commissioning Read/write the detector/ancillary address Display and confirm zone and point strings Display temperature/ CO levels / smoke obscuration Programme the device LED Initiate detector self verification test Display detector dirtiness level Control ancillary outputs Read ancillary statuses Compatible with all 800 series devices

Product Codes
516.850.900 516.850.905 WWQ252379 SP120941 516.800.922 516.800.924 516.800.923 850EMT engineering management tool Pack of 5 replacement stylus 2GB USB memory stick 3m RJ11 panel to 850EMT cable Spare ancillary programming lead Pack of 10 spare pins for ancillary lead Accessory kit (Carry case, shoulder strap & car 12v adaptor)

Chapter 2 Page 74

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Features
Compact Organises Tools Sturdy Construction Protects Tools

MXService Accessory Kit


A carry case which contains the following items:Car Lighter Adapter Shoulder Strap This provides space for the following:850EMT Engineer Management Tool Ancillary Programming Lead Mains Charger

Product Code
516.800.923 850EMT Engineer Management Tool accessory kit

Features
Pre-Programmed with latest AVR firmware Powered from XLM Loop card or FIM, No external power required Simple to operate Compact handheld device Complete with ribbon cable and connector

MZX AVR Programmer


This unit will allows the MZX Technology Fire Controller Loop Drivers to be updated to the latest software version. When required upgrades can be performed easily and quickly in the field with minimal system downtime. The MZX AVR Programmer is designed for use with MX,MZX,ZX and T2000 addressable fire controllers, please check document 17-05-AVR for compatibility details.

Technical Specification
2 Button Keypad 3 Status LEDs Operating Temperature 0C to 50C Size 189 x 80 x 31

Product Code
516.800.941 Tyco MZX AVR Programmer

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 75

Chapter 2 - MX Technology
Features
Ability to commission loops without a panel Verify installed loops before connection to panel Fault find loops whilst disconnected from panel

MXLoop Tester
The MX Loop Tester can test, commission and fault-find a loop of up to 250 MX digital addressable detectors/devices, without a fire panel. A laptop is generally used for operation & display, but a One Person Installation Mode is automatically enabled on power up. Identifies all devices on the loop, determining addresses and types. Over-addressed (>250), unknown device types, and, generally, duplicate addressed devices are recognised. Monitors analogue values of all detectors/modules on the loop to determine device status: normal/alarm/fault/dirty etc. Provides alarm test for detectors that support it. Allows Walk Test. Any device going into alarm is shown on the laptop with address and time. Walk Test Status (devices not tested yet) can be requested. Walk test mode overrides detection algorithm delays for fast testing. Monitors loop current and status, identifying open / short and over-current conditions. Details devices present on each side of break (so that position of break or tripped isolator can be determined). Includes commands to operate device LED and control output modules (relays and sounders). Turns on LED of faulty detectors (when there is no alarm) to aid visual identification. Automatic addressing mode allows un-programmed devices to be added in sequence and be automatically addressed. Detailed diagnostics and commissioning modes via laptop.

Technical Specification
Powered from 110V/230V mains supply via 24V, 3A plug pack, or from 24V batteries (batteries not included). Dimensions Unit: 200mm x122mm x 46mm Carry Bag: 250mm x 250mm x 70mm Weight: 2 kg (without battery)

Product Codes
557.203.021 557.203.022 557.203.023 557.203.024 557.203.026 MXLoop tester with EUROPEAN/UK MAINS to IEC CABLE SPARE ECM prog DB6 (FEM) - DB9 (FEM) null modem Spare carry bag with 2 pockets and strap Spare PSU 90-264VAC IN/24VDC 3A out Spare MX loop tester battery lead set

Features
Lightweight Convenient Compact

MX Service Case
There are 11 main circuit boards shared between the Minerva MX4000 and MX2 Control Panels, Repeater Panels and Black Box Panels. The MX Service Case is designed to hold one of each board in a convenient lightweight and portable case that will protect the boards whilst taking the minimum amount of space in a service engineers vehicle. The case also contains a fault finding manual. The MX Service Case allows a service engineer to carry onto site, sufficient spares to effect a panel repair efficiently and in a professional manner. It will avoid unnecessary return trips to the service vehicle or branch to collect spares and negates the need to carry cumbersome panels & enclosures in service vehicles.

Product Code
557.202.298 Chapter 2 Page 76 Fire Catalogue MX Service Case 02/12

Chapter 2 - MX Technology Service & Spares


Keys & Keyswitches 557.203.005 Set of spare keys for MX Panel (AL102) 557.180.209 Keyswitch assembly for use with MX2 controllers (spare) 557.180.208 MX2 Spare Keys 557.201.508 MZX Spare Key Set Housings & Metalwork 557.201.300 BFP801Blank Half Module - Grey Overlay 557.201.306 Standard MX Expansion backbox and chassis plate 557.201.310 Deep MX Expansion backbox and chassis plate 557.202.206 MX2 expansion aperture installation kit CPU FIMs & Loop Cards 557.202.000 FIM801 1-Loop Field I/F Module 557.202.001 FIM802 2-Loop Field I/F Module 557.202.008 FIM801CV T2000CV only 557.202.007 XLM800 2-Loop Expansion Card 557.202.002 CPU800 Central Processor Unit Power Supplies 557.202.003 PSM800 Power Supply Unit 557.202.004 LBM800 Loop Booster Module PCB 557.202.403 PSM800M Marine approved PSU 557.202.405 PSB800M Marine approved PSU c/w Loop Booster 557.202.210 PSU830 Power Supply with Loop Booster 557.202.208 MX2 8 Loop Expansion kit 557.201.210 Dual power supply mounting kit 557.202.050 PSM800 Temp Sensor Accessory Kit 557.202.113 PSB to FIM Cable 557.202.608 PMM800 Power monitor module 557.202.609 BAQ60T24 2.5A MZX PSU 557.202.610 BAQ140T24 5A MZX PSU 557.202.611 PMM805 Power Monitor Module - 5V Repeater 557.202.612 PMM840 Power Monitor Module - 40V Loop Power Indication & Expansion 557.202.013 OCM800 Operator Control Module 557.202.019 ODM800 Operator Display Module 557.202.021 ANN840 40-Way Alarm/Fault LED Module 557.202.022 ANN880 80-Way Alarm LED Module 557.202.020 COM820 20-Way Status/Command Module 557.202.200 DCM800 MX2 Display Control Module (without LCD assy) 557.202.601 DCM816 16 zone display PCB for MZX125 557.202.602 DCM832 32 zone display PCB for MZX250/251/252 557.202.209 MX2 LCD assembly 557.202.028 RSM800 Power Supply 557.180.053 RBUS Driver Chip 557.180.052 Serial Printer Driver Kit 557.202.613 DCM864R Spare Display / Control PCB for MZX 253 (64 red zonal LEDs) Callpoint Key & Glasses 515.001.045 MCP test key 515.001.119 MCP EN54 Spare Glasses pk of 5 MX Service Tool 516.800.922 MX Service tool, Spare programming lead 516.800.924 MX Service tool, Spare pins for programming lead pk of 10 MX Loop Tester 557.203.022 MX 557.203.023 MX 557.203.024 MX 557.203.026 MX

Loop Loop Loop Loop

Tester ECM Prog Null Modem Tester Carry Bag tester PSU Tester Battery lead set

Flammable Gas Detector 516.100.051 Spare Flammable Gas Detector Sensor 516.100.052 Spare Flammable Gas Detector PCB

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 2 Page 77

Chapter 2 - MX Technology

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 2 Page 78

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Control Panels and Repeater Panels


Features
2, 4 and 8 zone versions available. Supports the complete range of EN54 approved series 600 detectors including photo multi-sensor and CO multi-sensor. Supports Tyco twin wire sounders on all eight detection zones. Drives up to 3 repeater panels (4 and 8 zone panels). Access to controls via key switch. Space for 2 x 3.4 A/H batteries providing up to 72 hour standby. Remote control inputs for class change, alert, evacuate, silence alarms and reset. Zone 1 configurable for latching or non latching. Selectable zonal or general alarm sounder operation. Alert sounder option. Configurable zone co-incidence for automatic detectors. Fully monitored fire signalling output. Single pole volt free change over fire relay output. Single pole volt free change over fail safe fault relay output. Short circuit fire option. Auxiliary 24VDC 250mA power supply output. Open collector output for buzzer active, disablement active and evacuate active. Earth fault monitoring. Zone/Output disablement for each zone, fire signal output and all sounders. Buzzer disable feature. One man zone test. One man sounder test. Automatic fire detector and manual alarm call point fire event discrimination. Alarm counter. Compatible with diode bases for detector removal.

Minerva MZX-c
The Minerva MZX-c range of conventional twin wire fire alarm control panels will satisfy a wide range of applications from 2 to 8 zones and have many features that are normally associated with more expensive addressable systems. The Minerva MZX-c range of conventional fire detection control panels are designed to be both installer and user friendly. A high degree of flexibility and programmability allows the systems to be customised without the need for any configuration software. The range consists of 2, 4 and 8 zone panels together with an 8 zone repeater which is compatible with the 4 and 8 zone variants. The matching repeater panel has an inbuilt 240Vac power supply.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 1

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Technical Specifications
Panels 2 Zone Electrical Mains Supply Power Consumption (max) PSU/Charger Output Sounder Circuits 24VDC Nominal Aux DC Output 24VDC Nominal Maximum Battery Space Environmental Operating Temperature Operating Humidity Mechanical Dimensions (W x H x D mm) Weight Excl Batteries Kg Enclosure Colour 4 Zone 8 Zone Repeater 8 Zone

2 x 0.5A

230VAC +10% - 15% 138W 1.5A 4 x 0.5A 4 x 0.5A 0.25A 2 x 3.4 A/H (PS-1230) -5C to +40C 95% Non Condensing 365 x 273 x 110 2.2 Light Grey RAL7035

N/A N/A

Product Codes
508.031.004.EG 508.031.005.EG 508.031.006.EG 508.031.016.EG MZX-c MZX-c MZX-c MZX-c 2 4 8 8 ZONE ZONE ZONE ZONE PANEL TYCO 2 WIRE PANEL TYCO 2 WIRE PANEL TYCO 2 WIRE REPEATER PANEL

Chapter 3 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
4, 8, 16 and 32 zone versions available Semi-Flush mounting using optional bezel Supports the complete range of EN54 Approved Series 600 Detectors including photo multi-sensor and CO multi-sensor Compatible with System 620 ATEX and IECEx approved intrinsically safe system Extensive custom options programmable via switches and front panel controls Two stage alarms and investigate delay options Day/Night modes and alarm counter (with optional timer module) Full EN54 zone operation with options for non-latching, short circuit alarm or indication only circuits

Minerva MZX-c+ (Does not suppport Tyco twin wire sounders)


The MZX-c+ range of Conventional Control Panels are designed to be both installer and user friendly. They are designed and manufactured to a high standard and are approved by LPCB to EN54 parts 2 & 4. These Panels are available in 4,8,16 & 32 zone versions along with suitable Repeaters for all models. The 8 to 32 Zone Panels are capable of driving any combination of 8 channel output expansion boards (relays, alarm circuits & open collector 0v outputs) up to a maximum of 12 boards which can be set to zonal activated or common output modes. Each Panel has extensive configuration options but remains easy to install, program and operate and are supported by detailed documentation on commissioning, operation and maintenance. The Panels are designed to work with a wide range of manufacturers detectors (in addition to Tyco detectors) and are suitable for use in many types of installation including upgrades and new installations Ancillaries and Expansion C1631 Repeater Interface Board provides a port for driving up to 5 repeater panels. One C1631 Repeater interface board is required for the panel and one for each repeater. Repeaters are supplied with a C1631 fitted. C1630 Output Expansion Interface Board provides a port for driving up to 12 output expansion boards. EXP 4 and EXP 4 PSU Expansion Housings are designed to house any combination of up to four output expansion boards. The PSU version is equipped with a 5A 24Vdc power supply with space for 2 x 12V 12Ah batteries. Housing dimensions 325W x 370H x 126D mm EXP 5 and EXP 5 PSU Expansion Housings are similar to the EXP 4 and EXP 4 PSU but accommodate five output expansion boards. Housing dimensions 400W x 441H x 131D mm C1633 LED Driver Board provides eight open collector outputs rated @ 60mA. Outputs can be zonal alarm or common alarm. C1634 Relay Output Module provides eight volt free changeover contacts rated at 1A 30Vdc. Outputs can be zonal alarm or common alarm. C1635 Monitored Output Board provides eight fault monitored 24Vdc outputs. Power can be derived from the control panel or an external source. Outputs can be zonal alarm or common alarm.. C1651 MZX-c+ Timer Module is an optional plug-in board with an alphanumeric LCD to provides a real-time clock display. The clock can be programmed to provide investigate delays, sequential alarms and day night settings. The unit is also used to store and display a total count of the number of times the panel enters the alarm condition. Can be fitted to 8, 16 and 32 zone panels. Additional Benefilts Inputs for remote Silence, Evacuate, Reset and Class change Configurable monitored or volt free outputs for Fire, Fault and Protection Outputs for zones 1 to 4 (open collector) with 8, 16 or 32 zonal outputs provided by optional expansion boards Outputs for Disablement active, Evacuate active and buzzer active (open collector) Volt free reset relay. Active for 10 seconds following a panel reset 8 to 32 zone systems can drive up to 12 expansion input / output modules per panel Drive up to 5 repeater panels

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 3

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Technical Specifications
Panels Electrical 4 Zone Mains Supply Power Consumption PSU / Charger Output Sounder Circuits 24Vdc nominal Aux. DC Output 24Vdc nominal Maximum Battery Space Environmental Operating Temperature Operating Humidity Mechanical Dimensions (W x H x D mm) Space for 8 way expansion Weight Excl. Batteries Kg Enclosure Colour 85W 1.5A 4 @ 500mA 500mA 2 x 3Ah 8 Zone 165W 3.0A 4 @ 1A 1A 2 x 7Ah 16 Zone 32 Zone 230Vac +10% - 15% 165W 240W 3.0A 5.0A 4 @ 1A 4 @ 1A 1A 1A 2 x 12Ah 2 x 17Ah -5 to +40 oC 5% to 95% non-condensing 325x370x126 400x441x131 2 Boards 2 Boards Use Exp Hsg 7.1 7.1 10.25 RAL7035 Light Grey 325x370x126 N/A 6.2 6.2 400x441x131 7.6 8 Zone 85W 1.5A N/A N/A 2 x 3Ah 16 Zone 85W 1.5A N/A N/A 2 x 3Ah 32 Zone 85W 1.5A N/A N/A 2 x 3Ah Repeaters

N/A 6.2

Product Codes
508.032.002.EA 508.032.003.EA 508.032.004.EA 508.032.005.EA 508.032.006.EA MZXC+ 4 Zone Panel English/Arabic MZXC+ 8 Zone Panel English/Arabic MZXC+ 16 Zone Panel English/Arabic MZXC+ 32 Zone Panel English/Arabic MZXC+ 8 Zone Repeater 240Vac English/Arabic 508.032.007.EA MZXC+16 Zone Repeater 240Vac English/Arabic 508.032.008.EA MZXC+ 32 Zone Repeater 240Vac English/Arabic 508.032.012 MZXC+ 4 Way Expansion Housing 508.032.013 MZXC+ 4 Way Expansion Housing with PSU 508.032.014 MZXC+ 5 Way Expansion Housing 508.032.015 MZXC+ 5 Way Expansion Housing with PSU 557.201.502 Flush Mount Bezel for MZXC+ 4/8/16 Zone Panel and Repeater 2605060 C1630 O/P Expansion Interface Board 2605061 C1631 Repeater Interface Board 2605062 C1632 16 Zone Interface Board 2605063 C1633 LED Driver Board 2605064 C1634 Relay Output Board 2605065 C1635 Monitored Output Board 2605070 C1651 MZX-c+ Timer Board

Chapter 3 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Developed for use in vessels which require between 4 and 32 zones of fire detection. Compact 4 zone option for Console Mounting. Range includes a separate Water Mist Panel. Integrated Voyage Data Recorder output on 16 and 32 Zone Panel. No external secondary power source required. Discrimination between Automatic Fire Detectors and Manual Alarm Call points to provide the appropriate response. Optional Marine Approved Muster Alarm. Text label Inserts for Controls and Indicators in customer supplied language.

T1200 Conventional Marine Controller


Developed and Manufactured in the United Kingdom the T1200 range of Conventional Panels are a powerful yet user friendly series of Control Panels. The range is fully approved by all major Marine Authorities and takes advantage of the very latest technological advancements both in terms of design and manufacturing to the latest European, Marine and Asian standards. Benefits Allows very early detection of accommodation fires with significantly reduced false alarms when used with Tycos unique heat enhanced Compensated Carbon Monoxide (CCO) Detector. Configurable Detection Zones allowing zones to be configured for any or all of the following :- Latching or Non Latching Fire Indication Normal or Intrinsically Safe Zone Monitoring of Machinery space zones. Crew Alert Mode :- Manages Alarm Annunciation. Pre-configured for Immediate use. Detection Options Optical Detector - An excellent all round detector suited to all applications. High Performance Optical (HPO) Detector - A direct replacement for the Ion Chamber Smoke Detector. Flame Detector- Used where there is a risk of large flaming fires e.g. Machinery Spaces. Enhanced Compensated Carbon Monoxide (CCO) Detector The best detector for early warning without false alarms, used in life threatening applications e.g. Cabins, Public Spaces etc. Heat Detector - Used where smoke detectors cannot be used e.g. Galleys, Laundries, Drying Rooms etc. Extensive configuration options using simple on board DIL switches and links. Fault Finding Features The following fault finding indications are available : General Fault - Any Fault Condition. Power Supply Fault - Mains or standby power supply/ charger fault. System Fault - Micro Controller or memory fault. Earth Fault - Positive or Negative Power Supply Earth Fault. Fuse Fault - Auxiliary Supply Fuse Failure. Repeater Fault - Repeater Fault or Repeater communications failure. Sounder Fault - Any Sounder Fault. Fire Protection Fault - Fault on the Fire Protection Output. Fire Output Fault - Fault on the Fire Output. Fault Output Fault - Fault on the Fault Output.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: T1204 & T1216RDC 335w x 270h x 148d mm T1216 & T1216R 420w x 445h x 148d mm T1232/T1216W/T1232RAC/T1232R DC/T1200EA/T1200EDC 500w x 535h x 174d mm T1200B 335w x 170h x 102d mm Designed to IP56 -10C to +55C 95% RH (non condensing)

Environmental IP Rating: Operating Temp: Humidity:

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 5

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Product Codes
508.023.001 508.023.002 T1204DC 4 ZONE PANEL C/W 1.5A 24VDC PSU (requires T1200B battery box) T1204A1 4 ZONE PANEL C/W 1.5A 110VAC PSU (requires T1200B battery box) T1204A2 4 ZONE PANEL C/W 1.5A 230VAC PSU (requires T1200B battery box) T1216 16 ZONE PANEL C/W VOYAGE DATA O/P MODULE & 5.0A 110/230VAC PSU T1216W 16 ZONE WATER MIST FIRE DETECTION PANEL C/W 2 X 8 WAY ZONAL RELAY OUTPUT MODULES (C1634) AND 5.0AMP 110/230VAC PSU T1232 32 ZONE PANEL C/W VOYAGE DATA O/P MODULE & 5.0A 110/230VAC PSU T1216RDC 16 ZONE REPEATER WITHOUT PSU T1216RA1 16 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A 110VAC PSU T1216RA2 16 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A 230VAC PSU T1232RDC 32 ZONE REPEATER WITHOUT PSU T1232RA1 32 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A 110VAC PSU T1232RA2 32 ZONE REPEATER C/W 1.5A 230VAC PSU T1200EA EXPANSION BOX C/W 5.0A 110/230VAC PSU T1200EDC EXPANSION BOX (NO PSU) T1200B BATTERY BOX FOR T1204 4 ZONE PANEL T1200 RMRS DOOR STAY KIT C1631 REPEATER INTERFACE BOARD C1633 LED DRIVER BOARD C1634 RELAY OUTPUT BOARD C1635 MONITORED OUTPUT BOARD C1665 MUSTER INTERFACE BOARD A1466 RELAY OUTPUT BOARD T1216 ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE INSERT SET T1232 ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE INSERT SET T1216R ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE INSERT SET T1232R ENGLISH/CHINESE/JAPANESE INSERT SET Spares 509.023.001 509.023.002 509.023.003 509.023.004 509.023.011 509.023.012 509.023.021 509.023.022 509.023.023 509.023.031 509.023.032 2605060 509.023.042 509.023.051 509.023.052 509.023.061 C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD C/W AC PSU C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU FOR T1232 C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD C/W AC PSU C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU C1628 4 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY C1628 16 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY C1629 32 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY C1628 16 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY C1629 32 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY C1630 OUTPUT EXPANSION INTERFACE BOARD C1632 16 ZONE PANEL EXPANSION BOARD PS136 5.0A 110/230VAC PSU PS40 1.5A 24VDC PSU T1200 SPARE KEY SET

508.023.003

508.023.004

508.023.005

508.023.006

508.023.011 508.023.012 508.023.013 508.023.014 508.023.015 508.023.016 508.023.021 508.023.022 508.023.023 508.023.025 2605061 2605063 2605064 2605065 508.023.035 508.023.036 508.023.051 508.023.052 508.023.053 508.023.054

Chapter 3 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Extinguishing Panels, Repeaters & Accessories


Features
Approval to BS EN 12094-1:2003 additional options Approval to BS EN 54-2 and 4 Designed to BS7273-1:2000 Comprehensive facilities for gaseous extinguishing systems Monitored inputs for gas discharged, gas low, isolation valve closed/abnormal, gas trapped in manifold Control inputs for auto/manual, gas hold, gas abort 1 minute actuator cut off option Monitored actuator/solenoid release Extensive disablement options Common fire, fault, relay / monitored output facilities 1st, 2nd, 3rd stage and gas discharged relay / monitored output facilities Reset relay facilities Normally-open inputs provide for remote evacuate, silence alarms, system reset, lock-off input, low pressure and gas discharged pressure switch input. Outputs are provided for first stage signalling, second stage signalling, system discharged, common fire and common fault . These outputs may be configured as either Volt-Free C/O contacts or monitored 24V (50mA) outputs. A system reset Volt-Free relay is also provided. Configuration The use of DIL switches on the internal motherboard enables the engineer to easily configure the extensive options available and view the panels configuration upon any return visit. Additional Benefits Intrinsically safe barrier settings Metron or solenoid compatible Single or double knock operation Pre-discharge delay adjustable from 0 to 60 seconds Discharged indication with or without pressure switch Inhibit silence alarms until gas discharged Latching or non latching fault indication option Option for rapid buzzer pulse when gas discharge is imminent One man zone and sounder test Easily removable chassis

MZX-e Extinguishing Control Panel


The MZX-e gaseous extinguishant control panel is powerful yet user-friendly and is designed and manufactured to a high standard. The panel features approval to BS EN 12094- 1:2003, BS EN 54-2 and 4 and is designed to BS 7273 part 1. The panel has extensive configuration options but is easy to install, programme and operate. The removable chassis enables the engineer to first fix an empty cabinet and then fit the chassis at the commissioning stage. This is supported by comprehensive documentation on commissioning, operating, maintenance and fault finding. In addition there is a comprehensive range of compatible accessories available to meet most customer requirements. Operation Three fully-monitored detection zones are provided. Zones 1 and 2 normally provide first stage and second stage fire conditions to allow extinguishant discharge (coincidence detection zones). Zone 3 is an auxiliary zone for detection only purposes. Zone 4 is used as a manual release zone. Facilities Three fully-monitored alarm circuits are provided, each rated at 0.5A with various configuration options via the engineers DIL switch settings. Two circuits are designed to provide audible warning of any fire condition and one circuit to provide an individually distinct audible warning of the pre-discharge, discharged and emergency hold condition. Two fully-monitored actuator/solenoid circuits, each rated at 1A, operate simultaneously upon extinguishant release. An RS485 multi-drop circuit link supports up to 7 Status Controller/Indicators of any type mixed on the communication path. Additional terminals and configuration options allows the engineer to configure the manual release, abort and hold switches to either data comms or hard wired inputs as required.

Product Codes
508.033.050.EA MZX-e Extinguishing Control Panel English / Arabic 508.033.002.EA MZX-e SLU1 Status Lamp Unit, Indication only English / Arabic 508.033.003.EA MZX-e SLU2 Status Lamp Unit, Indication, Auto/Manual Select and Manual Release English / Arabic 508.033.004.EA MZX-e SLU3 Full Function Status Lamp Unit, Indication, Auto/Manual Select, Manual Release, Hold, Abort & Time Counter English / Arabic 508.033.005.EA MZX-e SLU4 Weatherproof Status Lamp Unit, Indication and Auto/Manual Select English / Arabic Chapter 3 Page 7

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Extinguishing Door Interlock Ancillaries & T500 Series Spares
A microswitch lock keep can be used with a deadlock to provide a signal to the panel to ensure that the extinguishing system is only put into Automatic mode when the door is locked shut. Product Codes 527.001.028 Micro-switch Lock Keep & Back-plate For Deadlock 599.001.012 Lamp 28V 60mA Used On T525

T561 Electrical Manual Release Unit


A stand alone manual extinguishant release unit with selectable activation and end of line resistors making the T561 compatible with MXCE, Prescient, System 1700 and NTR Extinguishing Panels. Product Code 509.030.117 T561 Extinguishing Release Manual Callpoint.

Weatherproof Extinguishing Indicator Units


E1 Single Red lamp unit Single 24V d.c. red lamp labelled 'Extinguishing System Operated' Product Codes 540.007.001 E1 Single Red lamp unit Heavy Duty IP67 Cast Aluminium Surface Mount Lamp Unit 599.001.029 Spare bulb for E1/E3 24V-5W

Technical Specification Dimensions: H(mm) W(mm) D(mm) E1 100 100 115 E3 300 100 115

E3 Red/Amber/Green lamp unit Heavy Duty IP67 Cast Aluminium Surface Mount Lamp Unit Three 24Vdc lamps: Red labelled 'Extinguishing System Operated'

Amber labelled 'Extinguishing System Automatic Control' Green labelled 'Extinguishing System Manual Control'

Product Codes 540.007.002 E3 Red/Amber/Green lamp unit 599.001.029 Spare Bulb for E1/E3 24V-5W

Chapter 3 Page 8

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems DDA Compliant Pager


Features
UHF radio link for maximum licensable protection Unique coding avoids neighbouring system clashes Self monitoring of system health Rugged steel enclosure to IP65 Backlit 2 line text display continuously reports system status Additional audible & visible status indicators Prioritised Fire Alarm Inputs Automated test calls alert pagers to loss of radio signal Fault Notification to the lost fire panel via a monitored link Key operated "System Test" facility for routine confidence checking Over 90 hour's backup operation with internal battery Achieves Disability Discrimination Act (DDA) compliance

Fire Tek Pro Paging System


The FireTek Pro paging system is designed for use with professional Fire Systems installed in commercial, industrial and educational premises. The system is primarily designed to alert the "hearing impaired" in the event of a fire or other emergency where an audible sounder is the normal means of indication. The FireTek Pro has been designed to comply with the recommendations detailed in BS5839-1: 2002 for alerting the "hearing impaired" to the activation of a fire alarm system. The system can also be used in conjunction with a security panel to alert guards who might be located remotely from the main premises. The interface to the fire panel comprises of three Prioritised Fire Inputs and two Fault Inputs. For ease of installation, a monitored cable assembly is provided with each system which includes a "common fault" relay output back to the host fire panel. This output will activate if the FireTek Pro suffers a mains failure, transmitter fault, antenna mismatch, interface link failure, or low battery state. Upon activation of any one of the Fire Inputs, the FireTek Pro will enter the fire alert condition, prioritisng and transmitting the Fire message to all enrolled pagers. The transmissions will be repeated until the fire condition is reset. The FireTek Pro Pagers ensure that users are alerted by distinct vibration patterns and clear text messages. UHF Radio Operation Any alerting system is only as good as its weakest link. The FireTek Pro utilises UHF radio frequencies, the main benefits being superior in-building radio signal propagation and the option of a manual frequency co-ordinate license issued by OFCOM. Licensing the FireTek Pro provides a higher degree of protection from interference. This fact is acknowledged in Section 18.1 of BS 5839-1:2002. High Integrity Pagers To complete the system the alphanumeric pagers have added features specifically incorporated for the "hard of hearing" when used with the FireTek Pro. These features include distinct vibrate alerts for emergency messages, a vibrating out of range indicator which displays "No Service" on the pager when the radio link is lost, and a vibrating low battery indicator. Antenna Options Mini Dipole Antenna - remote internally mounted antenna for large sites or areas of difficult signal propagation. Folded Dipole Antenna - remote externally mounted antenna for maximum signal coverage e.g. campuses and multi-building sites.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 9

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Technical Specifications
Supply Voltage: Operational Current: Inputs: 230V AC 50-60 Hz 12v 7Ah standby battery 250mA 3 Prioritised Volt Free (Fire) Input 1 - Fire Alarm - Evacuate Building Input 2 - There is an Incident Leave Building Input 3 - Prepare to Evacuate Await Instructions 2 Volt Free (Fault) 1 off volt free relay output Mains Failure Transmitter Fault Antenna Mismatch Panel Link Failure Low/Missing Battery 2 Line Backlit LCD Steel Enclosure rated to IP65 380 x 320 x 110 mm (H x W x D) (No antenna fitted)

Product Codes
557.200.071 557.200.074 557.200.076 557.200.077 557.200.078 557.200.079 557.200.080 Paging Transmitter 40 Character Alpha Numeric Pager 1/2 wave dipole antenna Wall mounting folded dipole antenna Pole mounting folded dipole antenna 5 metre antenna feeder cable 10 metre antenna feeder cable

Outputs: Fault Notification:

Visual Display: Enclosure: Dimensions:

Chapter 3 Page 10

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Point Detectors


Features
Unique early detection enhanced CO fire detector Intelligent Universal HPO Smoke Detector Low profile, discreet and unobtrusive Superior performance and reliability Designed for fast, easy installation Integral and remote alarm LED Series of Product Approvals

Through innovative design the Series 600 detectors have reduced the installation and servicing time to a minimum, needing only one visit to complete the installation and having a park position for the detector to ease the servicing. The Series 600 includes the unique enhanced Carbon Monoxide CO fire detector, which provides a general purpose fire detector with unprecedented early detection capability and excellent false alarm immunity. The CO fire detectors are the first choice for sleeping risks. Also included within the range is the intelligent high performance optical smoke (HPO) detector. The use of the patented optical sensing chamber, together with refined signal processing, has enabled the introduction of a smoke detector suitable for fast, reliable smoke detection of both slow and fast developing fires.

The HPO can be seen as a truly universal smoke detector, suitable for most applications. Approvals:-

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 11

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


High Performance Optical Smoke
These detectors react to the whole range of fire products from slow smouldering fires, producing visible particles to open flaming fires producing large numbers of very hot smaller sized aerosols. It combines optical and heat detector technology to detect clear burning fire products which hitherto could only be easily detected by ion-chamber detectors. For normal ambient conditions, the high performance optical detector behaves as a normal optical detector. Only when a rapid rise in temperature is detected does the sensitivity of the detector increase and the presence of smoke will confirm a fire condition. The HPO will not operate on a rate of rise of temperature alone. Datasheet - Product Code PSF123 Manual - Vol01C-02-D2 Detectors Fire Manual Product Codes 516.600.002.A Approval Branded LPCB ADT 516.600.002.T Approval Branded LPCB Thorn 516.600.002.Y Approval Branded Tyco LPCB 516.600.202 Approval Branded Tyco Marine

Model 601PH Model 601PH Model 601PH Model 601PH-M

Enhanced Carbon Monoxide Fire


The CO fire detector is a unique general purpose fire detector which provides very early warning of slow smouldering fires. Ideal for sleeping risks the CO fire detector is also well suited to many applications where heat detection is insufficient but smoke detection causes false alarms. As CO travels more freely than smoke the position of CO fire detectors is more flexible. This feature is particularly useful in large complex structures such as atria and warehouses, where position of smoke detectors is difficult. Datasheet - Product Code PSF123 Manual - Vol01C-02-D3 Detectors Fire Manual Product Codes 516.600.004.A Approval Branded LPCB ADT 516.600.004.T Approval Branded LPCB Thorn 516.600.004.Y Approval Branded LPCB Tyco 516.600.204 Approval Branded Marine Tyco

Model 601CH Model 601CH Model 601CH Model 601CH-M

Optical Smoke
These detectors are capable of detecting the visible smoke produced by materials which smoulder or burn slowly, i.e. soft furnishings, plastic foam etc;. or 'smoke' produced by overheated but unburnt PVC. These detectors are particularly suitable for general applications and areas where cable overheating may occur e.g. electrical services areas. The novel design of the asymmetrical sampling chamber and signal processing techniques stop unwanted alarms caused by very small insects. i.e. thrips. Smoke entering the sampling chamber scatters the infra-red light pulses onto a photo-diode. These pulses are converted to an electrical signal which is compared against a preset alarm level. Datasheet - Product Code PSF123 Manual - Vol01C-02-D6 Detectors Fire Manual Product Codes 516.600.001.A Approval Branded ADT LPCB 516.600.001.T Approval Branded LPCB 516.600.001.Y Approval LPCB 516.600.201 Approval Marine Thorn Branded Tyco Branded Tyco

Model 601P Model 601P Model 601P Model 601P-M

Heat
These detectors use two networked thermistors in a bridge configuration to provide a fast response, that depends both on absolute temperature and notes the change of temperature. The rate of rise/fixed temperature heat detectors can be used in areas where smoke sensors are unsuitable due to environmental conditions (smoke, dust etc,). Such areas include kitchens, locker rooms, canteens, garages, loading bays etc. Datasheet - Product Code PSF123 Manual - Vol01C-02-D5 Detectors Fire Manual Rate of Rise Product Codes 516.600.003.A Approval Branded Model LPCB ADT 601H-R 516.600.003.T Approval Branded Model Thorn 601H-R LPCB 516.600.003.Y Approval Branded Model LPCB Tyco 601H-R 516.600.203 Approval Branded Model Tyco 601H-R-M Marine Fixed Temperature 60C Product Code 516.600.214 Approval LPCB /Marine Fixed Temperature 90C Product Code 516.600.033 Approval LPCB/Marine

Model 611H-F

Model 631H-F

Chapter 3 Page 12

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Ion Chamber Smoke
These detectors react to the visible and invisible fire aerosols (products of combustion) and are therefore capable of detecting the early presence of hot smouldering and flaming fires, such as wood, paper etc. They are particularly suitable for general applications in all areas and use a dual ionisation chamber in which the air is ionised by a single radioactive source (33k Bq Americium 241). The presence of smoke in the sampling chamber causes a change in the balance voltage, between the two chambers. This is then compared against an alarm level. Datasheet - Product Code PSF123 Manual - Vol01C-02-D4 Detectors Fire Manual Product Codes 516.600.005.A Approval Branded ADT LPCB 516.600.005.T Approval Branded Thorn LPCB 516.600.005.Y Approval Branded Tyco LPCB

Model 601I Model 601I Model 601I

Solar Blind Infra Red Flame Detector


Flame detectors, unlike smoke and heat detectors, do not rely on convection to transport the fire product to the detector, nor do they rely on a ceiling to trap the products. They can therefore, be used to protect large open areas without sacrificing speed of response to flaming fires. In order to ensure full coverage, however, flame detectors do require direct line of sight to all parts of the protected area. Infra-red flame detectors such as the 601F are designed to respond rapidly to fires which involve cleanburning fuels such as alcohol or methane, ie fires which would not be detected by smoke detectors. The 601F Flame detector, by virtue of its operating wavelength and flicker discrimination, is insensitive to normal environmental influences. For outdoor use, a solar-blind detector (e.g. the S200Plus) should be used. The 601F flame detector should, normally, only be used inside buildings to supplement heat and smoke detectors. Product Codes 516.600.006 601F 516.600.007 601F-M Marine Datasheet - Product Code PSF132 Manual - Vol01C-02-D9 Detectors Fire Manual

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 13

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Series 600 Detector Specifications
Dimensions of Smoke/Heat/Co Detector

43

109

Dimensions of Flame Detector

21.2

108

Technical Specification - Series 600 601 601PH/P/601PH-M/601P-M Weight 100g 93g Material Operating Temp. -20 to +70C -20 to +70C Storage Temp. -40 to +80C -25 to +80C Relative Humidity Quiescent Current(typ) 62A 65A Alarm Current(typ) 54mA 45mA Operating Voltage 10.5 - 33 Vdc 10.5 - 33 Vdc *Short Term (<3min) -40 to +120C

601H-R/611H-F/601H-R-M/631H-F 80g FR 110 Bayblend -20 to +70C* -25 to +80C 95/98% Non-Condensing 61/65A 53mA 10.5 - 33 Vdc

601CH/601CH-M 90g -10 to +55C -20 to +55C 87A 53mA 10.5 - 33 Vdc

601F/601F-M 74g -20 to +70C -40 to + 80C 300A 42mA 18-28Vdc

Chapter 3 Page 14

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Sealed Stainless Steel Construction Suitable for use in hazardous areas

T54B - Point Type Heat Detector


Constructed from stainless steel, the T54B is an extremely rugged heat detector that can be used to detect fires in the harshest of environments. The T54B can be used in environments with ambient temperatures up to 200C and, being hermetically sealed is impervious to most contaminants. Classified as a simple device, the T54B can be used in Zone 0 areas when connected to a suitable intrinsically safe barrier. For reliable operation, it is recommended that T54B detectors have set points 20C or 20% (whichever is higher) above the maximum temperature they will be exposed to in normal operation. Preferred factory preset temperatures are: 60, 90, 100, 145C; normally with open contacts.

Technical Specification
Operating voltage @ 0.5A: Switching Current: Contact Resistance: Actuating Temp: (factory set) Fixed Temp. only: Accuracy: Ambient Temp.: Relative Humidity: Protection Category: Thread Size: 240Va.c. to 24Vdc 5 to 500mA <1 ohm 60 to 240C Type E + or - 5% -40 to +270C 100% RH IP67 M20 x 1.5mm

Product Codes
516.033.011 516.033.012 516.033.013 516.033.014 T4E60X T54B Point Type heat detector - 60C T4E90X T54B Point Type heat detector - 90C T4E100X T54B Point Type heat detector - 100C T4E145X T54B Point Type heat detector - 145C

Other temperatures and normally closed contacts are available by request.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 15

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Beam Detectors


Features
Motorised Auto-Aligning Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller Each Detector configurable from 8m to 100m Integral LASER Auto-Align Fast Automatic BeamAlignment Auto-Optimise Building Movement and Contamination Compensation Low Level System Controller 20mm Cable Gland Knockouts on System Controller 2-wire interface from System Controller to Detector Worldwide Approvals including EN54:12 and UL268 Up to 4 Detectors per System Controller

FIRERAY 5000 Multi Head Auto Aligning Infrared Optical Beam Smoke Detector
The FIRERAY 5000 motorised, auto aligning infrared optical beam smoke detector can now be installed with up to four detector heads per system, thus saving on installation time and costs. This innovative system has been designed from the ground up to include pioneering technology that fully addresses the needs of the installer and user, both now and in the future. With its industry leading optics, the FIRERAY 5000 is ideally suited for the protection of large areas where the use of traditional detection technologies would prove to be too difficult and/or costly to install. The FIRERAY 5000 combines an infrared transmitter and receiver in the same discrete unit and operates by projecting a well-defined beam to a reflective prism, which returns the beam to the receiver for analysis. Smoke in the beam path causes a drop in power, which, if below a pre-determined level, results in an alarm signal. Getting the system operational is simplified by a number of groundbreaking features that combine to make the FIRERAY 5000 the quickest and easiest detector of its type to install. Once the detector heads are connected, using the Easifit First Fix system, an integral LASER, which is aligned along the optical path of the beam, can be activated. This allows the reflective prism to be sighted quickly and with confidence. Once the LASER has been used to coarsely align the beam, the AutOptimise beam alignment system takes over and automatically steers the beam into the optimum position. The system can be fully customised, according to local conditions; both alarm thresholds (sensitivity) and time to Alarm/Fault can be set from the ground level System Controller. Each detector head is independently configurable from 8m through to 100m and has its own individual fire threshold. The System Controller retains one set of Fire and Fault relays that is common to all detectors that are installed. The FR5000 MultiHead is supplied with one detector head and reflector for single beam operation from 8 to 50 meters. Up to 3 additional detector heads can be added to the controller to enable larger or more complex areas to be protected (Subject to local codes and standards)

Technical Specification
Controller: 202w x 230h x 81d mm 0.9 Kg Detector: 134w x 135h x 134d mm - 0.5 Kg Additional detector head 2mA @ 24VDC Operating Current (low power mode): 10mA @ 24VDC Operating Voltage: 14 to 28VDC IP Rating: IP54 Operating Temperature: -20 to +55oC Humidity: 93% RH (non condensing) max

Product Codes
516.015.020 516.015.021 516.015.007 FireRay 5000 System (50m) FR 5000 Detector Head (50m) FireRay Reflector 100 X 100mm 4 reflectors are required for distances from 50 to 100m

Chapter 3 Page 16

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Range 5 metres up to 100 metres Area coverage up to 1400m2 Selectable sensitivity Self-check and automatic compensation Manual or automatic reset Suitable for both conventional and addressable fire systems Low current consumption Flexible system design options Robust metal construction Designed to conform to BS5839 Part 5

Optical Beam Smoke Detectors


The FIRE-RAY 2000 is an active infra-red smoke detector. The system comprises of three base elements i.e. a transmitter, receiver and Control Unit. Analysis of the modulated infra-red beam by the Control Unit determines whether smoke is present, and if so generates an alarm signal.

Technical Specification
Technical Specification Dimensions(mm) Height Width Depth 95 75 115 260 210 80 +11.5 to +28Vdc <13mA <20mA -10oC to +55oC up to 95% RH (Non-condensing) IP54 Weight (Kg) 0.4 2.25

Product Codes
516.015.006.A 516.015.006.T 920450 516.015.007 516.015.008 FireRay2000 optical beam smoke detector VdS approved, ADT Branded FireRay2000 optical beam smoke detector VdS approved, Thorn Branded FireRay2000 -UL Optical beam smoke detector - UL approved FireRay2000 Retro-Reflector 100 x 100mm FireRay2000 Alignment tool

Transmitter/Receiver Control Unit

Voltage RangeFireray 2000 Fireray 2000 Quiescent Current Fireray 2000 Alarm Current Operating Temp. Range Humidity Fireray

Fireray 2000 Enclosure

FireRay Optical Beam Smoke Detector Mounting Accessories


There are a range of mounting accessories available for use with FireRay Optical Beam Smoke Detectors. These accessories will help reduce installation times and provide a professional mounting solution when faced with challenging building internals. The large prism plate will securely The Universal Mounting bracket can be used mount 4 prisms and is designed with the Fireray 5000 detector head and the 1 to be used in conjunction with the or 4 way prism plates to enable the detector Universal Mounting Bracket (not head or prism plates to be easily mounted included) and adjusted when fixing to angled walls or cladding The Flat Mounting plate is a metal plate which will support a single prism or 4 prisms, the side mounting holes are compatible with Unistrut racking systems. The small prism plate will securely mount a single prism and is designed to be used in conjunction with the Universal Mounting Bracket (not included)

Product Codes
5000-005 5000-006 5000-007 5000-008 02/12 Universal Mounting Bracket Flat Mounting Plate for 1 to 4 Prisms Prism Mounting Plate for 4 Prisms Prism Mounting Plate for 1 Prism

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 17

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Linear Heat Detectors


Features
Easy and cost effective installation Good sensitivity with adjustable alarm threshold Open and short circuit monitoring Suited for outdoor and indoor applications Can be used in hazardous areas Mechanical protection is provided for cables in areas where damage may occur Chemical resistance sheathing is available for areas where petro-chemical corrosion may occur.

Linear Heat Detection


The LD40 linear heat detection system is used to monitor fire (or overheat) conditions in confined or polluted areas or where there are adverse or unusually variable environmental conditions. The sensor cable is unaffected by dust, moisture or vibration and requires little maintenance.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Operating Temp: Relative humidity: Rating: Operating Voltage: Quiescent Current: 178H x 130W x 75D mm 0.55Kg -25C to +70C Up to 98% RH non-condensing IP55 +8 to +30Vdc 60-80A

Product Codes
516.016.005 516.016.006 LD40 High resistance sensor cable blue 200M reel LD40 High resistance sensor cable black - 200M reel (Nylon sheath suitable for petrochemical exposure) LD40 EOL Termination kit (PK10) LD40 In-line Jointing kit (PK10) LD40 Analyser module with conventional detection zone interface. B6782-003 EDGE CLIP 2-3mm WEB B6782-024 EDGE CLIP 3-8mm WEB B6782-025 EDGE CLIP 8-13mm WEB B6782-026 EDGE CLIP 14-20mm WEB B6782-004 'T' CLIP B6782-005 PIPE CLIP B6782-023 'V' CLIP B6782-008 NEOPRENE SLEEVE

516.016.010 516.016.011 516.016.012 516.016.201 516.016.202 516.016.203 516.016.204 516.016.205 516.016.206 516.016.207 516.016.208

Ceiling Clip

Edge Clip

Pipe Clip

V Clip

Chapter 3 Page 18

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Detector Bases and Accessories


Features
Optional relay bases Remote indication LEDs Optional conduit entry backboxes Protective wire cages

Detector Bases and Ancillaries


The 600 Series range of low profile detectors provide a comprehensive range of highly effective and aesthetically pleasing smoke and heat detectors with worldwide approvals. The unique design and leading edge technology of the detectors go beyond the detection technology itself. The range of detector bases is designed to make low profile detector installations cost effective, aesthetically pleasing and easy to install and maintain thus minimising disruption. The detector bases include standard universal bases, which have no integral electronics, thus making them low cost and low maintenance. Alternatively, a range of functional bases incorporate sounders and relays to provide a cost effective method of adding functions and flexibility to the fire detection installation.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 19

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


The standard universal detector bases are compatible with the Series 600 low profile detectors. The standard bases have no electronics and even when the detectors are connected to the bases, they can be electrically disconnected and left in a park position. This enables wiring integrity tests to take place without any damage to electronics. An optional, tool removable locking pin allows the detector to be fixed in place to prevent tampering. 5B-5 Inch Universal Detector Base
This is the most commonly used base. It is fully EN54 approved for use with the Series 600 conventional range of detectors. If used it will require a separately supplied tool to remove a detector from the base. Features Drives a remote indicator Detector locking pin with every base Temporary Park position Fits directly to a British or European conduit box or directly onto the ceiling. Break-outs for surface installation Product Code 517.050.017 5B 5 Universal Base LPCB

5BD-5 Inch Conventional Diode Continuity Base


The 5BD Continuity Base is a standard 5 inch base fitted with a continuity diode, for use with all Series 600 detectors. The base is designed to ensure that conventional systems meet the requirements of BS5839 Pt:1 for callpoints placed after detectors. Features Compatible with Series 600 Low Profile Detector Range Designed for two wire operation Facility to drive a remote indicator A breakout locking key is provided as an integral part of each base, which can be fitted to lock the detector into position. A temporary park position is provided so that the field wiring can be tested with the detector in situ. Maybe fitted directly to a British or European conduit box or directly onto the ceiling Product Code 517.050.600 5 BD 5 Conventional Diode Continuity Base LPCB

Chapter 3 Page 20

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Functional Detector Bases
Functional detector bases use a common moulding which incorporates a double sided circuit board which enables electrical connections to be made on the top and bottom of the functional base. This allows the functional bases to be retrofitted into new and existing universal bases or alternatively the depth and cost of the installed detector can be reduced by using the functional base instead of the universal base. This feature enables additional sounders to be easily added during commissioning. In addition, changes to the building during its life can be easily adapted to, by retrofitting sounders and relay outputs to existing detection points. When functional bases are fitted to universal bases, they automatically lock into position. Removal is then achieved using the detector removal tool. This feature ensures that the detector and functional bases are removed separately.
Manual - Vol/01B-09-D1/01B-07-D1 Detectors Fire Manual

Tyco MKII Sounder Base


A new low current range of sounder bases for use with Conventional Fire Alarm Control Panels. Features Manufactured to EN54 part 3 Integral sounder and detector base Volume and tone adjustable after installation Low Power Synchronisation Do not require use of a standard base (maybe installed directly onto a standard besa box) Product Codes 577.001.035 601SB Conventional Sounder Base 577.001.037 601SBD Conventional Diode Sounder Base 577.001.036 602SB 2 Wire Line Powered Sounder Base 577.001.038 602SBD 2 Wire Line Powered Diode Sounder Base 517.050.022 Volume Pot Spare Cover (1 sheet of 144) 517.050.005 4 Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)

Tyco MKII Sounder Cap


A plastic cap which fits onto the 601SB/601SBD/602SB/602SBD Sounder Base to enable these bases to operate as a sounder without fitting a detector. Product Codes 557.001.040.A Mark II Sounder Cap (ADT Branded) 557.001.040.Y Mark II Sounder Cap (Tyco Branded)

MC600 Functional Relay Base


The 600 Series relay base provides dual relay contacts for signalling external devices on conventional detection systems. Very low operating current even when the relay is energised, enable the relay base to be used without additional power. The relay contacts operate when the detector enters the alarm condition. Features Dual pole 24Vdc relay contact (60VA) Status indicator LED Low power consumption (<20A except start up) Latching operation Can be used instead of a standard base Requires diode fitting if used in place of a diode base. Technical Specification Operating Temp.: -25C to +70C Up to 95% RH Humidity: (noncondensing) Vibration: Exceeds requirements of EN54-3, Marine & UL268

Product Code 568.001.018 MC600 Relay base (BS5839)

Volume Adjustment Tool


A simple Volume Adjustment Tool, specific to the task of sounder volume selection on the variablevolume range of Tyco MKII Sounder Bases. Sounder volume can be easily varied between the maximum 90dBA and minimum 68dBA volume settings, using this simple, functional tool. Note: Sounder Bases are supplied with the volume pre-set to maximum volume. Product Code 517.050.015 Volume Adjustment Tool

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 21

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Remote Indication LED
All detector bases have the ability to drive a remote LED in the event that the installed position of the detector is not easily visible. Features UK Single gang mounting High intensity red LED Product Code 540.003.006 Remote LED

EM-5B Euro Mounting


The euro-mounting base provides a matching back box, which allows the standard MUB to be ceiling mounted with conduit entries for standard 18 and 21mm conduit. Features 2 x 18mm conduit entries 2 x 21mm conduit entries Fits all 5 Bases Fitted with terminal, if more are required use optional accessory kit Product Codes 517.050.604 EM5B mounting base 517.050.612 Base accessory terminal kit (pack of 10)

DHM-5B - Deck Head Mounting


Where the detectors are mounted in humid and environmentally challenging situations such as marine or offshore installations, the DHM 5B deck head mount provides a sealed waterproof mounting which protects the electrical connections in the base. Can be screwed, bolted or welded to the deckhead. Supplied with 1 terminal. If more are required, use the optional base accessory kit. Features 4 x 20mm gland entries Fits ALL 5 bases IP55 with supplied gasket Product Codes 517.050.603 Deckhead mounting 517.050.612 Base accessory terminal kit (pack of 10)

Protective Detector Cage


Robust steel protective cage for Series 600 detectors using the 5 base. Ideal for schools and sporthalls or whenever detectors need protection. Strong coated steel construction with 4 point fitting. Product Code 517.050.614 CW-5B Detector Cage

Protective Detector/Sounder Base Cage


White powder coated steel protective cage for Series 600 Detectors fitted with a sounder base. Internal dimensions: 120mm dia x 80mm deep. Product Code 517.050.011 Steel Protective Detector Cage

Chapter 3 Page 22

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Duct Probes


SMP Duct Probe Units Where smoke within duct work needs to be detected these duct probe units provide an economical solution, for use with series 600 detectors. . The SMP Duct Probe Units are designed to be installed in air conditioning supply and exhaust ducts for the purpose of monitoring the airflow for smoke and combustion products. The SMP69 probe units are designed to accept and operate with series 600 detectors. For general applications it is recommended that photoelectric smoke detectors rather than ionisation smoke detectors are used. The SMP stainless steel probe unit is designed to withstand the more demanding environments of the offshore oil and gas industries.
Warning Duct probe units sited in the common duct work to several extract grills may fail to respond to smoke from any one extract due to the effect of dilution. The SMP units will not respond to airflow of less than 1.5m/sec.

The units are designed to operate in airspeeds of 1.5 to 25 metres per second. A range of sampling tubes from 525mm to 1575mm are available.

Technical Specification Operating temperature: -20C to +70C -25C to +80C Storage temperature: Relative Humidity: 0 to 95% SMP69 Stainless steel 316 housing with transparent polycarbonate cover

Height Width Length Weight

SMP69 90mm 150mm 225mm 1.2Kg

SMP69 Duct Probe Air Sampling - Stainless Steel


Product Codes 517.025.035 SMP69 Stainless Steel Duct Probe unit and universal detector base for Series 600/800 Detectors. 517.025.028 DPS450 Probe tube stainless steel 450mm and exhaust 517.025.029 DPS600 Probe tube stainless steel 600mm and exhaust 517.025.030 DPS750 Probe tube stainless steel 750mm and exhaust 517.025.031 DPS900 Probe tube stainless steel 900mm and exhaust 517.025.032 DPS 1200 Probe tube stainless steel 1200mm and exhaust 517.025.033 DPS1500 Probe tube stainless steel 1500mm and exhaust Datasheet - Product Code PSF092 SMP69 Duct Probe Unit Manual - Vol01B-06-D1 Detectors Fire Manual

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 23

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Built-in MZX Detector base DPK4 - with built-in MZX detector base 5" - 5B DPK4 is suitable for conventional systems Suitable for air velocities from 1 m/s to 20 m/s Can be used in combination with a wide range of optical smoke detectors e.g. 601P or 601PH One-pipe air sampling system simplifies installation Range of aluminium probe tubes are available for ducts up to 2700 mm Transparent lid allows detector to be seen Test hole on cover Sensitive flow indicator Simple service and maintenance Installer friendly connection of cables Easy installation of duct probe tubes

DPK4 Duct Probe


The DPK4 duct probe unit have been developed to detect smoke in ventilation ducts. They offer significant benefits in terms of performance and installation. The system comprises a single duct probe tube and housing specially designed for optimum airflow through the smoke detector and suitable for use in incoming, outgoing and circulation air ducts of ventilation and conditioning systems. The duct probes can operate across a wide range of airflow speeds and are especially recommended for installations in ducts with air flow velocities between 1 m/s and 20 m/s. Unlike more traditional duct probe units that employ an inlet and exhaust tube with sampling holes, the DPK4 unit uses a highly efficient single sampling tube that is slotted along its length. This allows the sampling tubes to be cut to the desired length whilst maintaining maximum efficiency. The transparent cover gives clear visibility of the detector, its LED indication and airflow indicator. A red plastic flag is fixed inside the housing providing a simple but effective confirmation that there is no leakage and that the air flow from the air duct is in fact passing through the housing. In order to reduce the time required to test the duct probe detector during routine maintenance, an aperture is provided that allows aerosol test gas to be directed at the detector without having to dismantle the unit. Accessories Tyco Safety Products offer 3 lengths of the duct probe tubes. The tube is made of aluminium and can easily be shortened to suit the span of the air duct. Where the unit is mounted on insulated or circular air ducts, the DPKM mounting bracket is required.

Product Codes
517.025.049 517.025.051 517.025.052 517.025.053 517.025.054 517.025.055 DPK4 - Duct Probe with MZX detector base 5" - 5B DPK600 - Duct Probe Tube 600 mm DPK1500 - Duct Probe Tube 1500 mm DPK2800 - Duct Probe Tube 2800 mm DPKM - Duct Probe Mounting Bracket Spare Filters for DPK4/DPK4I (Pk 10)

Detector supplied separately

Chapter 3 Page 24

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Callpoints


Features
Integral LED indicator for easy identification of operation Surface or flush mounting Extensive range of conventional callpoints Test key facility, speeds maintenance visits Optional transparent hinged cover Hazardous areas models available (See Special Hazards Section) IP67 Waterproof models for external applications

MCP Series Callpoints


A comprehensive range of callpoints for use with conventional systems. All the callpoints are designed to enable an alarm signal to be given by breaking a glass element. This operates a switch and is indicated by an LED indicator. If required, an optional transparent hinged cover may be installed to guard against accidental operation.

Technical Specification
(Indoor & Outdoor) Housing: Operating Temp.: Outdoor Indoor Relative Humidity: PC/ABS -30oC TO +70oC -10oC TO +55oC up to 95% RH (non-condensing) Commonly Used Callpoints
Model MCP200 MCP210 MCP230 MCP270 Keyswitch Colour Red Red Red Yellow White Type Conventional Conventional Conventional Conventional Conventional Alert Evacuate Alert Evacuate IP Rating 24D 24D 67 24D 24D R4/R1 Ohms 120/470 47/39 120/470 47/39 Not Applicable

Indoor & Outdoor MCP Callpoint


Indoor Callpoint Weight: 110g Outdoor Callpoint Weight: 240g

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 25

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Conventional MCP200 Callpoint
The MCP200 is a red indoor callpoint with alert resistors and LED indicator. The MCP200 is LPCB approved. Product Codes 514.001.142.A MCP200 without backbox-ADT branded 514.001.142.T MCP200 without backbox - Thorn branded 514.001.142.Y MCP200 without backbox - Tyco branded

Conventional MCP210/MCP211 Callpoint


The MCP210 is a red indoor callpoint with LED indicator and evacuate resistors. The MCP210 is LPCB approved and is supplied without a backbox. Product Codes 514.001.143.A MCP210 ADT branded 514.001.143.T MCP210 Thorn branded 514.001.143.Y MCP210 Tyco branded The MCP211 is a red indoor callpoint with evacuate resistors and LED indicator. (For use with the MZX-c Panels only). 514.001.160.Y MCP211 Without backbox - Tyco branded 514.001.160.A MCP211 Without backbox - ADT branded 514.001.160.T MCP211 Without backbox - Thorn branded

Conventional MCP230 Callpoint


The MCP230 is an IP67 red weatherproof callpoint with LED indicator and LPCB approved. Product Codes 514.001.110.A MCP230 ADT branded 514.001.110.T MCP230 Thorn branded 514.001.110.Y MCP230 Tyco branded

Conventional MCP270 Callpoint


Product Code 514.001.114 MCP270 Yellow callpoint Evacuate complete with LED indicator and backbox - LPCB approved

Other Conventional Callpoints & Keyswitches


Product Code 514.002.002.A White keyswitch in callpoint housing. English Bomb Alert marking with ADT branded

Special Marine Callpoints


Product Codes 514.001.112 MCP260M Marine callpoint complete with LED indicator - IP67 514.001.113 MCP250M Marine callpoint complete with LED indicator surface mount

Chapter 3 Page 26

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Callpoint Ancillaries
Product Codes 90-107 Red M141 spacer for red MCP KAC callpoints 515.001.045 Test key for all MCP and CP style callpoints

515.001.128 Callpoint hinged cover for use on MCP & CP style callpoint models (Colour -Clear)

515.001.026 Black callpoint bezel for MCP KAC callpoints

Ancillaries - Back Boxes


Product Codes 515.001.021 Standard Red surface mounting back box for MCP & CP indoor callpoints 10-115 SR2-T Optional Back Box (2 terminals) for MCP & CP indoor callpoints
Unless stated the indoor callpoints are supplied as flush mount units. The range is approved for use with the standard backbox. However, the SR2-T backbox is also available.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 27

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Callpoint Spare Glasses - Current
Product Codes 515.001.119 EN54 Part 11 Spare Glass for MCP and CP series Callpoints (Pack of 5) 515.001.025 CP200 Glasses, clear English text on white background. No logo (Pack of 5). 515.001.127 Deformable operating unit glass for use in place of glasses, for kitchens or other areas where glass is not acceptable. For MCP callpoints only. 515.001.024 CP200 spare glasses, white Arabic/English text with Thorn Security logo on white background (Pack of 5) 515.001.014 CP200 Spare glasses, black Arabic text on a white background (Pack of 5) 515.001.023 CP200 Spare glasses for CP200 white dutch text on clear background (Pack of 5)

Callpoint Spare Glasses - Old


Product Codes 515.001.010 Walsall callpoint glasses (Pack of 10) for service spares. The Walsall callpoint is an old square callpoint with round glass 515.001.003 ZF121 Callpoint glass (Pack 10) for service spares. The ZF121 is a square metal fronted AFA MINERVA callpoint typically used on Firefinder, System 1100, ZF/System 1200, CP and CT systems 515.001.009 CP100A glass unscored (Pack 10) for service spares. The CP100A has a large square glass to the edge of the callpoint. Used on the same AFA systems as the ZF121.

Chapter 3 Page 28

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Prevents accidental operation of callpoints Strong polycarbonate construction Optional break seal kit

STOPPER
The callpoint STOPPER provides protection from malicious or accidental activation of manual callpoints. Available for flush or surface mounted callpoints the STOPPER is also available with optional high pitch sounder which is activated when the lid is lifted. An optional Break-Seal fitting kit allows Break-Seals to be used to provide extra protection.
Product Code 515.001.029 515.001.030 515.001.036 515.001.034 515.001.035 515.001.031 515.001.032 Ref STI6530 STI6531 STI6535 STI1230 STI3150 STI6532 STI6533 STOPPER Flush Surface 4 4 4 4

WARNING:- Break seals only to be fitted by agreement with relevant fire authorities. The STOPPER is suitable for all callpoints up to 100mm square, including the MCP200 and other indoor KAC style callpoints.
STOPPER II With Sounder Weatherproof

4 4

4 4 4 4

STOPPER Dimensions

Product Code
515.001.033 IPO36 Break Seal Kit (pack of 1)

Flush Fit Millimetres A 137 B 140 C 104 D 45 E 12.5 F 12.5 G 185 H 12.5 Stopper STI6530 Stopper with Sounder STI6532

Surface Fit
(+30mm)

STI6531 STI6533

STOPPER STOPPER II Max. Callpoint Size 100 x 100mm 160 x 160 mm Max. Callpoint Depth 57.5 120 (+30mm Surface)

STOPPER II Dimensions

Millimetres A 70 B 16 C 197 D 50 E 178 F 146 G 228 H 254

Stopper II Surface Fit - STI1230

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 29

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Strong polycarbonate construction Will accommodate MCP230 callpoints Tamper resistant

STOPPER II
STOPPER II is constructed as the STOPPER from tough injection moulded polycarbonate. Physically larger than the STOPPER the STOPPER II extends the number of products to which these tough multi-purpose covers can protect. It consists of a strong tamper-proof clear polycarbonate cover and frame that fits easily over such products as break glass callpoints. STOPPER II can also be fitted with an integral battery powered sounder which activates if the cover is lifted. The STOPPER II is suitable for callpoints up to 160mm square.

Product Code
515.001.034

STI1230 Surface Fit STOPPER II

Features
Strong polycarbonate construction Provides environmental protection Ideal for offshore environments

Weather STOPPER & Weather STOPPER II


The Weather STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II extends the life of weather exposed devices, such as break glass callpoints, by offering protection against harsh conditions and environments. Experience has shown that this protective cover can extend the life of products installed in saline atmospheres, such as oil rigs and ship decks. While offering environmental protection the Weather STOPPER and Weather STOPPER II are constructed from tough durable polycarbonate which will also guard against tampering, vandalism or accidental operation of devices such as emergency switches.

Product Codes
515.001.036 515.001.035

STI6535 Surface fit Weather STOPPER STI3150 Surface fit Weather STOPPER II
02/12

Chapter 3 Page 30

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard
The Smoke Beam/CCTV Guard is manufactured from tough coated steel rod and is designed to protect projected beam detectors or CCTV cameras from vandalism or accidental damage. Suitable for use with System Sensor, Hochiki and Fireray 2000 detectors. Technical Specification Dimensions: 260H x 200W x 321D mm Product Code 516.015.009 STI9625 Smoke beam/CCTV guard

Keybox
This tough polycarbonate breakglass keybox is available to protect emergency keys. Product Code 515.001.043 STI6720 Keybox with printed glass

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 31

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Sounders and Beacons


Features
Wide range of both bells and electronic sounders High sound output characteristics Low current consumption Clean lines, modern styling Easy to install, low installation costs Weatherproof units for outdoor use Distinct sounds are available Motorised and Solenoid bells available Wide range of voltages available

Sounders
A range of sounders to meet a wide variety of alarm applications where loud, penetrating and distinctive warnings must be given to alert people of fire situations. In addition, multitone electronic sounders can give a variety of sounds to signal other conditions e.g.extinguishing gas release imminent, etc.

Note: For I.S. & Flameproof sounders, please see the special hazards section.

Chapter 3 Page 32

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Solenoid Operated Designed for Long Life Stove Enamelled Dome

6 Red Solenoid Operated Friedland Bell


The bells are the underdome type, with a high resonance pressed alloy-steel gong to ensure a loud clear ring tone. The operating mechanism is fully enclosed and the gong is red stove enamelled for long life. The bells are designed for internal use, but gasket sealed conduit boxes can be provided for external use.

Product Code
576.500.014 240V Red bell 6 240Vac solenoid operated. Fire text

Features
CE marked Low current 6 bell (ONLY 11mA) Low cost Extra high 95dBA/m Slim profile (53mm) Fully suppressed and polarised Quick and easy to install LPCB approved to EN54 Pt 3

6 & 8 Motorised Bells


Model MBF-6EV MBF-8EV MBA 8EV Rated Voltage 24V d.c. 24V d.c. 24V d.c. Rated Current 11mA 17mA 18mA Sound output 90-95dBA 90-97dBA 91-97dBA Operating Temp -12 to +50C -10 to +50C Colour Red Weight 410g 640g 1100g with back box

Product Codes
576.501.039.A 576.501.039.T 576.501.040.A 576.501.044.A 576.501.044.T 576.501.045 MBF-6EV ADT Branded MBF-6EV Thorn Branded MBF-8EV ADT Branded MBA-8EV ADT Branded MBA-8EV Thorn Branded BBX4 (2) W/P Backbox for MBA-8 Bell

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 33

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Weatherproof Option Flexible Mounting Option Attractive Design

Electronic Solenoid Bell


Unique patented alarm bell with miniature solenoid and integrated electronic control. No backbox required for surface wiring.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Voltage: Typical Current: Typ. Sound Output: 6 diameter 18-30Vdc 24Vdc@30mA 94dB (A)@1m

Product Codes
20-100 6 24Vdc Electronic bell, weatherproof IP33C Wormald Branded 20-101 6 24Vdc Electronic bell - red IP21C - Wormald Branded 20-111 6 24Vdc Electronic bell - white IP21C Marine Approved Products 576.501.407 MED 6 24Vdc Electronic bell, weatherproof IP33C 576.501.408 MED 6 24Vdc Electronic bell-red IP21C

Features
Low Current Concumption Suppressed and Polarised Sturdy Construction

CF Motorised Bells
The CF Motorised bells are low current, fully supressed and polarised.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Colour: Output Voltage: Typical Current: Tycpical Sound Output: 6 & 8 Diameter available Red 20-28Vdc 25/28mA @ 24Vdc 95/97dB (A) @ 1m

Product Codes
Marine Approved Products

576.501.405 576.501.406

MED 6 Red 24Vdc Motorised bell, Fire text with Thorn Branding MED 8 Red 24Vdc Motorised bell, Fire text with Thorn Branding

Chapter 3 Page 34

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Modern aesthetic design 32 Selectable tones 3 Volume settings Push and twist mount Shallow and deep bases Available in red or white Low current consumption 2 Stage alarm available Independently switched sounder or beacon Xenon beacon with the Excel Lite

Banshee Excel Sounders


The Banshee Excel sounder replaces the Banshee Multi Tone range of Sounders. It uses the same technically superior rocking arm transducer to reproduce the familiar 32 tones of the previous Banshee and Bedlam ranges.

Banshee Excel Lite Sounder Beacon


The new Banshee Excel adds the Banshee Excel Lite Sounder Beacon to its range using a high output xenon with the familiar sounder. The Banshee Excel Lite can be used as a multi stage device by switching the beacon and the sounder independently using a third wire.

Technical Specification
Approvals: LPCB & VdS approved to EN54-3 Tones available: 32 Operating voltage: 9-30Vdc Tone current consumption: See Tone Table in Chapter 11 Flash current consumption: 40mA Operating temperature range (Deg C): -40 to +70 Volume control via DIL switch: Maximum, Medium (-10dBA), Low (-20dBA) Flash rate per second: 1 Ingress Protection: IP45 or IP66 Termination: Screw terminals for 028mm2 to 2.5mm2 wire conductor

Product Codes
576.501.060 576.501.061 576.501.062 576.501.063 Banshee Excel sounder, red, IP45 (replaces 576.501.005.A & 576.501.005.T) Banshee Excel sounder, white, IP45 (replaces 576.501.009 & 576.501.025.A) Banshee Excel sounder, red, IP66 (replaces 576.501.016.A & 576.501.016.T) Banshee Excel Lite, red sounder, red xenon beacon, IP45

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 35

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Accessories
The combined mounting bracket for the Besson Multi-tone Banshee and Xenon Beacon allows quick and neat installation of combined sounders and beacons. The bracket allows the following electronic sounders to be mounted with the range of 1W Xenon Beacons: Besson Banshee MINERVA FIRECRYER voice enhanced sounder The bracket can be used with any of the 24Vd.c 1W Xenon beacons in red, clear, amber or blue (Part no.'s 540.001.030/031/032 & 033) Product Code 576.501.047 Banshee/Xenon bracket

Besson Wafer Sounder


The standard Besson Wafer sounder is supplied in white with a blank cover included. The specification is as follows: Input voltage: 24V d.c. (+/-25%) Sound Output: 60dBA/90dBA at 1m typical (pot. Adjustable) offering the same sound formats as the Banshee sounder range. It can therefore be used in conjunction with the Banshee sounders on the same site. Technical Specification Current: 4mA to 15mA Temperature Range: -40C to + 70C Dimensions: Dia 103mm, Height 22mm (excluding coverplate) Product Code 576.501.038 Besson wafer sounder and blank cover in white

Flush Mount Bedroom Sounder


Meeting the requirements for BS5839 part 1, the Bedroom Sounder range is well suited to hotels and residential environments where aesthetics is a prime concern. Matching the sound output of the Banshee range of sounders so therefore they can be mixed on the same site. Features Low current consumption 7mA Dual sound options selected via a jumper switch: Continuous and Fast Sweep 90dB Can be both Flush and Surface mounted Robust terminal connectors to accommodate up to 2.5mm2 conductors Product Codes 576.501.032.A Flush Mount Sounder ADT Branded 576.501.032.T Flush Mount Sounder Thorn Branded

Yodalarms
This versatile range of sounders are ideally suited for fire, safety and security hazard warning. Technical Specification Dimensions: YO3: 89H x 89W x 85D mm YO5: 134H x 134W x 128D mm YO8: 216H x 216W x 153D mm Product Codes 576.501.001 YO3 Yodalarm 3 24Vdc 100dB @ 1Mtr 576.501.002 YO5 Yodalarm 5 24Vdc 106dB @ 1Mtr 576.501.003 YO8 Yodalarm 8 24Vdc 112dB @ 1Mtr

Chapter 3 Page 36

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


MZX-c 2 Wire Symphoni Sounder
A Symphoni electronic sounder designed specifically for installation on the detection zone of the MZX-c panel Technical Specification Sound Output @ 1M: 100dB(A) +/-2dB(A) @ 24Vdc Continuous - 970Hz Tones: Alternating - 970/800 Hz at 2 Hz Pulsed - 970 Hz at 1Hz Operating Temp: -25 to+70 C Construction: Red/White ABS Ingress Protection: IP42 Termination: 2.5mm2 Screw Terminals Product Codes 576.501.204 Symphoni 2 Wire Sounder (Red) 576.501.205 Symphoni 2 Wire Sounder (White)

24Vdc Symphoni Sounder


The 24Vdc Symphoni Sounder is a general purpose internal sounder, available either as a very high output sounder for noisy areas, or a high output low current sounder for applications where power is limited. Both versions share the same horn and backbox which has double cable entries for ease of installation. The low power version has 3 selectable tones which may be employed for one, two or three stage alarm applications. The high output version has 32 selectable tones and retains full tone compatibility with the Roshni, Squashni and Askari product ranges. Product Codes 576.501.200 SY/R Low Power Red Symphoni Sounder (3 tone) 576.501.201 SY/W Low Power White Symphoni Sounder (3 tone) 576.501.202 SYHO/R High Output Red Symphoni Sounder (32 tone) 576.501.203 SYHO/W High Output White Symphoni Sounder (32 tone)

Technical Specification
Model Operation Operating Voltage Range Sound Output @ 1m Volume Control Current Consumption Tones Symphoni High Output 2 Hours Continuous 9-28Vdc Up to 120dB(A) 240mA +/- 20mA on Tone 3 1 to 32 Symphoni (Low Power) Continuous 12-30Vdc 100dB(A) +/- 2dB(A) @24Vd. c. Down to 80dB approx. 5mA +/- 1mA at all volumes Alternating 990Hz/650Hz@2Hz Continuous 990Hz Intermittent 990Hz, On/Off@1Hz Synchronised Start +/- 0.5% -25C to +70C Polarised Input ABS Plastic Case IP42 0.212Kg

Synchronisation Frequency Stability Operating Temperature Line Monitoring Method Construction Ingress Protection Weight

Synchronised Start +/- 0.15% -25 C to +55C Polarised Input ABS Plastic Case IP42 0.58Kg

Roshni
A flexible alarm sounder for Fire and Security applications complete with volume control and dil switch to provide 32 tones. Low profile Roshni with Deep base offers IP65 protection. All Roshni sounders have synchronised start for self synchronisation without third wire. Output Voltage: 9-28Vdc Typical Current: 24Vdc@16mA Typ. Sound Output: @1m 102dB Product Codes ROSHRDSR ROSHNI Sounder c/w deep base red 576.501.220 ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base - red 576.501.221 ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base - white 576.501.222 ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - Red 576.501.223 ROSHNI/Flashni Deep Base - White Marine Approved Products 576.501.401 MED W/P ROSHNI Sounder c/w deep base-red 576.501.402 MED ROSHNI Sounder c/w shallow base-red

Technical Specification Dimensions: 93 Dia x 105D mm (Deep base) Red or white Colour:

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 37

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Squashni
The Squashni electronic sounder is the original ceiling sounder for use as a universal fire detector platform or as a stand alone sounder complete with blank cover. It comes preset to tone 3 with a volume control and is fully compatible with Roshni tones, and has a synchronised start. Technical Specification Dimensions: 112 Dia x 27D mm Colour: Matched to leading fire detector manufacturers Approvals: None Output Voltage: 9-28Vdc Typical Current: 24Vdc@16mA Typ. Sound Output: @1m 93dB (A) Product Codes 576.501.030 Squashni white 24Vdc 576.501.031 Blank cover plate white for Squashni

Multi-Tone Askari Compact


The Multi-Tone Askari Compact is a compact bedroom sounder for unobtrusive installation. It comes with a volume control and is fully compatible with Roshni tones and has a synchronised start. A surface mount backbox is available from the supplier to special order. Technical Specification Dimensions: 87.5H x 87.5W x 36D mm Colour: Red or white Approvals: Input Voltage: Typ. Current: Typ. Sound Output: BS 5839 pt 1 9-28Vdc 18mA @ 24Vdc 97dB (A) @1m Product Codes 576.501.242 Multi Tone Askari Compact Sounder - white 576.501.243 Multi Tone Askari Compact Sounder - red

Chapter 3 Page 38

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Single Message or Multiple Message using the same sounder Multi Message facilitates multi evacuation strategies Clear and unambiguous alarm messages Voice Alarm Messages provoke an immediate response Sound Output Up to 100db(A) (Fire-Cryer Plus), 90db(A) (Mini Fire-Cryer Plus), 110db(A) (Midi FireCryer Plus) Optional integral Red Strobe Low current consumption average 20mA No special wiring easily retro fitted Fully synchronised over multi zones Deep base version available to IP66 Ultra slim base sounder to fit industry standard detectors Suitable for ceiling or wall mounting (Mini Fire-Cryer Plus) Optional front plate for stand alone use (Mini Fire-Cryer Plus) Voice Message Controller makes manual message switching easy

Fire-Cryer Plus - Voice Enhanced Sounders


The Fire-Cryer Plus range of voice sounders are electronic sounders which are pre-programmed with 9 messages. Each of the Fire-Cryer voice sounders can be used as a single message voice sounder by simply installing them on to a conventional 24Vdc sounder circuit or by using a sounder controller on a loop. The choice of message(s) broadcast can be selected using a DIL switch on the rear of the sounder. See Table A The Fire-Cryer Plus offers an excellent service upgrade opportunity for systems as well as a highly flexible and cost effective solution to providing a voice evacuation system to many buildings. The choice of Fire-Cryer voice sounders can be selected using Table B Messages 1 to 7 in Table A can be used in a multi message installation with the addition of a Multi Message Switching PCB (576.501.171) or a Voice Message Controller (576.501.181 or 576.501.182) interfaced between the fire alarm control panel and the sounder circuits. The Voice Message Controllers can be supplied with a 2.5A or 5.25A power supply built in. A Zone Extension PCB (576.501.172) is available to extend the system to 4 zones or 8 sounder circuits. See Table C A special Extinguishing PCB (576.501.173) used with the 576.501.135 will enable 1st, 2nd Stage, Hold and Gas Released messages to be automatically broadcast dependent on the state of the alarm. See Table A1

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 39

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Fire-Cryer Plus Multi Message PCB
Product Code

576.501.171

Fire-Cryer Plus Multi Message PCB

Fire-Cryer Plus Zone Extension PCB


Product Code

576.501.172

Fire-Cryer Plus Zone Extension PCB

Fire-Cryer Plus Extinguishing PCB


Product Code

576.501.173

Fire-Cryer Plus Extinguishing PCB

VMC / Multi Message PCB and 2.5A PSU


Product Code

576.501.181

VMC / Multi Message PCB and 2.5A PSU

VMC / Multi Message / Zone Extension PCB and 5.25A PSU


Product Code

576.501.182

VMC / Multi Message / Zone Extension PCB and 5.25A PSU

Chapter 3 Page 40

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Technical Specification
Fire-Cryer Plus Model Fire-Cryer Plus VDC Operating Voltage 20-28 Current mA @ 24VDC Peak/Avg - Sounder only 27/20 Current mA @ 24VDC Typical: Sounder with low current strobe 33/26 Current mA @ 24VDC Typical: Sounder with high current strobe 52/60 Current mA @ 24VDC Low current strobe only 13 Current mA @ 24VDC High current strobe only 32 Strobe Output Cd (LOW) 2 Strobe Output Cd (HIGH) 6 Volume Adjustment from Max. dBA Output to max output -18dBA 82 to 100 Weatherproofing (IP66 requires Deep Base) IP45 or IP66 Housing Material ABS Temperature Range C Colour Connections Midi 20-28 180/100 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 101 to 110 IP44 Aluminium/ Plastic Base -25 to +70 -10 to +55 -25 to +70 Red or White White Red Screw TB 1.5mm Screw TB 1.5mm Clamp 2.5mm2 Mini 20-28 27/20 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a 72 to 90 n/a ABS

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 41

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Standard Message Set which consists of 9 pre-programmed messages with tones (See Table A)

When used as a Multi Message sounder DIL Switches 4, 5, 6, 7 and 8 are OFF. When used as a single messa sounder use the DIL Switch settings in the table below 1 = ON, 0 = OFF When used as a Multi Message Sounder the Multi Message Switching PCB (576.501.171) will assign the messages to the following triggers: Starting Tone (See Table (A2) below)

Table A

Two Letter Message Code

Beacon Flashes Y/N

Speech Message

SW6

SW4

SW5

Message 1 1 AK Y Fire emergency. Please remain calm and evacuate the building immediately S1A/S1B 1 Message 2 2 AB Y This is a fire alert. This is a fire alert. Await further instructions. Await further instructions. MA 0 Message 3 2 MA Y Standby alert. Close all blinds and move to the middle of the room. MB 1 Message 4 0 AD N All clear. All clear. No further action required. MC 0 Message 5 0 SP N This is an ADT fire test. No action required. MD 1 Message 6 3 CC N This is a class change announcement. ME 0 Message 7 1 AF Y Fire detected. Keep calm. Leave the building by the nearest exit. MF 1 Message 8 2 AZ Y Ladies and gentlemen due to unforeseen circumstances we must ask you to leave the building immediately by the nearest exit or as directed by members of staff. 0 Message 9 2 AX Y We have an emergency situation. Please leave the building by the nearest exit. Members of staff will assist you. 1

0 1 1 0 0 1 1

0 0 0 1 1 1 1

SW7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1

0 0

0 0

Table A1

GAS EXTINGUISHANT MESSAGES (Used with 576.501.135) Starting Tone (See Table (A2) below)

Two Letter Message Code

Beacon Flashes Y/N

Speech Message

1st Stage 2nd Stage Hold Gas Released

2 2 0 1

CG CH LU CJ

Y Y N Y

First stage extinguishant release warning. Second stage extinguishant release warning. Extinguishant gas release on hold. Extinguishant released.

Table A2 Tone 0 1 2 3

No tone Banshee LF Fast Sweep. 800Hz to 950Hz swept @ 9hz Banshee LF Fast Sweep. 800Hz to 950Hz swept @ 9hz Pulsed at 1 second ON, 1 second OFF Bell tone, pulsed

SW8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Chapter 3 Page 42

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Ordering Fire-Cryer Plus Voice Sounders
Step 1 - Choose your Fire-Cryer Sounder

Table B Type Wall Mount Body Colour Beacon Red Red None Wall Mount Wall Mount White Red Red None Red Base Shallow Deep Shallow Deep Shallow Shallow Shallow Part Ref. 576.501.131 576.501.132 576.501.133 576.501.134 576.501.141 576.501.142 576.501.135

Wall Mount Base Mount

Red White

None None

Deep n/a

576.501.151 576.501.161

Step 2 - Choose your Interfaces for Multi Message Systems Table C Standard Multi Message Switching PCB Zone Extension PCB (adds 3 Zones of 2 Sounder Circuits i.e. 6 sounder circuits. Must be used with 576.501.171) Extinguishant Interface PCB 576.501.171 576.501.172 576.501.173

Voice Message Controllers & PSUs (All VMC enclosures include a 576.501.171) 576.501.171 576.501.172 PSU Box Size Part Ref Yes No 2.5A M2 576.501.181 Yes Yes 5.25A M3 576.501.182 Box Sizes M2 Enclosure 385W x 310H x 90D mm M3 Enclosure 385W x 520H x 90D mm

Product Codes
576.501.131 576.501.132 576.501.133 576.501.134 576.501.135 576.501.141 576.501.142 576.501.151 576.501.161 576.501.171 576.501.172 576.501.173 576.501.181 576.501.182 576.501.191 Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red wall mounted, shallow base, red beacon Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red wall mounted, deep base, red beacon Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red, wall mounted, shallow base Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, red, wall mounted, deep base Standard Fire-Cryer Plus (for use with 576.501.173 in Gas Extinguishant systems) Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, white wall mounted, shallow base, red beacon Standard Fire-Cryer Plus, white, wall mounted, shallow base Midi Fire-Cryer Plus, c/w back box, red Mini Fire-Cryer Plus, base mounted, white, c/w cover Fire-Cryer Plus Multi Message PCB Fire-Cryer Plus Zone Extension PCB Fire-Cryer Plus Extinguishing PCB Voice Message Controller c/w Multi Message PCB and 2.5A PSU Voice Message Controller c/w Multi Message PCB, Zone Extension PCB and 5.25A PSU Fire-Cryer Plus Demo Unit

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 43

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Single Gang Lamp/Buzzer Units
Lamp Buzzer units may be used for local alarms when high level audible warnings may not be appropriate. Available in flush and surface mount versions to fit standard single gang backboxes. Features Low Current Flush or Surface Mount Hi-Brightness LED Technical Specification Dimensions: 90H x 90W x 40D mm Current Rating: 15mA at 24Vdc nominally Product Codes 540.011.012 Single gang flush mount LED (red)/Buzzer Unit labelled Fire Alarm 540.011.013 Single gang surface mount LED (red)/Buzzer Unit labelled Fire Alarm c/w surface backbox.

Solista LED Beacon


Ultra low power requirement 3mA or 6mA at 24Vdc. Long life low profile design. Protected to IP54, supplied complete with base. Product Code 576.501.230 Solista LED Beacon (Red)

Easy AVTM Retrofit LED Beacon


This low power LED beacon is designed to be retrofitted to existing Banshee electronic sounders. Easy and fast installation typically 3 min. Low power 6mA max at 24Vdc.High Output LEDs. Product Code 576.501.012 Easy AV strobe for Banshee Sounders

NOTE: For I.S. Flameproof Beacons, please see the special hazards section.

Chapter 3 Page 44

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Available in 1, 2, 3 and 5 watts Protected to IP65 Attractive low profile design Optional bracket for mounting both Beacon and Banshee Sounder

Xenon Beacons - 24V Including Surface Mount Adaptor


This high quality range of Xenon beacons are tested to IP 65 making them ideal for the most stringent applications. Each beacon incorporates a low profile Fresnel lens designed to give maximum light output.

Technical Specification
Voltage V d.c. 24 24 24 24 Power Output Alarm Current Watt(s) mA 1 42 2 84 3 126 5 210 Flash Rate 60/min 60/min 60/min 60/min Rating IP65 IP65 IP65 IP65 Temp. Range Height -30 to +70C -30 to +70C -30 to +70C -30 to +70C Dimensions (mm) Diameter 51 75 51 75 51 75 75 90

Product Codes
540.001.030 540.001.031 540.001.032 540.001.033 20-112 20-113 20-120 Low profile clear 24Vdc 1 watt Low profile blue 24Vdc 1 watt Low profile amber 24Vdc 1 watt Low profile red 24Vdc 1 watt Low profile red 24Vdc 2 watt Low profile red 24Vdc 5 watt Low profile red 24Vdc 3 watt

Features
High Power 10 Candela Current Surge Suppression High Efficiency 88mA at 24VDC 1 Hz Flash Rate Protected to IP54 Wide Operating Voltage 10 to 60 VDC Operating Temperature -25oC to + 70oC

Solex 10 cd Xenon Beacon


A Solex 10 Candela Xenon Beacon with a red lens and a white shallow base which can be used wherever a high power xenon beacon is required. Due to the high power output and current consumption it is recommended that this device is not used with the MZX-c, MZX-c+ or similar small panels (an SB520 sounder booster module and PSU may be required in some cases).

Product Code
576.501.232 Solex 10 cd Beacon with red lens and white base

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 45

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
Combined strobe & sounder Matches Roshni sounders Weather Resistant to IP65

Flashni - Sounder/Strobe
A combined sounder and beacon which combines the features of the Roshni electronic sounder with a fully integrated Xenon beacon. These sounders are fully compatible with all Roshni tones.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: 93 Dia x 92D mm (Shallow base) 93 Dia x 121D mm (Deep base) 18-30Vdc 68mA@24Vdc 101dB (A)@1m

Product Codes
20-118 576.501.224 Combined Roshni sounder/strobe complete with deep base (IP65). Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red Body/Red Lens complete with shallow base & tone switch. Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red Body/Red Lens, deep base, tone switch & separate sounder/strobe operation.

Output Voltage: Typical Current: Typ. Sound Output:

576.501.227

Marine Approved Product

576.501.403

MED Combined Roshni Sounder/Strobe, Red Body/Red Lens complete with shallow base

Chapter 3 Page 46

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features

.

Combined Sounder and LED Beacon Low Current -10mA @ 24VDC 6 selectable tones Volume control (2 levels) White housing, clear lens with red LEDs DDA compliant audio visual solution for UK Neat unobtrusive design Ideal for hotels, care homes, schools & offices Independent power cables allow a large number of AV platform sounders to be driven from a single 24V circuit 90dB sound output >1Cd light output at 1 Hz Approved to EN54-3

Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon


This low current combined sounder/beacon is ideal for standalone usage utilising the optional blanking cap or can be used in conjunction with a 4 base and detector. When used with a detector it will provide a single point of installation for the detector, sounder and beacon. This is a conventional sounder / beacon and needs to be powered from the panel sounder outputs.

Product Codes
576.501.250 576.501.255 517.050.401 517.050.005 Squashni G3/AV Sounder Beacon Squashni G3/AV Blanking Cap Pack of 5 4 Universal Base 4 Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 47

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems


Features
2 Wire for use with MZX-c Fire Controllers Combined Sounder and LED Beacon Low Current 4 selectable tones Volume control (2 levels) Beacon Only option (switchable) White housing, clear lens with red LEDs DDA compliant audio visual solution for UK Neat unobtrusive design Ideal for hotels, offices, care homes, schools & offices 90dB sound output >1Cd Light output at 1 Hz Maximum number per zone = 10

Squashni G3/AV 2 Wire Sounder Beacon - (Twin Wire)


This low current combined sounder beacon is designed specifically for installation on the detection loop of the MZXc control panel. Ideal for standalone usage utilising the optional blanking cap or can be used in conjunction with a 4 base and detector. When used with a detector it will provide a single point of installation for the detector, sounder and beacon. This is a 2 wire sounder/beacon and can be used on all zones of the MZX-c control panel.

Product Codes
576.501.251 576.501.255 517.050.401 517.050.005 Squashni G3/AV 2 Wire Sounder Beacon Squashni G3/AV Blanking Cap Pack of 5 4 Universal Base 4 Detector Base Locking Pin Kit (PK100)

Chapter 3 Page 48

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems Service & Spares


T1200 CONVENTIONAL MARINE PANEL MZX-e EXTINGUISHING PANEL C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITH AC PSU (509.023.001) C1626 4 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU (509.023.002) C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU (509.023.003) C1627 16 ZONE PANEL MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU FOR T1232 (509.023.004) C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD WITH AC PSU (509.023.011) C1626 REPEATER MOTHERBOARD WITHOUT AC PSU (509.023.012) C1628 4 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY PCB (509.023.021) C1628 16 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY PCB (509.023.022) C1629 32 ZONE PANEL DISPLAY PCB (509.023.023) C1628 16 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY PCB (509.023.031) C1629 32 ZONE REPEATER DISPLAY PCB (509.023.032) C1630 OUTPUT EXPANSION INTERFACE PCB (2605060) C1632 16 ZONE PANEL EXPANSION PCB (509.023.042) PS136 5.0 AMP 110/230VAC PSU (509.023.051) PS40 1.5 AMP 24VDC PSU (509.023.052) T1200 SPARE KEY SET (509.023.061) MZX-c CONVENTIONAL PANEL 2 ZONE 2 WIRE MZX-c MOTHERBOARD (2605508) 4 ZONE 2 WIRE MZX-c MOTHERBOARD (2605509) 8 ZONE 2 WIRE MZX-c MOTHERBOARD (2605510) MZX-c MOTHERBOARD 8 ZONE REPEATER (2605505) MZX-c POWER SUPPLY (BAQ35T-24) MZX-c SPARE ENABLE KEY (2501061) MZX-c ZONE EOL UNIT - PK5 (2605538) MZX-c+ CONVENTIONAL PANEL MZX-c+ MZX-c+ MZX-c+ MZX-c+ MZX-c+ SPARE KEY SET (557.201.508) 5.0 AMP PSU - C1652 (2605071) TRANSFORMER 1.5 AMP (2000636) TRANSFORMER 3.0 AMP (2000637) TRANSFORMER 5.0 AMP (2000638) MZX-e SPARE KEY SET (557.201.508) EXTINGUISHING ANCILLARIES LAMP 28V 60mA (MCC) FOR T525 (599.001.012) 24V5WSBC SP BULB FOR E1/E3 (599.001.029) MANUAL ALARM CALLPOINTS ZF121 CALLPOINT GLASS (PK10) (515.001.003) CP100A CALLPOINT GLASS UNSCORED (PK10) (515.001.009) WALSALL CALLPOINT GLASS (PK10) (515.001.010) CP200 CALLPOINT GLASS-ARABIC (PK5) (515.001.014) CP200N CALLPOINT GLASS (PK5) (515.001.023) CP200 CALLPOINT ARABIC/ENGLISH GLASS (PK5) (515.001.024) CP200 CALLPOINT ENGLISH GLASS NO LOGO (PK5) (515.001.025) STOPPER BREAK SEAL KIT-RED (PK1) (515.001.033) MCP/CP CALLPOINT TEST KEY (PK1) (515.001.045) MCP/CP CALLPOINT EN54 PT11 SPARE GLASS (PK5) (515.001.119) DEFORMABLE MCP ELEMENT (PK1) (515.001.127)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 3 Page 49

Chapter 3 - Conventional Systems

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 3 Page 50

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics Tyco Expert Graphics (TXG)


Features
Provides annunciation, status display, and control in both normal and emergency situations Developed by Tyco specifically to provide monitoring and control of fire protection life safety systems Supports a range of fire detection systems:Minerva MX and MZX Minerva Simplex 4100 range 4100, 4120, 4020,4100U with upgrade paths to 2120 Zettler Zetfas, Wormald PBS16, Tyco Fast 2000 Multiple workstations can be configured for specific functions or redundant operation Single monitor or two monitor (text and graphics) support at each workstation

Emergency Management System & Fire Detection Graphical User Interface


Tyco Expert Graphics is a new client/server emergency management system and fire detection graphical user interface. TXG is based on a Tyco graphical alarm monitoring system that has been installed on hundreds of large fire detection and alarm monitoring systems around the world and will now be able to integrate the Minerva MX product range with improved functionality, particularly suited to the MX Graph markets. Tyco Expert Graphics provides annunciation, status display, and control for various fire detection and alarm systems including MX networks incorporating the latest MX Technology fire detection systems. It also supports the predecessor Minerva fire detection systems thus ensuring that future updates from Minerva to MX technology can be accommodated. Additional support is provided for Simplex 4100 range, Zetfas and Fast2000\PBS (Token ring format). TXG is a Microsoft Windows based graphical interface with a high resolution colour display. Responsive touch-screen (optional) buttons with realistic icons provide control switches specific to the operation being performed. Utilising a combination of symbols, floor plans, pictures, text, voice messages and video input, TXG displays the precise location and gives instructions on what emergency action should be taken. Additional Features Link up with I.P CCTV camera systems, no additional . wiring, reduced installation cost for a fully integrated fire\CCTV system Compatible with Flamevision FV300 array based IR flame detectors with built in CCTV MX Hotspot, chromatic analogue display. Programmable tracking of analogue values. Changes display colour in response to changes in analogue value from a selected number of MX devices. Trending diagrams of analogue values helps reduce maintenance time and cost Export analogue values to Excel for in depth analysis Audio descriptions of screens can be played when they are displayed or played when an event occurs The display can be configured to track detector inputs by changing the colour of areas in response to changes in analogue value. A detailed map of the area affected can be printed automatically for use by personnel responding to an emergency. Prompt response to a fire emergency, with the correct action, provides the opportunity to reduce financial loss and greatly improves safety. Much of the work involved in configuring TXG has been simplified through the automatic import of panel configurations and the ability to use a wide range of input data file types including GIF, JPG, bitmap, AutoCAD, Vector and WAV files. System maintenance can be carried out via the high level user interface with the ability to edit the position and attributes of point icons as well as make changes to drawing layouts. As well as simplifying maintenance, being a true client server application means that any number of on-site or off-site workstations can interrogate the database with pre-defined security levels to facilitate any required combination of access and control.

High level user interface allows end user to make changes to point attributes and layout further reducing lifetime cost of ownership. Centralised security administration means that operator accounts are administered through the TXG clients common database Mouse, keyboard or touch-screen control with full multimedia compatibility Dual language switching The ability to display live video when specific predefined alarm conditions occur Easy to configure and set-up. No special networking or PC training required Facilities and maintenance management report and analysis tools are available

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 4 Page 1

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics


The IP Video feature allows real-time images of the area at risk to be displayed in the event of an alarm or fault. Video capture of the affected area appears on the screen automatically, allowing the severity of the situation to be assessed quickly and the appropriate executive action to be taken. For less serious incidents, expensive and unnecessary plant shut downs can be avoided. In more critical situations, accurate information can be quickly and efficiently communicated to the response team. MX HOTSPOT Icons representing the devices being monitored will change colour dependant on status, alarm, normal, fault, isolate etc. In addition to this, selected areas can be highlighted using the chromatic analogue display feature, MX HOTSPOT. As the analogue value of a monitored point changes the chromatic analogue display will change the highlight colour through a pre-defined range. For example a heat detector assigned MX HOTSPOT could transit the highlight from blue to red. The number of chromatic steps is dependant on the resolution of the graphics card used, 16, 24 or 32 bits. NOTIFICATION BY EMAIL Events, whether they are real or false alarms are handled most efficiently when information can be quickly and accurately communicated. TXG allows users to set up email groups and notification texts linked to predetermined events. These are automatically transmitted ensuring that the appropriate resource is deployed. ADDITIONAL FUNCTIONS AND FEATURES Response buttons with configurable icons or text provide control switches specific to any operation being performed Uses a combination of symbols, floor plans, pictures, text and video to communicate events Standard MX and Minerva symbol libraries supplied Gives instructions on what emergency action should be taken Prints maps and instructions to assist response teams History logging recallable or printable by event, dates, device, or a host of other available filters The advanced filter allows the history report to be specifically limited to a particular range or date period. Commands to control outputs from the Graphical User Interface Events can be accepted individually or can be auto-accept Supports all standard PC image file types (i.e. GIF, JPG, BMP), AutoCAD & Vector file types AVAILABILITY AND ORDER PROCESS TXG can be downloaded from the tycoemea.com website and can be used with a time restriction for demonstration or training purposes. TXG can also be ordered from our Letchworth and Echt distribution centres. Customers can fax or e-Mail an order form which details the software options required, to customer service at Letchworth. Original order forms can be obtained from http://www.tycoemea.com/. This form will allow customer service to prepare and allocate a license code that will activate the required features. Customers will also be required to place an order on JDE for each part number on the form. A media pack containing CD with license number, dongle, multi language manuals on CD and original order form will be dispatched to the customer. On receipt, the software can be loaded and the license number entered to make available the requested software features.

Product Codes
508.040.100 508.040.001 508.040.002 508.040.003 TXG USB Server Dongle/License/Software TXG001-Single Client with 1 panel (Requires TXG USB) TXG004-Single Client with 2 to 4 panels (Requires TXG USB and TXG001) TXG010-Single Client with 5 to 10 panels (Requires TXG USB, TXG001 and TXG004) TXG020-Single Client with 11 to 20 panels (RequiresTXG USB, TXG001, TXG004 and TXG010) TXG999-Single Client with 21 or above panels (Requires TXG USB, TXG001, TXG004 TXG010 and TXG020) TXG-C Additional Client license TXG-MIN80 Minerva driver license TXG-OPC - OPC Alarm / Event & Data Access Server Licence TXG-CPP - SIMPLEX CPP driver TXG-PBS/FAST2000 DRIVER TXG Emergency Management PC (no monitor) 19 LCD Touchscreen Monitor

508.040.004

508.040.005

508.040.011 508.040.021 508.040.025 508.040.027 508.040.033 508.020.025 508.020.019

Chapter 4 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics


TXG IS TOTALLY SCALABLE
FROM A SINGLE FIRE ALARM PANEL CONNECTED TO A TXG SERVER The modest additional cost of a single TXG client/server is easily justified when the benefits that a Graphical User Interface bring are considered.

RS232

TXG with direct connection to a single Minerva MX

TO A COMPLEX INSTALLATION WITH MULTIPLE DIVERSE NETWORKS AND DISTRIBUTED CLIENTS Large multi-building facilities may have a number of fire detection networks, possibly installed over an extended period of time. TXG can be used as a hub to integrate these systems with a number clients providing annunciation and control where it is needed.

Zetfas Simplex 4100 Range Wormald PBS 16

Tyco Fast 2000

Minerva network via TLK800 Interface

TXG Client

TLI 800EN-G Interface

TXG Server

TXG Client

CCTV Surveillance System TXG Client TCP\IP

Minerva MX Network

TXG with multiple fire detection networks and CCTV integration

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 4 Page 3

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics


Features
Allows MZX Technology Fire Controllers to be seamlessly networked together Dual ARM 7 RISC processors Support for Emergency Mode Indication True peer-to-peer communications; no host or master controller required Highly resilient, node failure open and short circuit does not affect remaining network Approved to EN54-13 and EN54-2 Up to 99 controllers may be used on the network Wide range of cable topography supported Network can use a variety of cable types with up to 2500m between nodes (cable dependant), 1200m using standard 1.5mm MICC cable FOM800 Plug on fibre optic module provides up to 5000m between nodes using 62.5/125 multimode fibres Easy to install and programme Simple to operate

TLI800EN Network Interface Module and FOM800 Fibre Optic Module


Inter-controller Network The use of the MZX Technology Network allows the fragmentation of a number of fire controllers to be drawn into a network system. Because every installation is different, the MZX Technology Network has been designed to be highly flexible, allowing for a wide range of different systems applications. With a large network system the amount of data and information passing between fire controllers can become high during an emergency condition. The MZX Technology Network communication protocol has been specifically designed with this in mind and ensures that each event message passed around the network is acknowledged by the receiving controller in the fastest possible time. Operation The network is totally flexible and enables from 2 to 99 fire controllers to be seamlessly linked together, providing a system capability of up to 23,760 fire zones with 99,000 detection addresses, and over 100,000 digital I/O points. System Overview The MX Net communications network comprises a collection of network interface modules and peripheral equipment that together form a fault resistant, and flexible peer-to-peer network for the MX Digital addressable fire systems controllers. With the MZX Technology Network, each MZX Fire Controller on the network permits an operator to interrogate and control any other MZX Fire Controller on the network for extended interrogation and control, the MZX Technology Network allows for up to a maximum of five nodes on the network to be configured either as Master operating stations or TXG graphical user interfaces (refer to datasheet PSF206). Cable Parameters Maximum wire to wire capacitance Resistance Baud rate Capacitance Maximum resistance = 40 Ohm for EN54-13 38400 0.3 uF compliant installation. 19200 0.6 uF Maximum resistance = 65 9600 1.2 uF Ohm for proper function without compliance.(all 2400 1.2 uF baud rates) 1200 1.2 uF Chapter 4 Page 4 Master operating stations use the standard MZX Fire Controller hardware. In this application, the controller changes its personality; and enables additional information from each controller on the network to be displayed. Mode of Operation The MZX Technology Network employs a token passing communications protocol that treats each node on the network equally. Loss of one or more nodes does not affect the operation of the remainder of the network. Data is regenerated at each node in the network enabling maximum distance between nodes. In the event of a short/ open circuit on the network between any two nodes, isolation will automatically occur and the network will re-configure communications and continue to allow communication between all nodes physically connected. The MZX Technology Network offers a high level of system integrity, allowing safety critical actions to be passed across the network from one MZX Fire Controller to another. This very high level of system integrity enables the MZX Technology Network to meet the requirements of EN54-13 and EN54-2. In the event of loss of communication with the host controller, the TLI800EN will use its secondary processor to monitor the controllers fire outputs and if necessary can activate the controllers emergency fire input. In addition it can support a LED annunicator for network panel fire indication, this is wired to a MPM800 via the TLI800ENs integral RBus RS485 port. Fibre Optics Fibre optics can also be supported on the MZX Technology Network system by fitting one or two FOM800 modules to the TLI800EN network card, this uses either type 62.5/125 or 50/125 multi-mode fibres between nodes on the network. Use of fibre permits a maximum distance between nodes of up to 5000 metres in either bus or ring topology.

Product Codes
557.202.080 557.202.081 557.200.039 TLI800EN Network Card and cable FOM800 Fibre Optic Module TLI800EN Network Interface in Housing c/w PSU 02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics


Technical Specification
TLI800EN Network Card Mechanical Dimensions: Weight: Housing:

Technical Specification
FOM800 Fibre Optic Network Interface Mechanical Dimension: Weight: Housing: Electrical Supply Voltage: Network Connections: Cable Type:

116 x 90 x 20 mm 0.10 Kg The TLI800 Network P .C.B. is mounted directly onto the MZX CPU800 within the panel enclosure 74mA @ 24VDC & 20mA @ 5VDC 2 x RS 485 9 x on board LEDs / RS232 port for system analysis and fault finding 2 Core MICC, Shielded or Twisted pair Screw terminals, will accept 2.5 mm2 cable

50 x 58 x12 mm 0.015 Kg The FOM800 is mounted directly onto the TLI800EN Network card Powered from TLI800EN 2 x ST Fibre optic connections 62.5/125 or 50/125 multi-mode fibre optic cables

Electrical Power Consumption: Network Connections: Network diagnostic:

Cable Type: Network Connections:

Environmental Operating Temp: Storage Temp: Relative Humidity:

-10C to + 55C -10C to + 70C 95% (100% intermittent)

Technical Specification
TLI800EN-G Housed Network Card with PSU Mechanical Dimension: Weight:

Network Parameters: Number of nodes: 99 (max) Distance between nodes: 1000 to 5000 metres (dependent upon cable type) Communications type: RS485 Baud Rates: 9.6K to 115.2K Transport Type: Token passing, non-collision protocol Environmental Operating Temp: -10C to + 55C -10C to + 70C Storage Temp: Relative Humidity: 95% (100% intermittent)

300 x 200 x 85 mm 3.85 Kg

Environmental Operating Temperature: 0C to +55C 95% max Relative Humidity: Electrical Supply Voltage: Power consumption:

220 to 250 VAC 160mA

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 4 Page 5

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics


TLD-530 ThornNet/MXNet direct line driver PCB The Telephone Line Driver Module (TLD-530) is used to interface two (2) dedicated telephone line circuits to the TLI-800 module. The TLD-530 line driver module converts the RS-485 signals received from the TLI-800 network interface module to signals capable of being transmitted over the telephone line circuits. One TLI-800 supports two channels so only one module is required per controller for both single path and redundant path star connections. The interface allows for field configured baud rates and supports distances of up 3,000 metres. Up to two units can be fitted into a TLO/TLD Housing. Technical Specification Dimensions 170H x 120W x 20D mm 140g Weight

Product Codes 557.180.699 TLD 530 ThornNet/MXNet direct line driver PCB 557.180.148.A TLO/TLD Housing - ADT branded

CCU3 The CCU3/C-MXMB provides a MODBUS interface to a number of MX panels on an MXNet. CCU/IO boards may also be connected to provide general I/O devices accessed through the MODBUS interface. The CCU3/C-MXMB connects to MX panels on the MXNet via a TLI-800 (TPI) interface card using RS232 (PL2 socket). It connects to MODBUS via either an RS232, RS485 (default) or RS422 connection. Another port allows up to 8 CCU/IO boards to be connected. Each CCU/IO has 8 relay outputs that can be used as inputs to the MX. These contacts are controlled via WRITE commands to the MODBUS map. Each CCU/IO also has 8 supervised inputs whose status can be read from the MODBUS map. Technical Specification Input Voltage 18-30Vdc Current 150mA at 24Vdc Dimensions 140 x 105 x 15mm Product Code 557.202.046 MX CCU3/C-MXMB MX to MOD Bus Interface

The CCU3/C-MX Bridge enables the direct connection of an MX Technology fire controller and Minerva 16E or 80 fire controllers via the H-Bus Communications Driver Module (CDM). No network cards are required in this configuration. The CDM attaches on to the Minerva H-Bus and provides a serial port for the CCU3/C-MX bridge.

Product Codes 557.202.123 MX Bridge CCU3/C-MX Bridge 557.180.025 Minerva Comms Driver Module

Chapter 4 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics


Features
Facilitates Integration of MX & Minerva Systems Easy Upgrade Path for MINERVA systems

MX Minerva - Bridge
The MX Minerva bridge enables a mix of Minerva and MX Panels anywhere on a shared network to operate as an integrated system. Housed in either a MXAPSU17 or MXAPSU38 housing, the MX-Minerva bridge is a translating host converting packets between the Minerva format and the MX format in both directions. Flexibility is provided for packet conversion in the bridge configuration programme. The bridge comprises of 2 network cards and a translating host (CCU). The MX Minerva bridge can be added to one mixed network using both Minerva and MX Nodes or it can be connected to span between two physically separated network rings, one with Minerva nodes and one with MX nodes.

Technical Specification
Size: Input voltage: Operating Temp: EMC/RFI: 320x440x120mm (17A/H) 320x440x215mm (38A/H) 120-250VAC - 50/60Hz 8 to +55C EN50130-4

Product Codes
557.202.120 557.202.121 MX-Minerva Bridge Kit (17AH) MX Minerva Bridge Kit (38AH)

0509

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 4 Page 7

Chapter 4 - Networks and Graphics

This page left intentionally blank

Chapter 4 Page 8

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment Essential Test Equipment


Testifire is a 3 in 1 tool which represents the next generation of detector testing enabling smoke, heat and CO testing from one device. Latest technology stimuli production and delivery renders the product suitable for testing complex multi sensors to basic single sensor detectors. Its advanced design allows for single, sequential or simultaneous stimuli generation. This ensures each type of detector can be functionally tested in an efficient manner. Testifire eliminates the need for pressurised canisters by using replaceable capsules. It addresses global warming concerns associated with aerosols reducing waste and transport bulk.

Smoke, Heat & CO Detector Test Kit


Product Code 517.001.236 Includes: 1 x Testifire Smoke, Heat & CO Detector Tester 1 x Testifire Smoke Capsule 1 x Testifire CO Capsule 2 x Solo Battery Batons 1 x Solo Battery Charger

Smoke Capsules
Product Code 517.001.237 6 x Replacement smoke capsules for use with Testifire

CO Capsules
Product Code 517.001.238 6 x Replacement CO capsules for use with Testifire

Detector Removal Tool


Product Code 517.001.240

800RT Detector Removal Tool


Product Code 516.800.917

Universal Solo design suits wide range


of detectors

Compatible with 800 and 600 series


detectors

Suitable for use at / from angles

Enables detector dust covers to be


removed

Telescopic Access Pole


Product Code 517.001.230 Solo Telescopic Pole extends from 1.26 to 4.5 metres

Extension Pole
Product Code 517.001.226 A 1.13 metre Solo Extension Pole which can be used on its own or fitted to the Solo Telescopic Access Pole

Optimum strength to weight ratio Certified non-conductivity Simple looking mechanism and easy to
use

Storage Bag
Product Code 517.001.264 A protective carry and storage bag for the Solo or Testifire product ranges

03/11

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 5 Page 1

Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment


Adaptor Tube B
Product Code 517.001.224 Adaptor for Solo Access Poles of: 800RT Detector Removal Tool T110 Flame Detector Tester T210+ Flame Detector Tester M900 Address Key Extractor Tool

M900 Address Key Extractor Tool


Product Code 517.001.235 The address key extractor tool can be used to remove the address key from either a 4 or 5 detector base from ground level

to allow fitting 516.800.917 592.001.012 592.001.016 517.001.235

Additional and Alternative Products & Accessories


Smoke & Heat Detector Test Kit
Product Code 517.001.267 Includes: 1 x Testifire Smoke & Heat Detector Tester 1 x Testifire Smoke Capsule 2 x Solo Battery Batons 1 x Solo Battery Charger

Dispenser for Solo Smoke and CO Canister


Product Code 517.001.255

Lightweight and simple to use Universal design suits wide range of detectors Spring loaded solution for suspended ceilings Transparent cup for clear view of detector LED Designed for use at height, angles or low level For use with Solo Smoke and CO Canisters

Solo Smoke Detector Tester


Product Code 517.001.256

Solo CO Detector Tester


Product Code 517.001.262

Designed for use with Solo Dispenser Non flammable Fast activation Fast clearing

Designed for use with Solo Dispenser Genuine, non-flammable CO stimulus Controlled delivery

Cordless Heat Detector Test Kit


Product Code 517.001.254

Battery powered No cables, trailing leads or hanging wires Suits fixed temperature, rate of rise and combination detectors upto 194oF / 90 oC Lightweight and simple to use Universal design suits wide range of detectors Transparent cup for clear view of detector LED Designed for use at height, angles or low level 1 x Solo Heat Detector Tester 1 x Solo Battery Charger 2 x Solo Battery Batons

Includes:

Battery Baton
Product Code 517.001.239

Battery Charger
Product Code 517.001.243 Fast Charger for use with Solo Battery Batons

NiMH Battery Baton for use with Testifire and Solo Cordless Heat Detector Tester

Chapter 5 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

03/11

Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment Product Selector


Smoke Capsule 517.001.237 Smoke Capsule 517.001.237 Solo Smoke Detector Tester 517.001.256 Solo CO Detector Tester 517.001.262

CO Capsule 517.001.238

Testifire Smoke, Heat & Co Detector Tester 517.001.236

Testifire Smoke & Heat Detector Tester 517.001.267

Solo Smoke & CO Aerosol Dispenser 517.001.255

Solo Heat Detector Tester 517.001.254

Solo Universal Removal Tool 517.001.240

Flame Detector Testers 592.001.012 592.001.016

Detector Removal Tool 516.800.917

Address Key Extractor Tool 517.001.235

Solo Battery Baton 517.001.239 For use with Smoke,Heat & CO DetectorTest Kit 517.001.236 Smoke & Heat DetectorTest Kit 517.001.267 Cordless Heat Detector Test Kit 517.001.254 9m/30ft

Adapter Tube B 517.001.224

Solo Ext Pole 517.001.226 8m

Solo Ext Pole 517.001.226 7m

Solo Poles Access Height


Part Numbers Access Height (approx max.)

517.001.230 Solo Ext Pole 517.001.226 6m/20ft 517.001.230+ 517.001.226 (x2) 517.001.230+ 517.001.226 (x3) 5m 517.001.230+ 517.001.226 (x1)

6m / 20ft 7m / 23ft 8m / 26.25ft 9m / 30ft

4m

3m

Solo Telescopic Access Pole 517.001.230

2m

1m Solo Battery Baton Charger 517.001.243 Solo Carry Bag 517.001.264

03/11

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 5 Page 3

Chapter 5 - Detector Test Equipment


Features
Approved for use in zone 1 & 2 areas (GPIIC gases) Adaptor plate to ensure perfect alignment IECEX Approved

S200+ Series Test Equipment Technical Specification


Material: Weight: Supply Voltage: Operating Temp. Humidity: Enclosure: Classification: Glass filled polyester 0.8kg 9Vdc -10C to + 50C 95% (Non Condensing) IP54 Atex EExe ib IICT4. Suitable for use in zones 1 & 2 where group IIC gases or lesser hazards are sometimes present in explosive concentrations.

Product Codes
592.001.016 T210+ Test source for use with Solo 704 Adaptor Tube B (517.001.224) and Solo 100/101 Poles (517.001.230/226) T210+Adaptor required for the T210+ to be used with S200 and S200 Plus Flame Detectors T110 PP9 Battery and Charger Kit

592.001.014

592.001.010

Manual - Vol01B-01-G5 Detectors Fire Manual

S100 Series Test Equipment


Product Codes 592.001.012 T110 Test Source for use with Solo 704 adaptor tube B (517.001.224) and Solo 100/101 poles (517.001.230/226) 592.001.018 T110 Adaptor for series 600 and 800 flame detectors 592.001.010 T110 PP9 Battery and Charger Kit

Chapter 5 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

03/11

Chapter 6 - System Accessories Batteries, PSU and Chargers

Product Codes PS-1221 PS-1230 PS-1270 PS-1212 PS-12650 PS-12380 PS-6100 PS-12170 PS-12260 PS-1242 PS-12120

Voltage (V) 12 12 12 12 12 12 6 12 12 12 12

Ah at 20h rate 2.1 3.0 7.0 1.2 65.0 38.0 10.0 17.0 26.0 4.5 12.0

Length 178 134 151 97 348 197 151 181 166 90 151

Dimensions (mm) Width 35 67 65 42 167 165 51 76 176 70 98

Height 60 60 94 51 178 170 94 167 112 101 94

Height including Terminals 66 66 98 54 178 170 98 167 125 105 100

Product Codes
PS-1221 PS-1230 PS-1270 PS-1212 PS-12650 PS-12380 PS-6100 PS-12170 PS-12260 PS-1242 PS-12120 12 Volt 2.1 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 3.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 7.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 1.2 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 65.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 38.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 6 Volt 10.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 17.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 26.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 4.5 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery 12 Volt 12.0 Ampere hour rechargeable sealed lead acid battery

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 6 Page 1

Chapter 6 - System Accessories


Features
Robust metal housing Twin fused outputs Temperature compensated charging Deep discharge protection of batteries Fault relay output Size 383mm wide x 408mm high x 97mm deep Weight 4.3 Kg (excluding batteries) Operating temperature -5C to +40C Supply voltage 230VAC 50/60Hz Comprehensive LED status indication

Minerva MXP24/50 PSU


The MXP24/50 PSU is approved by IMQ to EN 54-4:1997 + A1:2002 and EN60950-1:2001. The steel housing contains a 5 amp switch mode power supply and monitoring board and has space to accommodate 2 x 12V 17Ah sealed lead acid batteries. The 10 front panel LED's comprehensively indicate the status of the unit.

Product Code
558.004.020 Minerva MXP24/50-U/TSP 5A Charger & Housing

Chapter 6 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 6 - System Accessories Door Release Equipment


Door Release Magnets
The door magnet range encompasses 2 metal and 2 ABS housed wall mounted and 1 floor mounted release magnet sets

Features
Integral release button Attractive design Slimline ABS housed units Robust floor mounted unit

Door release magnet set, Wall Mount, Metal Housing, 24VDC Door release magnet set, Wall Mount, Metal Housing, 230VAC

Product Code 3-59-0404-S001 Product Code 3-59-0404-S002

Door release magnet set, Wall Mount, ABS Housing, 24VDC Door release magnet set, Wall Mount, ABS Housing, 230VAC

Product Code 3-87-0351 Product Code 3-87-0352

Door release magnet set, floor mount, ABS housing 24VDC

Product Code 3-84-0301

Floor mounting bracket for adapting wall mounted door magnets to floor mount

Product Code 2-34-035G-S001

Technical Specifications 3-59-0404-S001 - 89 x 89 x 70mm, 0.5Kg, 180N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 24VDC 3-59-0404-S002 - 89 x 89 x 70mm, 0.5Kg, 180N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 230VAC 3-87-0351 - 95 x 87 x 46mm, 0.36Kg, 200N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 24VDC 3-87-0352 - 95 x 87 x 46mm, 0.36Kg, 200N Holding Force, 1.15W Coil @ 230VAC 3-84-0301 - 110 x 96 x 96mm, 0.7Kg, 200N Holding Force, 45mA Coil @ 24VDC

Door Release Power Supply


The Transformer Rectifier is a dual purpose, smoothed power supply providing either an energised or de-energised output upon activation. The output may be activated by utilising a set of volt free contacts from a fire or security panel, or by providing a 12/24Vdc trigger voltage from other apparatus. The transformer rectifier units are normally used to control the operation of other 24Vdc equipment such as magnetic door retainers. The units are ideal for applications where the supply is to be energised from a remote source. Technical Specification Input Voltage: 230VAC 50Hz 22 - 30Vdc Output Voltage: Output Current: 4 Amps Continuous Temperature: -10C to + 40C Relative Humidity: 95% RH IP Rating: IP41 (excluding rear face) Material: 1.2mm white powder coated steel Dimensions: 230mm (W) x 200mm (H) x 80mm (D) Product Code 558.004.010 ELM 24V 4A Door Holder PSU

Door Release Button


Door Release Button supplied with surface mount backbox for manual release of door magnets or door release units. Product Code 519.001.008 Door Release Button

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 6 Page 3

Chapter 6 - System Accessories Auxiliary Interface Relays


Boxed Relays
Product Codes 567.005.004 Relay 5010. Supplied with 1 PCB but can fit a maximum of 2 PCBs each containing up to 5 plug in relays. Order relay (569.001.007) separately. Metal boxed heavy duty alarm relay with 25A mains rated DPCO contacts. Available with either a 240VAC 12mA or 24VDC 50mA rated coil. Suitable for heavy duty switching applications. RU1-24, this is a metal boxed auxiliary relay with 5 A Mains rated double pole contacts with a 24 VDC 25mA coil. This compact relay is suitable for interfacing a fire alarm controller to low current mains powered devices or contactors 568.001.002 Relay 5010 PCB (5 Relay)

Product Codes 567.007.008 Alarm Relay 240Vac MK4 567.007.009 Alarm Relay 24Vdc MK4

Product Code RU1-24 Relay Boxed 24Vdc Coil 5A contacts

Relays
Product Code 569.001.007 Cradle relay and retaining clip 2 C/O 26V nominal 700 ohm coil 5 amp (used with Relay 5000 and 5010). Product Code 609.001.015 Polarised & suppressed 24VDC double pole C/O relay with gold clad contacts, 2K ohm coil, 2 Amps @ 30VDC (PCB Mounted)

Fire Notice Frames


These frames are used mainly for Fire Alarm Zone Charts and are available to fit A4 to A1 size drawings. These come supplied with fitting hooks. Product Codes 525.001.005 A4 Dimensions: 212mm x 297mm 525.001.006 A3 Dimensions: 280mm x 356mm 525.001.008 A2 Dimensions: 483mm x 367mm 525.001.007 A1 Dimensions: 483mm x 737mm

Chapter 6 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 6 - System Accessories Fire Resistant Cable


DTWYLER Lifeline cable is suitable for fire alarms and emergency lighting where BS6387 and BS7629 standards are acceptable and meets the installation and performance requirements of: BS5839 Pt.1 for use in fire alarms BS5266 for use with emergency lighting IEC331 fire resistance Lifeline is LPCB approved to BS6387 CAT CWZ and BASEC approved to BS7629. Lifeline is low smoke, zero halogen, has an integral aluminium backed mylar tape screen with tinned drain wire and requires no special terminations, tools or ferrules for installation. Full details of Lifeline cable can be found in the DTWYLER Lifeline datasheets on the Tyco Safety Products website (www.tycoemea.com). DTWYLER offer a wide range of cable and safety cabling systems including complete safety cable systems to DIN4102 part 12. The following DTWYLER Lifeline cables are held in stock at Tyco Safety Products Letchworth warehouse, together with suitable P clips and glands. Cables are priced per metre but must be ordered in units of 100 metre. P clips and glands are priced each but must be ordered in packs.

Technical Specification
Bare copper, solid or stranded to BS 6360 Insulation: Special double layer insulation according to BS 7655, E15 Inner Covering: High temperature resistant glass fibre tape Screening: Al-Laminated tape with tinned copper drain wire, solid to BS 6360 Outer Sheath: Flame retardant polyolefin compound according to BS 7655, LTS3 Technical Properties Rated Voltage: 300/500V 2000V, 50Hz core/core Test Voltage: 2000V, 50Hz core/screen Operating Temp: -15oC to +90oC Core Colours: 2 cores + earth: red, black 4 cores + earth: red,yellow,blue,black Sheath Colour: Red or white General Properties Zero Halogen, no corrosive gases IEC 60754-2, BS 6425 part 1 Reduced fire propagation - IEC 603323, BS 4066 part 3 Minimum smoke emission - IEC 61034, BS 7622 Insulation integrity - IEC 60331 (FE180), BS 6387 (cat. CWZ) Approvals BASEC Construction Conductor:

Product Codes
Product Codes 599.048.020 599.048.022 599.048.023 599.048.024 599.048.032 599.048.034 599.048.035 599.048.036 No. Cores 2 + earth 2 + earth 2 + earth 2 + earth 4 + earth 4 + earth 4 + earth 4 + earth DTWYLER Lifeline cable Core Size Colour 1 mm Red 1.5 mm Red 1.5 mm White 2.5 mm Red 1 mm Red 1.5 mm Red 1.5 mm White 2.5 mm Red Clips P34 R P34 R P34 W P37 R P37 R P40 R P40 W P43 R

Product Codes

599.048.001 599.048.002 599.048.003 599.048.005 599.048.009 599.048.010

DTWYLER Lifeline Fire Resistant P Clips & Glands Qty. per pack Reference Colour 50 P34 Red 50 P34 White 50 P37 Red 50 P40 Red 10 NG1 Red 10 NG1 White

No. of Cores x Cross Section (n x mm2) Copper Content (Kg/Km) 2 x 1.0 19 2 x 1.5 29 2 x 2.5 48 4 x 1.0 39 4 x 2.5 96

Total Weight (Kg/Km) Outer Diameter (approx. mm) Calorific Potential (KWh/m) 75 7.4 0.16 97 8.2 0.18 141 9.6 0.24 114 8.6 0.23 223 11.3 0.37

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 6 Page 5

Chapter 6 - System Accessories

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 6 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA Aspirating Smoke Detection


Vesda aspirating smoke detection provides a high sensitivity method for detection of fires at a very early stage - it is ideal for computer rooms and other high risk and high value areas. The range of products range from the Laserfocus for small risks up to the LaserPlus range of networkable 4 pipe panels.

Features
Laser Based Absolute Smoke Detection Very Early Warning of a Potential Fire Incident Wide Sensitivity Range (0.025%-20% obs/m) (0.008 - 6.4% obs/ft) Detection Capabilities for smaller critical areas up to 500m Dual Stage Dust Filtration Programmable Alarm Thresholds Reliable Air Flow Monitoring Easy User Interaction AutoLearn Smoke & Flow Pre-engineered Pipe Designs

LaserFOCUS Aspirating Smoke Detection


Incorporating detection methodology derived from its VESDA predecessors - the VESDA LaserFOCUS multiple point air sampling technology works by utilising a highly effective aspirator that continually draws air into its laser detection chamber via a pipe network. Accurate assessment of the air sample using calibrated detection and long detector life expectancy, are assured with a patented dual stage filtration process that both eliminates background noise and preserves the optical integrity of the laser technology with its clean air bleed. The result of which is an unchallenged detection process able to provide reliable and consistent very early warning smoke detection performance across a diverse range of applications.

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage: Current Consumption: Dimensions: Weight: IP Rating: Operating Temp: Sampled Air: Humidity: 18 to 30 Vdc 220mA quiescent 295 mA alarm 255H x 185W x 90Dmm 2 kg IP30 0C to + 40C 0C to + 40C 5% to 95% (non condensing)

Product Codes
516.018.020 516.018.022 516.018.023 VLF-250 Vesda Laserfocus (with English overlay) VIC-010 LaserFocus VesdaNetwork Card VLF-500 Vesda Laserfocus (with English overlay)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 1

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
Reduced size Absolute smoke detection Wide sensitivity range Single pipe inlet Simple display Referencing VESDAnet communication (VN) Dual stage dust filter Three alarm levels Configurable relays Air flow monitoring Optional remote display and relay capability Simple mounting design AutoLearnTM Marine Approved Version

LaserCOMPACTTM and MX LaserCOMPACTTM


The LaserCOMPACT and VLC800 MX Laser compact detector has been specifically designed to provide all the benefits of aspirating smoke detection, including very early warning, in single small areas and where space is a premium. This has been achieved through the combination of approved LaserPLUS detection technology, dual stage filtration technology and a modified aspirator design incorporated in a smaller enclosure with simplified display. The LaserCOMPACT is available in two versions, one that interfaces via relays only (RO) or across either the relays or VESDAnetTM (VN). The VLC 800MX Laser Compact is available with an in-built MX interface to enable it to communicate directly with the MX loop.

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage: Current Consumption: Dimensions: Weight: Operating Temp: Sampled Air: 18 to 30Vdc 225mA quiescent, 245mA in alarm 225H x 225W x 85Dmm 1.9Kg -10C to+ 39C -20C to +60C

Product Codes
516.018.011 516.018.010 516.018.012 VLC-505-VN VESDA net Version (VN) VLC-500-RO Relays Only Version (RO) VLC800 MX Addressable Vesda Laser compact (Compatible with MX Consys versions 2.1 and above) VLC-500-RO Relays Only Version (RO) Marine VLC-500-VN Vesdanet Version (VN) Marine VRT-J00 Remote Display c/w 7 relays Marine

516.018.030 516.018.031 516.018.032

Chapter 7 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
Wide sensitivity range Laser-based light source 4 Configurable alarm levels Purpose built Aspirator 4 In-line Inlet pipes Flow sensor for each inlet pipe Wide range DC power Low-cost maintenance Dual stage filter Easy access to filter cartridge 7 Software configurable relays Recessed mounting Multiple exhausts

LaserPLUS Standard Modular Range


The detector assembly contains the laser detection chamber, high efficiency aspirator, monitored filter cartridge, control electronics and relay interface. The detector assembly can be used as a distributed system, with the display, programmer and VESDAnet socket modules mounted in a remote location. Alternatively, the detector assembly can be configured as a self-contained system by replacing the detectors blank panels with the display and/or programming modules.

516.018.001 VLP-012 LaserPLUS Detector, programmer and display

516.018.002 VLP-002 LaserPLUS Detector and display

516.018.013 VLP-400 LaserPLUS Detector with fire OK LED

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage: Current Consumption: 18 to 30Vdc (No display or programmer) 240mA quiescent plus 50mA alarm (24Vdc at 3000 rpm) 225H x 350W x 125D mm 4.0Kg (including display and programmer modules) 0C to + 39C 0-95% RH, non condensing

Product Codes
516.018.001 516.018.002 516.018.013 VLP-012 LaserPLUS Detector, programmer and display VLP-002 LaserPLUS Detector and display VLP-400 LaserPLUS Detector with fire OK LED

Dimensions: Weight: Operating Temp: Humidity:

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 3

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
Individual pipe annunciation Adaptive scan threshold Wide sensitivity range (0.005 to 20% obs/m) Laser based light source Configurable alarm levels Purpose built Aspirator 4 In-Line inlet pipes Flow sensor for each pipe inlet Low-cost maintenance Dual stage filter Easy access to filter cartridge Recessed mounting

LaserPLUS Scanners
VESDA LaserPLUS is also available in a Scanner configuration, which allows the system to distinguish and identify the pipe carrying smoke, while sampling multiple sectors. VLS-214/314 FD7/FD12 Scanner
Product Codes 516.018.004 VLS-214 FD7 Scanner, programmer and display with 7 relays. 516.018.007 VLS-314 FD12 Scanner, programmer and display with 12 relays

The VESDA LaserPLUS will continue to sample from all sectors to monitor the fire growth and maintain full protection.

VLS-600/700 FD7/FD12 Scanner


Product Codes 516.018.016 VLS-600 FD7 Scanner with Fire OK LED 516.018.019 VLS-700 FD12 Scanner with Fire OK LED

VLS-204/304 FD7/FD12 Scanner


Product Codes 516.018.005 VLS-204 FD7 Scanner and display with 7 relays. 516.018.008 VLS-304 FD12 Scanner and display with 12 relays

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage: Current consumption: Dimensions: Weight: Operating Temp: Humidity: Relay Outputs: 18 to 30Vdc (No display or programmer) 240mA quiescent plus 70mA alarm (24Vdc at 3000 rpm) 225H x 350W x 125D mm 4.0Kg including display and programmer modules 0C to + 39C 10-95% RH, non condensing 7 or 12

Product Codes
516.018.004 516.018.007 516.018.005 516.018.008 516.018.016 516.018.019 VLS-214 FD7 Scanner, programmer and display with 7 relays. VLS-314 FD12 Scanner, programmer and display with 12 relays VLS-204 FD7 Scanner and display with 7 relays. VLS-304 FD12 Scanner and display with 12 relays VLS-600 FD7 Scanner with Fire OK LED VLS-700 FD12 Scanner with Fire OK LED

Datasheet - Product Code PSF105U VESDA LaserPLUS

Chapter 7 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
Four alarm levels (Alert/Action, Fire 1 & Fire 2) 20 segment vertical bar graph Alarm threshold indicators (Alert, Action & Fire 1) Audio and visual indication Alarm indicators Informative fault indicators Multi-mode numeric display(defaults to smoke obscuration) Acknowledged push-button presses Multiple language supported Addressable to any detector

Remote Displays and Modules


A display module monitors the VESDA LaserPLUS detector. It reports a visual representation of smoke levels, and all alarm and fault conditions. The internal sounder warns personnel in the local area that an alarm threshold has been reached, or a fault has occurred. It has a 20 segment vertical bar graph, a 2-digit numerical display, an audible sounder and clear alarm and fault indicators. It also has 4 push buttons to control the detector and the mode of the display. Displays can be located at a convenient location - either within the detector module, or remotely on the VESDAnet. For monitoring convenience, multiple displays can be associated with a single detector. VRT-400,700 & 800
Product Codes 516.018.104 VRT-400 Remote scanner display including 7 relays 516.018.107 VRT-700 Remote scanner display no relays 516.018.108 VRT-800 Remote scanner display with 12 relays

VRT-200,600,J00 and K00 displays


Product Codes 516.018.102 VRT-200 Remote display including 7 relays 516.018.106 VRT-600 Remote detector displayno relays 516.018.119 VRT-J00 Compact Display c/w 7 relays 516.018.120 VRT-K00 Compact Display no relays

VRT-300 Remote VESDAnet socket


Product Code 516.018.103 VRT-300 Remote VESDAnet socket

VRT-100 Remote programmer


Product Code 516.018.101 VRT-100 Remote programmer

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage: Current Consumption: 18-30Vdc (when used in detector unit, Remote unit or 19 rack) 60mA quiescent plus 20mA alarm @24Vdc - (module only)/90mA quiescent plus 20mA alarm @24Vdc (in remote mounitng box) 150H x 140W x 90D mm 0C to +39C 10-95% RH, non condensing

Dimensions: Operating Temp: Humidity:

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 5

Chapter 7 - VESDA
LaserPLUS Standard 19 Inch Sub-Rack Remote Display Assemblies
The 19 sub-rack is available as a mounting option, with 4 mounting slots for display or programming modules. Technical Specification Dimensions: 128H x 482W x 120D mm Product Codes 516.018.201 VSR-2000 19 Sub-rack with 1 detector display and 3 blanks 516.018.203 VSR-2210 19 Sub-rack, 2 detector displays, programmer and 1 blank 516.018.204 VSR-2221 19 Sub-rack with 3 detector displays and programmer 516.018.206 VSR-2222 19 Sub-rack with 4 detector displays

LaserPLUS Components for Ordering Custom Built Remote Display Sub-racks


Sub-rack configurations other than those available as standard can be supplied as custom built units. The sub-rack and cost of assembly are included in the VSR-CUSTOM. The configuration of the custom built unit must be specified at time of ordering (e.g. 2 x VSU-0 and 2 x VSU-2 configured as VSR-0022) Note: The order of the numbers (e.g. 0022) indicates the order in which the sub-units will be mounted in the sub-rack housing when looking from the front of the unit - from left to right. Product Codes 516.018.260 VSU-0 Blank Sub-unit 516.018.261 VSU-1 Programmer sub-unit 516.018.262 VSU-2 Detector display sub-unit plus 7 relays 516.018.264 VSU-4 Scanner display sub-unit plus 7 relays 516.018.265 VSU-5 Blank sub-unit with 7 relays 516.018.214 VSU-E Blank scanner sub-unit with 7 relays 516.018.268 VSU-8 Scanner display sub-unit with 12 relays 516.018.269 VSU-9 Blank display sub-unit with 12 relays 516.018.219 VSU-J Compact display sub-unit plus 7 relays 516.018.210 VSR-CUSTOM Custom sub-rack housing includes cost of custom building 4 VSU sub-rack units.

LaserPLUS Standard 19 Inch Rack Remote Display Assemblies


Standard rack enclosures are available to fit 2 (see picture) or 5 sub-rack assemblies. Technical Specification Dimensions: 020-050 300H x 400W x 140D mm Product Code 516.018.303 020-050 IP65 Enclosure

LaserPLUS Ancillaries & Power Supply Unit


A variety of other ancillaries are available. Configuration software is available from the Xtralis website www.vision-fs.com. Product Codes 516.018.402 VHX-0200 PC link HLI plus leads (MK2) 516.018.407 VESDA VPS-220 2A 24VDC PSU 516.018.410 VESDA VPS-250-E 5A 24VDC PSU 516.018.401 VHH-100 Hand held programmer plus leads

LaserPLUS Spares
The following common VESDA LaserPLUS spares are kept in stock by Tyco Safety Products. Other spares can be supplied if required. Product Codes 516.018.502 VSP-004 Scanner display (spare) 516.018.505 VSP-019 Filter cover door (spare) 516.018.506 VSP-006 Spare detector chassis and manifold 516.018.508 VSP-008 Spare remote termination card 7 relays 516.018.509 VSP-009 Spare scanner chassis and manifold 516.018.514 VSP-014 Spare header termination card 7 relays 516.018.515 VSP-015 Spare aspirator fan 516.018.504 VSP-005 Filter cartridge (spare)

Chapter 7 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
Powerful fan Upto two x 100m pipe runs Pipes can be individually monitored for air flow with LED bar graph MX Loop and 24 VDC connections Fault monitored via the MX Loop IP65 enclosure Field serviceable air filters Uses standard 25mm Vesda pipe & fittings

ICAM IAS800 Air Sampling Smoke Detection Systems


The ICAM IAS800 Air Sampling Smoke Detection System provides a flexible solution to meet the unique needs of numerous applications including industrial spaces such as cable tunnels, tamper proof and unobtrusive requirements for special accommodation, or can simply be used to replace spot (point) detectors in office environments. The IAS800 system actively draws air from the protected area through sampling holes in a pipe network. Sampled air is then filtered before being analyzed by upto two MX Technology detectors. The IAS800 system is available in three configurations:IAS800 twin inlet pipe configuration which can be fitted with two detectors for monitoring one or two pipe runs. IAS801 single inlet pipe configuration which can be fitted with one detector. IAS802 twin inlet pipe configuration which can be fitted with two detectors for monitoring one or two separate pipe runs with independant fault outputs. The system utilises a high performance aspirator and software configurable flow monitoring circuitry. The air flow level is displayed on a ten element bar graph that can be adjusted for high and low flow thresholds, and flow failure is reported as a device fault via upto two MX Technology MIM800 addressable modules. Applications: Ideal for areas where access is restricted, harsh environments and areas where a point detector would be damaged. Such as:Lift Shafts Floor / Ceiling Voids Cabinet Protection Conveyor Tunnels Hose Down Areas Stables Prison Cells Areas with Low Ceilings

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage Current Consumption Dimensions Weight Operating Temp Humidity Sampling Pipes 18 to 30Vdc 300mA 259w x 184h x 166d mm 2.77 Kg -10 to +55C (with detectors) 10 to 90% RH NonCondensing 25 mm dia, 100m per inlet

Product Codes
516.016.301 516.016.304 516.016.305 516.016.303 ICAM IAS800 Aspirated Smoke Dual Detector common fault monitor ICAM IAS801 Aspirated Smoke Single Detector common fault monitor ICAM IAS802 Aspirated Smoke Dual Detector dual fault monitor ICAM Course Filter (PK10)

Note: Detectors to be ordered separately.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 7

Chapter 7 - VESDA Vesda Pipe, Fittings and Test Equipment


VESDA Aspirating Pipe & Fittings are a metric standard of 25mm external diameter with suitable adaptors available for imperial to metric conversions. (British Standard approved pipes BS5391 Part 1 1976 and BS5391 Part 1 1976 for fittings). The British manufactured pipe is produced in red ABS under stringent quality control approved to BS EN ISO9001, which covers all aspects of product design, manufacture and inspection.

Features
Toughness and durability Chemical resistance Easy to joint Low Friction Wide temperature range Lightweight Red colour for easy identification

Aspirating Pipe & Fittings


Pipe 25mm diameter
VESDA aspirating pipe, printed along its length on opposite side at 450mm intervals. 3 m length pipe Order in multiples of 10. Product Code 516.018.901 Pipe 25mm diameter

Socket 25mm
Straight socket for 25mm pipe. Order in multiples of 10. Product Code 516.018.902 Socket 25mm

Socket union 25mm


Socket union to facilitate servicing of pipework. Order in multiples of 1. Product Code 516.018.903 Socket union 25mm

Socket Adaptor 25mm to 3/4


Socket adaptor, imperial to metric, to extend existing systems. Order in multiples of 5 Product Code 516.018.909 Socket Adaptor 25mm to 3/4

Bend 25mm
90 degree Long Radius bend Order in multiples of 5 Product Code 516.018.904 Long Radius bend 90

Chapter 7 Page 8

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Elbow 25mm
45 deg elbow Order in multiples of 5 Product Code 516.018.905 Elbow 25mm

End Cap 25mm


End cap 25mm Order in multiples of 5 Product Code 516.018.906 End cap 25mm

Equal Tee 25mm


Equal Tee 25mm Order in multiples of 5 Product Code 516.018.907 Equal Tee 25mm

In-Line Filter
In-Line Filter, suitable for all Vesda Aspirating Smoke Detectors Product Code 516.018.925 In-Line Filter (red) for use with Vesda ASD systems

Filter Elements
Dual density replaceable filter elements for use with In-Line Filter Product Code 516.018.926 Replacement Filter Elements (pack of 4)

Pipe Clip 25mm


Pipe Clip 25mm Order in multiples of 10 Product Code 516.018.908 Pipe Clip 25mm

Solvent Cement (0.25 Litre Tin)


Solvent cement Product Code 516.018.910 Solvent cement

Capillary Tube Conical Sample Point Assembly


Capillary Tube Conical Sample Point Assembly. 25mm socket adaptor + 2m capillary tube (tube colour - red) Product Code 516.018.911 Capillary Tube Conical Sample Point Assembly

Capillary Tube Flush Sample Point Assembly


Capillary Tube Flush Sample Point Assembly. 25mm socket adaptor + 2m capillary tube (tube colour - red) Product Code 516.018.912 Capillary Tube Flush Sample Point Assembly

Capillary Tube 10 mm
Capillary Tube 10 mm 10mm o/d x 30m length (tube colour - red) Product Code 516.018.915 Capillary Tube 10 mm

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 9

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Pipe Cutters
Pipe Cutter Product Code 516.018.918 Pipe Cutter

Pipe Ties
Pipe Ties (Red) Order in multiples of 100. Product Code 516.018.920 Pipe Ties (Red)

Sampling Point Label (1 reel)


Sampling point label. Order in multiples of 100. Product Code 517.017.005 Sampling point label.

Pipe Label (1reel)


Pipe Label. Order in multiples of 100. Product Code 517.017.006 Pipe Label

Pipework designs for Vesda Systems must be verified by the use of the Aspire pipework Design Software Tool. Available for download from the Xtralis Website at www.vision-fs.com.

Test Equipment
Wire Burn Test Box
Wire burn test box designed to heat up a measured length of special wire to produce smoke, used to test the transport time and performance of Vesda aspirating smoke detectors. Built in timer Insulated terminals Selectable input voltage Illuminated power on indicator Robust enclosure Supplied with UK power lead Technical Specification Input Voltage 110-120 or 220240VAC Output Voltage 6.3VAC @ 20A IP rating IP30 Timer 1 to 3 mins Dimensions 170w x 120d x 135h (mm) Weight 2.75Kg Product Code 516.018.921 Wire Burn Test Box

Smoke Test Wire


Smoke test wire for use with the wire burn test box. Technical Specification Size - 10/0.1mm, 0.078 mm2 CSA Length 100m Weight 0.25Kg Product Code 516.018.923 Smoke Test Wire-Vesda 251-001

Chapter 7 Page 10

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA
A VESDA Aspirating Smoke Detector B Detection pipe work C VESDA ECO Gas Detector

Features
Single gas or dual gas versions available Greater coverage than point gas detection Highly cost effective solution Can use the same pipe work to detect smoke and gas hazards Easily retrofitted to existing VESDA ASD installations Relay, 4-20mA and RS485 Modbus interfaces provided as standard High level interface to MZX via the DDM800 module On-board data logging

VESDA ECO Gas Detection


Gas Detection and Aspirating Smoke Detection Plus Environmental Monitoring The VESDA ECO is a gas detector module that is inserted into the pipework of a VESDA aspirating smoke detector. Different VESDA ECO models detect different gasses. Applications VESDA ECO by Xtralis provides protection from both fire and gas threats in powerful yet cost effective configurations to provide point, zone or total area coverage in a variety of applications including: Battery charging rooms Underground utility tunnels Boiler rooms Warehouses Manufacturing facilities Parking garages Transportation centres Areas requiring gas detection often also require a fire / smoke detection system. Xtralis VESDA ECO combines gas detection capability with VESDA aspirating smoke detection (ASD) at minimal additional cost. This combined solution can be significantly less expensive than a number of conventional standalone fixed point gas detectors and a separate fire detection system. Routine maintenance costs are also reduced as a single service contract can cover both systems. It is common practice to provide constant ventilation of plant and process areas to reduce the risk of a gas hazard. The energy costs associated with this solution can be considerable. As an alternative, gas detection can be used to activate or boost ventilation only when required and consequently reduce HVAC operating costs. VESDA ECO provides an economical method of providing gas detection over a wide area for this application.

34 mm

110 mm

125 mm

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 11

Chapter 7 - VESDA
VESDA ECO Gas Detection Product Codes
VESDA ECO Detectors ECO-D-B-11 ECO Hydrogen H2 Gas Detector H2 0-100% LEL ECO-D-B-12 ECO Methane CH4 Gas Detector 0-100% LEL ECO-D-B-13 ECO Propane C3H8 Gas Detector 0-100% LEL ECO-D-B-31 ECO Oxygen O2 Gas Detector 0-25% Vol ECO-D-B-41 ECO Carbon Monoxide CO Gas Detector 0-500 PPM ECO-D-B-42 ECO Amonia NH3 Gas Detecor 0-100 PPM ECO-D-B-43 ECO Hydrogen Sulphide H2S Gas Detector 0-100 PPM ECO-D-B-44 ECO Sulphur Dioxide SO2 Gas Detector 0-10 PPM ECO-D-B-45 ECO Nitrogen Dioxide NO2 Gas Detector 0-10 PPM ECO-D-B-41-45 ECO Dual Gas Detector Carbon Monoxide CO 0-500 PPM + Nitrogen Dioxide NO2 0-10 PPM VESDA ECO Replacement Sensor Cartridges ECO Spare Cartridge Hydrogen H2 0-100% LEL ECO-SC-11 ECO-SC-12 ECO Spare Cartridge Methane CH4 0-100% LEL ECO-SC-13 ECO Spare Cartridge Propane CH8 0-100% LEL ECO-SC-31 ECO Spare Cartridge Oxygen O2 0-25% Vol ECO-SC-41 ECO Spare Cartridge Carbon Monoxide CO 0-500 PPM ECO-SC-42 ECO Spare Cartridge Ammonia NH3 0-100 PPM ECO-SC-43 ECO Spare Cartridge Hydrogen Sulphide H2S 0-100 PPM ECO-SC-44 ECO Spare Cartridge Sulphur Dioxide SO2 0-10 PPM ECO-SC-45 ECO Spare Cartridge Nitrogen Dioxide NO2 0-10 PPM ECO-SC-41-45 ECO Spare Cartridge Dual Carbon Monoxide CO 0-500 PPM + Nitrogen Dioxide NO2 0-10 PPM

Technical Specification
Mechanical Weight: Dimensions: Pipe external diameter: Terminal size: Cable Access: Environmental Ingress protection: Operating temp: Sampled air temp: Humidity: Electrical Voltage: Current quiescent: Current alarm: Power consumption: Outputs: 250 g 110x125x34mm 25 mm 1.5mm2 2xM16 bulkhead grommets IP65 and NEMA 4 -20 to 55oC -20 to 55oC 10-95% RH, non-condensing 18-30 VDC Typically 60 mA @ 24 V DC 85 mA 3.2 W RS 485 Modbus RTU Four programmable relays 30 VDC 1A 4-20 mA output Micro SD card 2 GB

Onboard Memory Card:

Chapter 7 Page 12

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 7 - VESDA
Features
Maximum detection range of 150 metres for the OSI-10 Status LEDs for Fire, Fault and Power High false alarm immunity Dust and intrusive solid object rejection Easy alignment with large adjustment and viewing angles No need for precise alignment Tolerant of alignment drift Automatic commisioning in under ten minutes Simple DIP switch configuration Dual wavelength LED-based smoke detection Simple and easy maintenance requirements Conventional alarm interface for straightforward fire system integration Three selectable alarm thresholds

OSID Smoke Detection


Open-area Smoke Imaging Detection (OSID) by Xtralis is a new innovation in projected beam smoke detection technology. By using advanced dual wavelength projected beams and optical imaging technology, OSID provides a low-cost, reliable and easy to install solution that overcomes typical beam detection issues such as false alarm incidents and alignment difficulties. Unique Detection Technology The OSID system measures the level of smoke entering beams of light projected over an area of protection. A single OSID Imager can detect up to seven Emitters to provide a wide coverage area. Simple Installation and Maintenance The OSID system consists of up to seven Emitters, for the 45 and 90 Imager units, located along the perimeter of the protected area, and an Imager mounted opposite. Each component can be mounted directly to the surface or can be secured with the supplied mounting brackets. Battery powered Emitters with up to five years battery life are also available to reduce installation time and cost.

Technical Specification
Supply Voltage 20 to 30 VDC (24 VDC nominal) Imager Current Consumption Nominal (at 24 VDC): 4 mA (1 Emitter) 7 mA (7 Emitters) Peak (at 24 VDC) during training mode: 27 mA Emitter Current Consumption Wired Version (at 24 VDC): 350 A Battery Version Built-in 5 Year Battery Adjustment Angle 60 (horizontal) 15 (vertical) Maximum Misalignment Angle 2 Dimensions (WHD) Emitter / Imager 198 mm x 130 mm x 96 mm Operating Conditions* Temperature -10 C to 55 C * Humidity 10 to 95% RH (non-condensing) IP Rating IP 44 for Electronics IP 66 for Optics Enclosure Status LEDs Fire Alarm (Red) Trouble / Power (Bi-color Yellow / Green)

Product Codes
OSI-10 OSI-45 OSI-90 OSE-SP OSE-SPW OSE-HPW OSID-INST VKT-301 Imager 7o coverage Imager 38o coverage Imager 80o coverage Emitter Standard Power Emitter Standard Power, Wired Emitter High Power, Wired OSID Installation Kit OSID Demo Kit (2 x OSE-SPW + 1 x OSI-90 + 1 x OSID-INST + Stand and Carry Case)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 7 Page 13

Chapter 7 - VESDA

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 7 Page 14

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 8 - Fire Phones and Disable Refuge Fire Phones and Disable Refuge
Features
Meets the requirements of BS5839 Part 9. Ideal for all disabled refuge and fire telephone applications. Compact 4 or 8 line (expandable to 12 or 16) wall mounted central control unit which saves space in crowded control rooms. Type B disabled refuge outstations offer true duplex handsfree speech. Available in stainless steel or green steel flush, surface and weatherproof versions. Type A fire telephone outstations come in locking or non locking red steel cabinets and offer true duplex speech. Flush and surface versions are available. Unique auto learn facility allows fast network set up. All extensions can be named with user defined text of up to 15 characters. Fully monitored hardware and software. System operates at 24Vdc. In the event of mains failure, operation can be maintained for 24 hours (standby) and 3 hours (in use) using 2 x 12v 7Ah SLA batteries.

Cel TEL Disabled Refuge and Fire Telephone System


CelTEL comprises of a low cost, all-in-one, wall mounting controller which can handle 4 or 8 lines (expandable to 12 or 16 lines via an 8 line slave unit). Typically it would be located in a buildings control room (or in smaller applications at a fire services access point). It allows the management and/or the emergency services to communicate via a telephone style handset with the systems outstations. For larger systems up to 4 controllers can be interlinked using a network communication card allowing systems of up to 64 lines to be easily implemented.

Cel TEL 1-64 Line Controllers


CelTEL 4 Way Master EVC Panel with Handset and Display Allows operators to communicate with up to 4 x Type A or B outstations. Supplied with a backlit LCD and handset. Requires 2 x 12v 7Ah SLA batteries. Can be semi flush mounted using the bezel. Optional tamper resistant cabinet. CelTEL 8 Way Master EVC Panel with Handset and Display Allows operators to communicate with up to 8 x Type A or B outstations. Same features as 4 Way Master EVC Panel. CelTEL Slave EVC Panel with 8 Additional Lines Can be connected to a Master EVC Panel to increase its line capacity upto 16. Does not require a separate mains supply or batteries since it takes power from the Master EVC Panel. Can be semi flush mounted using the bezel. CelTEL EVC Network Communication Card Allows the interconnection of up to 4 x Master Controllers over a 1km network. One card required per networked Master Controller. Allows systems of up to 64 lines (4 x Master Panels each with a Slave Panel) to be easily setup. Any Master EVC Panel can take control of the system by the input of a special code. For networked systems that do not require multiple control points, Master Controllers without Handsets are available. Anti Tamper Enclosure for the CelTEL Master EVC Panel A tough tamper resistant cabinet for housing the Master EVC Controller in areas that are accessible to the general public. Helps ensure the Controller remains operational at all times by reducing the risk of vandalism. Flush and semi flush stainless steel and weather resistant options also available.

11/11

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 8 Page 1

Chapter 8 - Fire Phones and Disable Refuge


Type B Disabled Refuge Outstations Features
Allows anyone in the Refuge Area to communicate with building control at the touch of a button and vice versa. High quality brushed stainless steel or green finish. Includes connections for an optional audio frequency induction loop system. Easily interfaced to strobes, CCTV activation relays and/or disabled persons toilet alarm systems.

Weatherproof IP65 Enclosure for the Type B Surface Mounting Disabled Refuge Outstation Features
An IP65 rated weather resistant enclosure designed for use with the Surface Type B Outstation. Allows an IP65 rated Type B Outstation to be created for use in external areas. Supplied with a locking keyswitch mechanism that can be changed to a semi secure handle. Optional bezel available.

Type A Fire Telephone Outstations Features


Designed for use in fire telephone and stadium marshalling applications. Allows fire marshals and stewards to communicate via a telephone handset. Typically located at entrances and fire fighting lobbies. Supplied in a lockable red steel wall mounted cabinet that can be semi flushed with an optional bezel.

Chapter 8 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

11/11

Chapter 8 - Fire Phones and Disable Refuge


Disabled Persons Toilet Alarm Features
Includes everything required for a BS8300 compliant emergency assistance alarm. Can be interfaced with the CelTEL Disabled Refuge System by wiring directly to a spare line.

CelTEL EVC Typical System Layout


Master/Slave connection via supplied looms (Mount slave adjacent to master so they can be considered one cabinet) More Outstations 2 core 1.5mm2 enhanced fire rated cable upto 1km in length Communication network (only required on networked systems) 4 x 2 core 1.5mm2 enhanced fire rated cable Total network length = 1km Total number of networked systems = 4 (or 64 lines) More Outstations

More Outstations

More Outstations

11/11

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 8 Page 3

Chapter 8 - Fire Phones and Disable Refuge


Technical Specifications
Master Controllers Dimensions / Weight Paint Finish Standby Battery requirements Mains Fuse / Battery Fuse Max number of lines Outstations per line Outstation cabling requirements W 422 x H 250 x D 80mm (base); W 435 x H 269 x D 11mm (Lid); 3.1kg Lid and Base RAL 7035 (Grey Texture) 2 x 12v 7Ah VRLA (valve regulated lead acid) connected in series 1A 20mm HRC / 1A 20mm 8 (expandable to 16 if a slave unit is fitted) networking allows up to 64 line systems 1 2 core 1mm or 1.5mm enhanced fire rated cable, max. 1km/line max. cable resistance

Network Specifications Max no. of Master Panels per network 4 (providing 32 lines, or 64 lines if each Master Controller has a Slave Panel fitted) Connection Via Network Communication Card (one per networked master) Network Cabling requirements 4 x 2 core 1.5mm enhanced fire rated cable, up to 1km in length Anti Tamper Enclosure Dimensions W 603 x H 465 x D 200mm Expansion Units (CelTEL Slave) Cabling requirements 2 x CAT 5 patch leads (supplied) Dimensions / Weight W 412 x H 250 x D 80mm (base); W 435 x H 269 x D 11mm (Lid); 3.1kg Paint Finish Lid and Base RAL 7035 (Grey Texture) Disabled Refuge (Type B) Outstations Dimensions & Weight (Flush) W 175 x H 250 x D 55mm (assembled); W 152 x H 228 x D 53mm (backbox); 1.4kg Dimensions & Weight (Surface) W 175 x H 240 x D 55mm (assembled); 1.4kg Paint Finish Stainless Steel facia, RAL 9005 (jet black) backbox Dimensions (IP65 cabinet) W 200 x H 298 x D 124mm approx (unassembled w/o handle fitted) Fire Telephone (Type A) Outstations Dimensions & Weight (Push Door) W 202 x H 278 x D 105mm; 3.8kg Dimensions & Weight (Lift Lock) W 202 x H 278 x D 125mm; 3.8kg

Product Codes
2572200 2572201 2572202 2572203 2572204 2572206 2572210 2572211 2572212 2572213 2572214 2572215 2572216 2572217 2572219 CelTEL 4 Way Master EVC Panel with Handset and Display CelTEL 8 Way Master EVC Panel with Handset and Display Master Controller without Handset CelTEL Slave EVC Panel with 8 Additional Lines CelTEL EVC Network Communication Card Anti Tamper Enclosure for the CelTEL Master EVC Panel Type B Stainless Steel Flush Mounting Disabled Refuge Outstation Type B Stainless Steel Surface Mounting Disabled Refuge Outstation IP65 Enclosure for the Type B Surface Mounting Disabled Refuge Outstation Type A Fire Telephone Outstation with Push Door Type A Fire Telephone Outstation with Lift up Lock Type B Green Flush Mounting Disabled Refuge Outstation Type B Green Surface Mounting Disabled Refuge Outstation Semi Flush Bezel for Type A Outstation Disabled Persons Toilet Alarm

Chapter 8 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

11/11

Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection Water Leak Detection Alarms


The Water Leak detection system is a water detection system designed to be used in situations where not just flooding but also undue dampness could cause damage or ultimately become dangerous. The system comprises an electronic monitoring and alarm control panel connected to sensors located in the area requiring protection and can be custom made with a variety of types of detection sensor to suit the characteristics of the areas to be covered. This system has been designed for ease of installation and modern micro-electronics ensure a high degree of reliability. Typical Applications: Computer Rooms, Telecommunications and Office Areas Electrical Plant and Tank Areas Valuables, Antiques and Artifacts In general, wherever the presence of water could be a potential problem to people, equipment, perishable stock, data/information archives and record stores, hospital theatres and so on.

There are also sensors for the detection of non-conductive fluids such as diesel/oil.

Features
Suitable for computer rooms Wide range of sensors Relay contacts to interface to BMS or fire alarmcontrollers

DETEK Water Flood Detection Controllers


Controller electronics are housed in a robust cabinet and provide accurate sensing for water leakage and comprehensive alarm facilities. The system is ideal for all types of applications utilising a mixture of sensors on a single control panel to give optimum flexibility. All systems have a test facility to enable simple regular confidence checking of the equipment. Lockable cabinets constructed in mild steel with stove enamelled finish for surface mounting. 20mm Knockouts are provided for ease of cable entry. Indications of status on each zone, wiring fault and supply healthy. Mains fail battery back-up indication where applicable. The 85dBA pulsed audible alarm has a fully functional local mute facility. Approvals: Electro Magnetic Compatibility - All of the control panels and sensors have been performance tested to meet the requirements of EN55022 for emissions and EN50092 for immunity. British International Standards - The equipment is manufactured in accordance with EN ISO 9001 procedures. Electrical Safety - Manufactured in accordance with Electrical Equipment (Safety) Regulations 1994 - Low Voltage Directive (SI 1994/3260).

Technical Specification
Dimensions: 160H x 220W x 62D mm (Single Zone) 270H x 362W x 84D mm (Multi Zone) Single phase 240VAC, 25VA Max. Relay Contacts: Two sets of volt free change over contacts for alarm and one set for wiring fault or power loss. These may be used to link into Building Management Systems or for remote alarms and beacons up to 2A, 50Va.c./d.c.

Product Codes
508.200.004 508.200.005 508.200.006 1 Zone - water/flood control panel 2 Zone - water/flood control panel 4 Zone - water/flood control panel

Supply:

04/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 9 Page 1

Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection


Sensor Cable The Sensor cable comprises of high flexibility conductors insulated by Helagaine mono-filament braiding. Cable or tape sensors are suitable for general protection under false floors, or can be fastened directly to pipework enabling coverage in ceiling void areas. The cables can be connected together, up to 100m, to cater for larger areas. For each zone a start of line and an end of line module is required. Sensor Pads Sensor pads are constructed from glass fibre with an anti-corrosive nickel plated surface. Pads will detect a few ccs of liquid and are either face up for location under vulnerable points or face down for general coverage. Probe Sensors Probe sensors are the least sensitive and are often employed as water level sensors. In general the sensor is enclosed in a protective cover which also provides a means for fixing and 20mm gland entry. The probe is designed for vertical mounting at skirting level though may be mounted in voids or sumps. A screw allows 16mm height adjustment after the sensor is installed.

CD5 & CD10 Sensing Cable


Technical Specification Sensor Cable Dimensions: 8mm dia Product Codes 516.200.010 CD/5 metre length of sensing cable 516.200.011 CD/10 10 metre length of sensing cable

SOL Start of Line for Sensing Cable


Product Code 516.200.012 SOL Start of Line for Sensing Cable

EOL End of Line for Sensing Cable


Product Code 516.200.013 EOL End of Line for Sensing Cable

SFD Sensor Pad - Face Down


Technical Specification Sensor Pads Dimensions: 115H x 160Wmm Product Code 516.200.006 SFD Sensor Pad - Face Down

SFU Sensor Pad - Face Up


Technical Specification Sensor Pads Dimensions: 115H x 160Wmm Product Code 516.200.016 SFU Sensor Pad - Face Up

SFD/C Cover for Sensor Pad


Technical Specification Sensor Pads Dimensions: 115H x 160Wmm Product Code 516.200.007 SFD/C Cover for Sensor Pad

Chapter 9 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

04/10

Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection


SPS/V Vertical Mount Probe Sensor c/w cover
Technical Specification Probe Sensor Dimensions: 85H x 62W x 62Dmm Product Code 516.200.004 SPS/V Vertical Mount Probe Sensor c/w cover

FF1 Fixing Clips for Sensing Cable


Product Code 516.200.014 FF1 Fixing Clips for Sensing Cable

CDT Warning Labels for Sensing Cable


Product Code 516.200.015 CDT Warning Labels for Sensing Cable

04/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 9 Page 3

Chapter 9 - Water Leak Detection

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 9 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

04/10

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards Special Hazards

Introduction
Tyco Safety Products manufacturers and provides a wide range of equipment suitable for use in hazardous areas where normal equipment cannot be safely used. The range extends from IS detectors for use on conventional systems to flameproof and I.S. flame detectors for use in the most demanding of environments. A complete range of Barriers, Housings, Callpoints and Sounders are available to fully support the product range. Electrical equipment supplied for use in Hazardous Areas must comply with rigid requirements to ensure that its introduction into the area does not increase the existing risk. Thorn Security Limited have designed Intrinsically Safe (I.S.) systems and equipment for use in Hazardous Areas which can be connected to Fire Detection Systems installed in Safe Areas. There are two I.S. systems used by Thorn Security Limited. System 620 for use in conventional fire detection circuits and System 800 for use with MINERVA MX digital addressable circuits. The control equipment of the fire detection system must be connected either via a Shunt Diode Safety Barrier or by an Isolating Interface to System 620 and System 800. Two Sounder Systems (one earthed and one isolated) are available for use with System 620 and System 800. APPLICATION - GENERAL The System Designer must be familiar with BS EN 60079-14: 2003, EN 50, EN 50020 and ATEX certification and have successfully completed an appropriate recognised course in Intrinsic Safety. Design of the system requires that the designer has all the information concerning the installation correctly documented. The nature of the Hazard must be defined by the customer and a survey carried out to determine the proximity of the safe area to establish cable runs. The probability of a flammable mixture being present is defined by a Zone Number. Flammable gases are classified in Groups and their minimum spontaneous ignition temperature is categorised by Class. Thorn Security equipment marked EExe ia IIC T5 would be suitable for use in worst case conditions, e.g. Zone 0 (ia), Hydrogen (IIC), T5 (100 deg C). The Fire Alarm Equipment and Safety Barriers should be placed as near as possible to the containment wall of the Hazardous Area. This minimises the cable lengths between the barrier and the Hazardous Area and thus the capacity to store energy. In order that an Installation will comply with the ATEX certification designated for each system it is essential that the certified devices are connected with cables of the specified limits. These limits have been certified for specific classifications of hazard in order that energy storage is limited. Safety Barriers are incorporated into the circuit feeding the Hazardous Area to limit the voltage excursion and the current. The limit of voltage and current will prevent a fault within the I.S. circuit exceeding the ignition conditions. THE FITTING OF SAFETY BARRIERS, ISOLATING INTERFACES OR SOUNDER DRIVERS DOES NOT IN ITSELF MAKE A CIRCUIT TO WHICH THEY ARE CONNECTED INTRINSICALLY SAFE.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 1

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


APPLICATION - HAZARDOUS AREA A Hazardous Area is defined as one where in the presence of a flammable mixture, ignition may cause an explosion. There is a risk of an explosion when substances (whether liquid, gas, vapour, dust, powder, or solid) are mixed with air to form a flammable atmosphere. To prevent the possibility of ignition in flammable atmospheres special precautions for the construction and use of electrical apparatus is required. One method of construction and use is defined as INTRINSICALLY SAFE. APPLICATION - INTRINSIC SAFETY To preclude the risk of an explosion, equipment in the Hazardous Area must not be capable of causing ignition under normal operating, or specific fault conditions. Limiting the energy which can be stored in, and released by, electronic circuitry and cables in the Hazardous Area is achieved by using Intrinsically Safe equipment and by placing restrictions on the cable parameters. To complete the explosion protection concept of a circuit a Safety Barrier must be connected between the Hazardous Area equipment and the source of power in the Safe Area. The electrical power which may be supplied or drawn from a Safe Area (i.e. an area with no definable hazard) is limited by using Shunt-Diode Safety Barriers or Isolating I.S. Interface Units. Connection of the Hazardous Area equipment to the Safety Barrier must comply with the limitations listed in the System Certification. These limits have been certified for specific classifications of hazard in order that energy storage in the cables is limited. If the Electrical Energy in a circuit is less than the value required to ignite a potentially explosive mixture then the circuit is said to be INTRINSICALLY SAFE. APPLICATION - GALVANIC ISOLATORS Galvanic isolators protect the integrity of an Intrinsically Safe circuit under "Fault" conditions. Galvanic isolators operate in a fully floating electrically isolated condition, no High Integrity I.S. earth is required. SHUNT-DIODE SAFETY BARRIERS AND INTERFACE UNITS A Shunt-Diode Safety Barrier, Isolating I.S. Interface Unit, or Isolating Sounder Driver protects the integrity of an Intrinsically Safe circuit under 'Fault' conditions. The over-voltage protection provided by a Shunt-Diode Safety Barrier is with reference to the safety barrier earth connection. It is therefore imperative that a HIGH INTEGRITY EARTH is used for this type of barrier. A High Integrity Earth is a current sink of nominally zero impedance capable of passing a fault current without compromising the function of the Shunt-Diode Safety Barrier. Connection to this earth and the barrier earth must not be more than 1 ohm and not less than 4mm2 cross section area. Several types of safety barrier are commercially available and include Single circuit and Dual circuit Shunt-diode, and galvanically isolating types. The Shunt-diode type requires a High Integrity Earth connection and the galvanically Isolating type operates in a fully floating electrically isolated condition; no High Integrity I.S. earth is required. A Shunt-Diode Safety Barrier DOES NOT make a circuit to which it is connected Intrinsically Safe. CERTIFICATION The design and construction of the equipment that may be installed in a Hazardous Area is controlled by a scheme of inspection and certification to the EU ATEX Directive 94/9/EC. The inspection and certification is carried out by an approved ATEX notified body. Designers are licensed to reproduce the marks on equipment that complies with the Certification listed in its License Number. Only ATEX approved barriers/isolators and intrinsically safe hazardous area equipment may be used.

Chapter 10 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards Special Hazard Flame Detectors


Features
ATEX, ICEX & FM approved Fast, reliable flame detection using multi-infrared detection Simplifies alarm handling for remote control room situations Provides immediate visual ID of alarm location Robust stainless steel housing with heated window Automatic monitoring of detector functionality 256 cell infrared sensor array monitoring the field of view to separately identify flame and non flame sources Range of integral interface options Masking of part of field of view with software configuration tool 60m detection range with 90 field of view Remote video monitoring with fire location and detector information Automatic optical path monitoring History Log stored in detector

FV300 Array Based Flame Detectors


The FlameVision FV300 is a range of detectors that use a 256 cell multi-infrared array, to detect flame and provide positional information so that the location of a flame within the detectors field of view can be communicated. Additionally, an inbuilt CCTV camera can transmit a detectors eye view of the protected area to a CCTV monitor. Superimposed onto the CCTV picture will be the positional data highlighting exactly where the source of alarm is coming from. An angle of view of 90 degrees on the horizontal plane has been achieved with little or no reduction in sensitivity over the entire field. A pan fire covering one-tenth of a square metre can be detected by the FlameVision FV300 at a range of 60 metres. Such a small fire at that range would not normally be visible on a CCTV picture. The superimposed positional data on the CCTV display highlights and identifies the source of the alarm. This can save precious time and allow executive actions to take place at the earliest opportunity thus minimising potential fire losses.

Markets:
The FlameVision FV300 detectors are intended for applications demanding a high level of protection and where a rapid response to fire is important. Typical applications are: Refineries Drilling and production plants Fuel loading facilities Compressor stations LNG/LPG processing & storage Gas turbines Chemical production Aircraft hangars Waste management/transfer Sports stadiums Tank farms Printing industry Warehousing Munitions storage

Range of Interfaces:
As standard the FV300 is supplied with the following interfaces: Fire and fault relays, programmable as normally open or normally closed 4 to 20mA analogue current output, proportional to the flame detection signal (sink or source) RS485 serial data port suitable for network connection using a MODBUS protocol. This can be used to communicate the positional co-ordinates of a flame within the field of view of the detector Video output compatible with twisted pair video cable

Flame Vision Models: There are six FlameVision models in the FV300 detector range. There are models with and without cameras. Each model is also supplied either with a sealed back-box and a pre-connected 3m length of cable or with two threaded cable gland entries.

FV300 Flame Detector Model Nos. No camera PAL Format camera NSTC Format camera

Cable gland entries FV311S FV311SC FV311SC-N

Sealed back-box FV312S FV312SC FV312SC-N

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 3

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Technical Specification
Mechanical Characteristics Dimensions Height: 138.8 mm Width: 152.8 mm Depth: 91.7 mm Weight: 3.96 kg Mounting bracket weight: 1.54 kg Materials Enclosure: Detection window: Camera window: Guard/label plate: Mounting bracket: Screws etc. exposed to the elements: Electronic modules Stainless Steel 316L, ANC4BFCLC to BS 3146: Part 2 Sapphire Toughened glass Stainless Steel 316S16 to BS 1449: Part 2 Stainless Steel 316S16 to BS 1449: Part 2 Stainless Steel 316 A4 Fibreglass substrate

Product Codes
516.300.006 516.300.008 516.300.007 516.300.055 516.300.057 516.300.056 517.300.001 517.300.002 517.300.005 517.300.006 517.300.021 517.300.022 FV311S Flameproof Detector - cable gland entries - no camera FV311SC Flameproof Detector - cable gland entries - PAL camera FV311SC-N Flameproof Detector - cable gland entries - NTSC camera FV312S Flameproof Detector - sealed back box - no camera FV312SC Flameproof Detector - sealed back box - PAL camera FV312SC-N Flameproof Detector - sealed back box - NTSC camera MB300 Mounting Bracket WH300 Stainless Steel Weather Hood JB300 Exe Junction Box MK300 Field Spares Kit WT300 Walk-test Controller CTI300 Off-line Configuration Tool Kit

Electrical access FV311 Series detectors: Standard M20 gland holes (two) FV312 Series detectors: Multi twisted pair screened cable Environmental Temp. Humidity, Enclosure Protection and Pressure Operating temp. range without camera: Operating temp. range with camera: Maximum withstand temp: Storage temp. range: Relative humidity: Enclosure protection: Normal operating atmospheric press: Heat radiation from sun:

- 40C to + 80C - 10C to + 55C 120C (for 10minutes) - 40C to + 80C Up to 99% (non condensing) Tested to IP66 and IP67 910 mbar to 1055 mbar 0 to 1kWm2 typical

Chapter 10 Page 4

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Triple waveband infrared solar blind flame detection for optimum false alarm immunity Unrivalled black body rejection over a wide range of source temperatures Range adjustable to 50 metres for a 0.1m2 petrol pan fire Discrimination of optical faults (dirty windows) from other faults by the built-in self test feature Housing designed for easy installation of cabling Models also available with relay or 4-20mA outputs Patented dual filter for complete solar blindness 100 field of view on IS versions 90 field of view on Flameproof versions IECEX Approved

S200 Plus Triple IR Solar Blind Flame Detector


Unlike other flame detectors on the market the MINERVA S200 PLUS is available in both Intrinsically Safe (EEx ia) and Flameproof (EEx d) models. The intrinsically safe models are suffixed by the letter " i " and are ATEX Certified EEx ia IIC T5. As part of an intrinsically safe circuit, it is suitable for zones 0,1 and 2 where group IIC gases or lesser hazards can be continuously present in explosive concentrations. The flameproof models are suffixed by the letter "f" and are ATEX Certified EEx d IIC T6. The detectors are suitable for zones 1 and 2 where group IIC gases or lesser hazards can be intermittently present in explosive concentrations.

Technical Specification
Detector Material: Dimensions: Weight: Gland Entry: Range: Operating Temp: Intrinsically Safe= Flame Proof= Response Time: Sensitivity: Relative Humidity: Enclosure: Stainless Steel 316L/316 167H x 167W x 89D MM 4.5Kg 2 x 20mm 0.1m2 petrol at 50m 0.4m2 petrol at 60m - 40oc to +80o c (IECEX & ATEX) - 20oc to +60o c/+80oc (IECEX/ATEX) Field Selectable 3,6 and 12s 3 range settings 95% (100% intermittent) IP 66 and IP 67

Product Codes
517.001.266 517.001.263 517.001.184 S200+ Spares Kit & Sealant S200+ Weather Protection Assembly S200+ Detector Mounting Bracket

Datasheet - Product Code PSF102U Minerva S200 Plus Series

Approvals Various models are certified by a number of approval bodies including those listed below. ATEX Approved models have a suffix 1 as the third digit. FM Approved models have a suffix 2 as the third digit.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 5

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


S200 Plus Triple IR Solar Blind Flame Detector
Additional Features Flexible mounting and angular adjustment 2 x 20mm field cable entries IP66/67 housing designed for external use Rugged 316 stainless steel housing and mounting bracket Variable response times and sensitivity settings Remote self test and range setting True window test in detection area (i.e. not in the edge of the window) Terminals provided for Remote LED connection where relevant BASEEFA (CENELEC) certified Approved to EN54 Pt 10 (Except FV282F) IEC 61508 Approved (SIL2) FM, DNV and LRS certified Very low power consumption (0.35mA) Models available with Conventional or Analogue Addressable interface (requires 2 core cable only)

Approvals Interface Conventional S231i+ S231f+ S232f+ S241i+ S241f+ S261f+ S271i+ S271f+ FV282F+ 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4 4-20mA MZX Addressable Relay 4 4 4 ATEX Ex ia Ex d FM Ex d 516.037.004 516.037.003 516.037.015 516.038.004 516.038.003 516.040.002 516.041.004 516.041.003 516.040.014 Product Codes

Chapter 10 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards System 800 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas
Features
Addressable I.S. MX Technology Compatible with S271i+ flame detector Compatible I.S. callpoint. Atex certified intrinsically safe Ex II 1 GD System Suitable for use in Zone 0, 1, 2, 20, 21 & 22

System 800 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas


A complete range of ATEX and ICEX certified detectors suitable for use in Zone 0, 1, 2, 20, 21 & 22 Areas. MX digital addressable for use on Minerva MX Fire Controllers. There is a risk of fire or explosion in all areas containing flammable substances in the form of liquids, gasses, dust or materials. Where these combustible materials are mixed with air in sufficient concentration they form a flammable atmosphere and the areas containing them are designated Hazardous Areas. When a source of ignition, such as a spark, is applied in a hazardous area, an explosion could take place. Electrical equipment supplied for use in Hazardous Areas must comply with requirements to ensure that its introduction into the area does not increase the existing risk. System 800 is an MX TechnologyTM Intrinsically Safe (I.S) system for use in Hazardous Areas which can be connected to the MX Fire Detection Systems installed in the Safe Areas. The System designer must be familiar with ATEX certification and have successfully completed an appropriate recognised course in Intrinsic Safety. Design of the system requires that the designer has all the information concerning the installation correctly documented. The nature of the hazard must be defined by the customer and a survey carried out to determine the proximity of the safe area to establish cable runs. The probability of a flammable mixture being present is defined by a zone number. Flammable gasses are classified in Groups and their minimum spontaneous ignition temperature is categorised by Class. Tyco Safety Products supplied equipment marked EEx ia IIC T5 would be suitable for use in worst case conditions. E.G. Zone 0 (ia), Hydrogen (IIc), T5 (100 deg C). The Fire Alarm Equipment and Safety Barriers should be placed as near as possible to the containment wall of the Hazardous Area. This minimises the cable lengths between the barrier and the Hazardous Area and thus the capacity to store energy. In order that an Installation will comply with the ATEX certification designated for each system, it is essential that the certified devices are connected with cables of the specified limits. These limits have been certified for specific classifications of hazard in order that energy storage is limited. The number of devices connected to the barrier and located in the Hazardous Area must always be limited to not more than the listed maximum. The use of the MX designer Software tool will ensure correct loop loading and its use is essential to the design process. System 800 is for use in MX Technology Addressable Fire detection circuits. Datasheet PSF129U Manual 17A-02-DETEx

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 7

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


801PHEx/811PHExn Smoke and Heat Detector
The 801PHEx/811PHExn Optical Smoke & Heat Detectors form part of the 800Ex Series of MX Addressable Fire Detectors. The detector plugs into the 5BEX base. The mode of detector may be: Optical smoke only detector (sensitivity - High, Normal or Low) HPO smoke detector (sensitivity High, Normal or Low) Heat only rate-of-rise (A1R) detector (no sensitivity selection) Heat fixed temperature 60C (A2S no sensitivity selection) Optical (sensitivity High, Normal or Low) combined with heat fixed temperature 60C (A2S) HPO (sensitivity High, Normal or Low) combined with heat fixed temperature 60C (A2S) Technical Specification ATEX Code: Ex ia EX II 1GD Exn EX II 3G Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100C/ EExnA II T4 Weight: 0.2Kg detector and base (approx) Operating Temp. Range: -25C to +70C Storage Temp: -40C to +70C Relative Humidity: 95% non- condensing Product Codes 516.800.530 801PHEx Optical Smoke + Heat Detector 516.800.534 811PHExn Marine Optical Smoke + Heat Detector Manual Vol 17A-02-PHExn 17A-02-PHEx

801CHEx/811CHExn CO & Heat Detector


The 801CHEx/811CHExn Carbon Monoxide plus Heat Detector form part of the 800Ex Series of MX Addressable Fire Detectors. The detector plugs into the 5BEX base. The mode of detector may be: Heat only detector (A1R or A2S) (sensitivity: High, Normal or Low) Compensated Carbon Monoxide detector (sensitivity: High Normal or Low) Compensated Carbon Monoxide detector (sensitivity: High or Normal) combined with heat (A1R) Technical Specification ATEX Code: Ex ia EX II 1GD Exn EX II 3G Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100C/ EExnA II T4 Weight: 0.2Kg detector and base (approx) Operating Temp. Range: 0C to +55C/-20C to +40C Storage Temp: -20C to +55C Relative Humidity: 95% non condensing. Product Codes 516.800.531 801CHEx Carbon Monoxide + Heat Detector 516.800.535 811CHExn Marine Carbon Monoxide + Heat Detector Manual Vol 17A-02-CHExn 17A-02-CHEx

801HEx/811HExn Heat Detector


The 801HEx/811HExn Heat Detectors form part of the 800Ex Series of MX Addressable Fire Detectors. The detector plugs into the 5BEX base. The mode of detector may be: EN54-5 A1R, rate-of- rise normal ambient EN54-5 A2S, fixed 60C EN54-5 CR, rate-of-rise high ambient; Technical Specification ATEX Code: Ex ia EX II 1GD Exn EX II 3G Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100C/ EExnA II T4 Weight: 0.2Kg detector and base (approx) Operating Temp. Range: -25C to +70C Storage Temp: -40C to +70C/-40C to +80C Relative Humidity: 95% non-condensing Product Codes 516.800.532 801HEx Heat Detector 516.800.536 811HExn Marine Heat Detector Manual Vol 17A-02-HExn 17A-02-HEx

801FEx Flame Detector


The 801FEx point type flame detector forms part of the MX Technologyrange of digital addressable fire detectors. The detector plugs into the 5BEX base. The 801FEx is a full featured solar blind flame detectors and can detect a 0.1m2 fire at a range of 20m. Technical Specification ATEX Code:Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T4/ Ex iaD 20 T135C Weight: 0.2Kg detector and base (approx) Operating Temp.Range: -20C to +70C Storage Temp: -40C to +80C Relative Humidity: 90% non-condensing Product Codes 516.800.066 801FEx I.R. Flame Detector 516.800.067 811FEx Marine I.R. Flame Detector Manual Vol 17A-02-FEX

IS28 Banshee Sounder


The IS28 MK4 intrinsically safe banshee sounder has been developed for use in hazardous areas. Up to a maximum of four sounders may be connected to one I.S. sounder driver. Each IS28 banshee has an output of 94dBA at one metre, this sound output will reduce to approximately 90dBA when four sounders are fitted to a circuit. Technical Specification ATEX Certification number ITS03ATEX21311X to II GD EEx ia IIC T5 ICEX Approved Product Code 576.501.013 IS28 MK 4 Banshee BS5839 Low Frequency ATEX Certified Intrinsically Safe - Grey Sounder

Chapter 10 Page 8

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


CP840Ex Break Glass Call Point
The CP840Ex Weatherproof Break Glass Call Point is designed to monitor and signal the condition of a switch contact associated with the break glass. Technical Specification ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/Ex iaD 20 T100C Operating Temp Range: -25C to +70C Storage Temp: -30C to +70C Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH non condensing Product Code 514.800.513 CP840Ex MX Digital Addressable Break Glass Call Point Manual Vol 17A-02-CPEx

CP830Exn Break Glass Call Point


The CP830Exn Weatherproof Break Glass Call Point is designed to monitor and signal the condition of a switch contact associated with the break glass. Technical Specification ATEX Code: Ex II 3G Cenelec Code: EEx nL IIC T4 (-20oc Ta +40oc) Operating Temp Range: -25C to +70C Storage Temp: -40C to +80C Relative Humidity: Up to 95% RH non condensing Product Code 514.800.514 CP830Exn Marine MX Digital Addressable Break Glass Call Point Manual Vol 17A-02-CP830Exn

IF800Ex Interface Module


The Intrinsically Safe IF800EX Interface Module is designed to monitor fire contacts such as sprinkler flow switches. The IF800Ex is contained within a grey compression moulded glass filled polyester box with 2 x 20mm cable gland holes. The electronic components are mounted on a double sided printed circuit board built into a potted module formed from a plastic moulding. Connectivity is via two terminal blocks fitted to the PCB. Technical Specification ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: EEx ia IIC T5 Product Code 514.001.062 IF800Ex MX Digital Addressable Interface Module Assembly Manual Vol 17A-02-IFEX

EXI800 Interface Module & Galvanic Isolators


The EXI800 Interface Module, used with a galvanic isolator, provides a path for an MX panel to transparently communicate to slave devices (800Ex Detectors, IF800Ex Interface Module or CP840Ex Addressable Break Glass Callpoint) connected to the Intrinsically Safe loop. The interface reduces the standard MX loop supply voltage and signalling currents to levels that are acceptable for hazardous areas. The EXI800 can detect a short circuit of the left-loop, the right-loop, or the IS spur and will isolate the offending circuit from the other loop connections. The IS loop output of the EXI800 interfaces with the Pepper+Fuchs KFDO-CS-Ex1.54 Galvanic Isolator supplying loop voltage and signalling currents to the Intrinsically Safe Loop. The EXI800 is supplied complete with one service tool EX dongle that is required to activate address programming using the standard MX service tool. The MTL 5021 Isolating sounder driver enables an intrinsically safe sounder device located in the hazardous area, to be controlled from the safe area. The MTL 5021 has one channel and is suitable for connecting suitable certified loads in Zone 0, IIC, T4-6 hazardous areas. Product Codes 514.001.063 EXI800 Interface Module 517.001.259 Pepper+Fuchs KFD0-CS-EX1.54 Galvanic Isolator 557.203.008 Spare Service Tool Ex Dongle 517.001.245 MTL 5021 I. S. Sounder Driver Manual Vol 17A-02-EXI

IS Barrier Enclosure
The MTLDX Series enclosure equipment will house the EXI800 20mm pitch), Pepper+Fuchs KFDOCS-Ex1.54 Galvanic Isolator (20mm pitch) and MTL 5021 I.S. Sounder Driver 16.2mm pitch). The units are DIN rail mounted with 70mm of rail supplied with the DX070 and 170mm of rail with the DX170. Enclosures are usually selected on the number of units they will accommodate. The following table shows the capacity of each of the enclosure types. Product Codes 517.001.248 DX070 Enclosure 517.001.247 DX170 Enclosure

Enclosure

MTL5000 isolators 16mm Pitch

MTL7000 barriers 7.5mm Pitch

DX070 4(2*) 9(5*) DX170 10 (8*) 22(18*) * Use these figures when two IMB57 mounting brackets for tagging/earth rail accessories are included.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 9

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Glass Reinforced Polyester Enclosure light, strong and not subject to corrosion. Resettable Element. Explosion protected EExe (ATEX Approved). In line and end of line resistors. Red Epoxy Finish. 7 x terminals. Lift flap for extra protection against inadvertent operation. 1 x changeover switch. Captive cover screws. Key operated test facility simple but secure. 1 x M20 bottom cable entry.

BG MIM800 Callpoint EX II 2 GD
An Ex II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased Safety (EExemd) Resettable Manual Alarm Call Point for use with the EExd Flameproof MIM800 input module in EExd housing on an Addressable Detection & Releasing System in gas and dust explosive risks. Please note that the above part is only compatible with Consys Version 17.0 and above when used with 577.800.067.

Technical Specification
Explosion Protected EExed(Increased Safety) Certification: ATEX approved Ex II 2 GD BAS02ATEX2105X EExemdIICT4 CENELEC EN50014 EN50019 EN50018 EN50028 Suitable for use in Zones 1 & 2 Voltage: Up to 250V Certified Temperature: -20oC to +50oC Ingress Protection: IP66 & 67 Terminals: 7 x 2.5mm Switch Ratings(1 x Changeover): DC 0-30V 5A (Resistive) or 3A (Inductive) DC 30-50V 1A Resistive or Inductive AC 0-254V 5A Resistive or Inductive Cable Entries: 1 x M20 Bottom Weight: 1.2Kg Material: Anti Static U.V. Resistant Glass Reinforced Polyester Finish: Red Epoxy Paint Resistors: Alarm: 100 Ohm EOL: 250 Ohm Labelling: Burning House Symbol Dimensions (W X H X D): 120mm x 126mm x 75mm Protection:

Product Code
514.001.107 EX II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased Safety (EExemd) Resettable Manual Alarm Callpoint

Chapter 10 Page 10

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Copper Free Metal Alloy Aluminium Housing Explosion Protected to EExd (ATEX Approved) 9 x Terminals 3 x M20 Cable Entries Fast Interrupt Mode for Call Points

MIM800 Input Module in EExd Housing


An EExd Flameproof MIM800 Addressable Module for extending the monitoring of Call Points and other Alarm Inputs on an MX, ZX and MZX Addressable System in gas and dust explosive risks. Please note that the above part is only compatible with Consys Version 17.0 and above when used with 514.001.107.

Technical Specification
Protection: Certification: Explosion Protected EExd (Flameproof) Ex II 2 GD LOM02ATEX2037 EExdIICT6 CENELEC EN50014 EN50018 EN50019 EN50281-1-1 EN60439-1 Suitable for use in Zones 1 and 2 to IEC 60079-10 Suitable for use in Zones 21 and 22 to EN50281-3 40Vdc -20oC to +55oC IP67 9 x 2.5mm 3 x M20 (No Blanking Plugs) 0.8 Kg Metal Alloy Aluminium - Copper Free 108mm x 98mm x 90mm

Product Code
577.800.067 MIM800 Input Module in EExd Housing

Voltage: Certified Temperature: Ingress Protection: Terminals: Cable Entries: Weight: Material: Dimensions (W X H X D):

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 11

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Allows the DDM800 to be mounted in a Hazardous Area. Allows the monitoring of Call Points and other Alarm Inputs (including 4-20mA devices) designed for use in Hazardous Areas on an MX, ZX and MZX Addressable System in gas and dust explosive risks. Approved for use in Gas Zone 1 and 2. Approved for use in Dust Zone 21 and 22. Copper Free Metal Alloy Aluminium Housing. Explosion Protected to EExd (ATEX Approved). 5 x M20 Cable Entries (3 x bottom and one each side).

DDM800 Fire & Gas Detector Module in EExd Housing


A DDM800 Fire and Gas Detector Module in a EExd Housing for use in special hazardous area applications. The DDM800 Universal Fire and Gas Detection Module is a detector module designed to interface a wide range of conventional fire detectors to MZX Technology control panels. Additionally the option is available to connect two 4 to 20mA devices and to configure the alarm thresholds within the control panel. The DDM800 is supported by MXConsys Version 15 and above and Issue 6 MXDesigner. It is recommended that MXDesigner is used for all system designs using DDM800 modules. For detailed design and application details, please refer to document "DDM800 Universal Fire & Gas Detector Module Product Application and Design Information" reference 17A-02-DDM.

Technical Specification
Protection: Certification: Explosion Protected EExd (Flameproof) Ex II 2 GD LOM02ATEX2037 EExdIICT6 CENELEC EN50014 EN50018 EN50019 EN50281-1-1 EN60439-1 Suitable for use in Zones 1 and 2 to IEC 60079-10 Suitable for use in Zones 21 and 22 to EN50281-3 40Vdc -20oC to +55oC IP67 12 x 2.5mm 5 x M20 (3 Blanking Plugs Supplied) 1.3 Kg Metal Alloy Aluminium - Copper Free 150mm x 150mm x 104mm

Product Code
577.800.066 DDM800 Fire & Gas Detector Module in EExd Housing

Voltage: Certified Temperature: Ingress Protection: Terminals: Cable Entries: Weight: Material: Dimensions (W X H X D):

Chapter 10 Page 12

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Allows the SIO800 to be mounted in a Hazardous Area. Allows the status of a normally open contact to be monitored and/or a volt free change over relay output in a Hazardous Area to be interfaced onto an MX, ZX and MZX Addressable System in a gas and dust explosive risk. Approved for use in Gas Zone 1 and 2. Approved for use in Dust Zone 21 and 22. Copper Free Metal Alloy Aluminium Housing. Explosion Protected to EExd (ATEX Approved). 5 x M20 Cable Entries (3 x bottom fitted with blanking plugs and one each side supplied open).

SIO800 I/O Module in EExd Housing


The SIO800 Single Input/Output Module is designed to monitor a normally open contact input and provide a volt free changeover relay output. This enables inputs and outputs from hazardous area devices to be easily interfaced to the MX, MZX, MX2, T2000 and ZX Range of Control Panels.

Technical Specification
Protection: Certification: Explosion Protected EExd (Flameproof) Ex II 2 GD KEMA 09ATEX0110 EExdIICT6 CENELEC EN50014 EN50018 EN50019 EN50281-1-1 EN60439-1 Suitable for use in Zones 1 and 2 to IEC 60079-10 Suitable for use in Zones 21 and 22 to EN50281-3 40Vdc -20oC to +55oC IP67 9 x 2.5mm 5 x M20 1.64 Kg Metal Alloy Aluminium - Copper Free 150mm x 150mm x 104mm

Product Code
555.800.072 SIO800 Single Input/Output Module in EExd Housing

Voltage: Certified Temperature: Ingress Protection: Terminals: Cable Entries: Weight: Material: Dimensions (W X H X D):

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 13

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards System 620 Fire Detection for Hazardous Areas
Features
Conventional I.S. system Suitable for worst case (EEx ia IIC T5) High Performance Optical (HPO) smoke detector Compatible with S231i+ flame detector Compatible I.S. callpoint Suitable for use in Zone 0,1,2,20,21& 22

System 620 Fire Detection


A complete range of ATEX and ICEX certified detectors suitable for use in Zones 0,1,2,20,21 & 22 areas for use on conventional panels. There is a risk of fire or explosion in all areas containing flammable substances in the form of liquids, gasses, dust or materials. Where these combustible materials are mixed with air in sufficient concentration they form a flammable atmosphere and the areas containing them are designated Hazardous Areas. When a source of ignition, such as a spark, is applied in a hazardous area, an explosion could take place. Electrical equipment supplied for use in Hazardous Areas must comply with requirements to ensure that its introduction into the area does not increase the existing risk. System 620 is an Intrinsically Safe (I.S.) system for use in Hazardous Areas which can be connected to a conventional fire Alarm Controller installed in the Safe Area. The System Designer must be familiar with ATEX certification and have successfully completed an appropriate recognised course in Intrinsic Safety. Design of the system requires that the designer has all the information concerning the installation correctly documented. The nature of the hazard must be defined by the customer and a survey carried out to determine the proximity of the safe area to establish cable runs. The probability of a flammable mixture being present is defined by a Zone Number. Flammable gases are classified in Groups and their minimum spontaneous ignition temperature is categorised by Class. Tyco Safety Products supplied equipment marked EEx ia IIC T5 would be suitable for use in worst case conditions. Eg. Zone 0 (ia), Hydrogen (IIc), T5 (100 deg C). The Fire Alarm Equipment and Safety Barriers should be placed as near as possible to the containment wall of the Hazardous Area. This minimises the cable lengths between the barrier and the Hazardous Area and thus the capacity to store energy. In order that an Installation will comply with the ATEX certification designated for each system it is essential that the certified devices are connected with cables of the specified limits. These limits have been certified for specific classifications of hazard in order that energy storage is limited. The number of devices connected to the barrier and located in the Hazardous Area must always be limited to not more than the listed maximum. When a mixture of devices is connected to any one zone the numbers must be reduced in proportion to the ratio of the load presented to the barrier. When a System includes the use of an S231i+, it must be remembered that the load it presents to the circuit is twice that of a detector. A mixture of large and small load devices connected to a zone will require a calculation for the number of allowed detectors. System 620 System 620 is for use in conventional fire detection circuits. Two Sounder Systems, (one earthed and one isolated), are available and either can be used with System 620. Datasheet - PSF122U

Chapter 10 Page 14

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


High Performance Optical Smoke
The MR601TEX has been developed to overcome the slower response of the optical detectors to hot burning fires, by increasing the sensitivity of the optical detector when it is associated with a rapid change in temperature. In this way it is intended to become a detector which can cover some of the risks currently covered by ion chamber detectors. Smoke detectors will not detect burning alcohol or other clean burning liquids which do not generate smoke particles. ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/ Ex iaD 20 T100C Operating Temp Range: -20C to +70C Storage Temp: -25C to +80C Relative Humidity: 95% noncondensing Product Code 516.054.011.Y (Vol 01B-04-D12) MR601TEX Conventional High Performance Optical Smoke Detector

Heat Detectors
If environmental conditions rule out the use of smoke detectors, then a heat detector of the type MD601Ex/MD611Ex may provide an acceptable, though less sensitive, alternative. For general use, and particularly where the ambient temperature may be low, a 'Rate-ofRise' heat sensor is to be preferred. This type of sensor reacts to abnormally high rates of change of temperature and provides the fastest response over a wide range of ambient temperatures. A fixed temperature limit is also incorporated in these detectors. In many environments, e.g. kitchens and boiler rooms, sudden, large changes in temperature are considered 'normal'. Rate-of-rise detectors are generally not suitable in these cases and fixed temperature [static] types should be used. ATEX Code : Cenelec Code: Ex iaD 20 T100C Ex II 1GD Ex ia IIC T5/ Operating Temp Range: -20C to +70C Storage Temp: -25C to +80C Relative Humidity: 95% noncondensing Product Codes 516.052.051.Y (Vol 01B-04-D11) MD601EX Conventional Rate of Rise Heat Detector 516.052.041.Y (Vol 01B-04-D11) MD611EX Conventional Fixed Temperature Heat Detector

Flame Detectors
Flame detectors, unlike smoke and heat detectors, do not rely on convection to transport the fire products to the detector nor do they rely on a ceiling to trap the products. They can therefore be used to protect large open areas without sacrificing speed of response to flaming fires. In order to ensure full coverage however, flame detectors do require direct line of sight to all parts of the protected area. Infra-red flame detectors such as the 601FEx are designed to respond rapidly to fires which involve clean-burning fuels such as alcohol or methane, i.e. fires which would not be detected by smoke detectors. The 601FEx Flame Sensor, by virtue of its operating wavelength and flicker discrimination is insensitive to normal environmental influences. For outdoor use a solar-blind detector [e.g. the S200 Plus] should be used. The 601FEx Flame detector should, normally, only be used inside buildings to supplement heat and smoke detectors. ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T4/ Ex iaD 20 T135C Operating Temp Range: -20C to +70C Storage Temp: -40C to +80C Relative Humidity: 90% noncondensing Product Codes 516.600.066 (Vol 01C-02-D10) 601FEx Infra-Red Flame Detector 516.600.067 (Vol 01C-02-D10) 601FEx-M Infra-Red Flame Detector (Marine)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 15

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Enhanced Carbon Monoxide Fire & Heat Detector
The MDU601EX detector is a combined CO and Rate of Rise Heat Detector where the sensitivity of the CO detector is enhanced in response to a fast rate of change of temperature. ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/ Ex iaD 20 T100C Operating Temp Range: -10C to +55C Storage Temp: -20C to +55C Relative Humidity: 90% noncondensing Product Code 516.061.001.Y (Vol 01B-04-D14) MDU 601EX Enhanced Carbon Monoxide Fire & Heat Detector

5BEX Detector Base and Ancillaries ATEX Code: Ex II 1GD Cenelec Code: Ex ia IIC T5/ Ex iaD 20 T100C
Operating Temp Range: -25C to +70C Storage Temp: -40C to +80C Relative Humidity: 95% noncondensing Product Codes 517.050.023 5BEX 5 Universal Ex Base 517.050.603 DHM-5B deckhead mounting 517.001.120 System 601 EOL Unit (Pk 10)

Chapter 10 Page 16

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Intrinsically Safe Weatherproof to IP67 Compatible with System 620

Intrinsically Safe Callpoint - ATEX Approved


The MCP220Ex is a conventional callpoint for use on the ATEX Certified System.

Technical Specification
Dimensions: Weight: Material: Conventional: Colour: ATEX Code: CENELEC: ATEX Cert: IP Rating: 93H x 98W x 66Dmm 270g PC/ABS Yes Red Ex II 1GD EX ia IIC T4 Ga /EX iaD T135c Da SIRA 06ATEX2131X IP67

Product Code
514.001.109 MCP220Ex Red Callpoint intrinsically safe for use with ATEX certified conventional system 620.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 17

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Intrinsically safe Weatherproof to IP66/IP67 Robust GRP Housing

BG3 Intrinsically Safe Conventional Callpoint -Atex Approved


This manual fire alarm call point is designed in accordance with the latest European Callpoint Standard (EN54-11). Weatherproof to IP66/IP67 and available certified intrinsically safe, simple apparatus manufactured from glass reinforced polyester (GRP) which provides a robust, corrosion free construction and ensures effective and reliable operation in harsh industrial and offshore environments. Units are supplied in self coloured GRP with a Burning House duty label as standard.

Technical Specification
Model: Protection: BG3I Explosion Protected EExia (Intrinsically Safe) Certification: CENELEC EN50014, 020 BASEEFA EExia IIC T4 Cert No. BAS00ATEX1067X Suitable for use in Zones 0,1 & 2 Voltage: Up to 28V (IS) Certified Temp: -55C to +55C Ingress Protection: IP66 & IP67 European Standard for Callpoints: EN54-11 Terminals: 6 X 4.0mm2 Cable Entries: 2 X M20 Bottom Weight: 0.5Kg Material: UV resistant glass reinforced polyester Finish: Natural Red GRP

Product Code
514.001.059 Intrinsically Safe Callpoint (BG3I4NBN)

Chapter 10 Page 18

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Polyester Enclosure light, strong and not subject to corrosion. Break Glass. Explosion protected EExe (ATEX Approved). In line and end of line resistors. Red. 9 x terminals. Lift flap for extra protection against inadvertent operation. 1 x changeover switch. Captive cover screws. No hammer required the glass is covered by a membrane thus protecting the operator from glass fragments. Key operated test facility simple but secure. 2 x M20 bottom cable entries.

BG Conventional Callpoint EX II 2 GD
This EX II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased Safety (EExemd) Conventional Break Glass Manual Alarm Call Point is fitted with a 470 ohm Alarm Level Resistor and a 4K7 ohm EOL Resistor for use with Tyco Conventional Detection Circuits including the DIM800 and DDM800 MX Modules. It is also fitted with a removable link which allows it to be connected on its own or with other Conventional Devices to a Tyco Conventional Detection Circuit.

Technical Specification
Explosion Protected EExed (Increased Safety) Certification: ATEX approved Ex II 2 GD BAS02ATEX2105X EExedmIICT4 CENELEC EN50014 EN50019 EN50018 EN50028 Suitable for use in Zones 1 & 2 Voltage: Up to 250V Certified Temperature: -20oC to +50oC Ingress Protection: IP66 & 67 Terminals: 9 x 2.5mm up to 60V Switch Ratings(1 x Changeover): DC 0-30V 5A (Resistive) or 3A (Inductive) 30-50 1A Resistive or Inductive AC 0-254V 5A Resistive or Inductive Cable Entries: 2 x M20 Bottom Weight: 1.2Kg Material: Anti Static U.V. Resistant Glass Reinforced Polyester Finish: Red Epoxy Paint Resistors: Alarm: 470 Ohm EOL: 4K7 Ohm Labelling: Burning House Symbol Protection:

Product Code
514.001.108 EX II 2 GD Dust Approved & Increased Safety (EExemd) Conventional Break Glass Manual Alarm Callpoint

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 19

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards

Banshee IS28
IS28VCL MK4 Banshee BS5839 Low Frequency ATEX and ICEX certified intrinsically safe grey sounder - 94dBA, 10mA. Certificate Number : ITS03ATEX21311x EXII 1GD EExia IIC T5.

Product Code
576.501.013 IS28VCL MK4 Banshee

Features
Robust GRP Body Suitable for offshore and petrochem Certificated Intrinsically Safe

XB8 Intrinsically Safe Beacon


This ruggedised, intrinsically safe and weatherproof beacon is intended for use in potentially explosive atmospheres, and has been designed with high ingress protection to cope with the harsh environmental conditions found offshore and onshore in the oil, gas and petrochemical industries. Please refer to MEDC for guidance on cable capacitance and barriers.

Technical Specification
CENELEC EN50014, 20 & 39 BAS02ATEX1258X EExia IIB T4 Zones 0,1 & 2 Material: UV stable glass reinforced polyester body. Clear polycarbonate cover/lens. Retained stainless steel cover screws. Finish: Painted Red Tube Type: Xenon discharge Lens Colour: Clear Terminals: 8 x 2.5mm2 Flash Rate: 1 flash per second Cable Entries: Up to 3 x M20 via knockouts Tube Energy: 0.5 Joules Weight: 1.4kg Certified Temperature: -55C to + 60C Ingress Protection: IP66 & IP67 Tube Life: >1 x 106 Flashes Voltage: 24V via suitable barrier Current Consumption: 71mA max nominal Certification:

Product Code
540.001.038 Intrinsically Safe Xenon Beacon (XB8BB024CNR)

Chapter 10 Page 20

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
For use in hazardous areas Robust GRP construction Powerful Output, up to 118dBA

DB3 Flameproof Horn Sounder


This lightweight all GRP flameproof sounder is intended for use in potentially explosive gas and dust atmospheres and has been designed with high ingress protection to cope with the harsh environmental conditions found offshore and onshore in the oil, gas and petrochemical industries. The flamepaths, flare and body, are manufactured completely from a UV stable glass reinforced polyester. Stainless steel screws and sinter are incorporated thus ensuring a corrosion free product. A tapered flamepath is used to overcome the problems of assembly of parallel spigot flamepaths.

Technical Specification
Terminals: Mounting: Cable Entries: Tone Selection: Certification: 6 x 2.5mm2 Stainless steel bracket with ratchet facility 2 x 20mm EExd. 27 user selectable tones. CENELEC EN50014,18,19 BASEEFA Cert. No. BAS00ATEX2097X, EExd IIC. Zones 1 and 2. Body & horn in anti-static, UV stable, glass reinforced polyester. Swivel bracket & captive cover screws in stainless steel. *Output measured with 24VDC input voltage. Tone set to 970Hz continuous. Weight: Ingress Protection: Voltage: Certified Temperature: 6.0kg approx IP66 / IP67 12VDC to 48VDC -20o C to +70o C

Material:

Nominal Output (dBA) 93 105 108 111 112 114 115 118

Input Current (mA)* 50 100 150 200 250 300 350 380

Product Code
576.501.049 Flameproof Horn Sounder (DB3D048N2BNR)

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 21

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Robust Corrosion Resistant GRP body High Power (5 Joule) Certificated Flameproof

XB11 Flameproof Xenon Beacon


These certified beacons have been designed for use in potentially explosive gas and dust atmospheres and harsh environmental conditions. The glass reinforced polyester enclosures are suitable for use offshore or onshore, where light weight combined with corrosion resistance is required. The beacon housing is manufactured completely from a U.V. stable, glass reinforced polyester. Stainless steel screws and mounting bracket are incorporated ensuring a totally corrosion free product.

Technical Specification
Voltage: Tube Energy: Peak Current Consumption (mA): Effective Intensity (Cd): Peak Intensity (Cd): Power Consumption (Watts): Note: Weight: Certified Temperature: Ingress Protection: Terminals: Entries: Certification: 24Vdc 5 Joules 320 29 22213 8 The Cd figures are for a clear lens @ 1Hz flash rate. For red lens multiple by 0.15 2.5Kg EExd -55C to + 70C (T4) -55C to + 55C (T5) -55C to + 40C (T6) IP66 & IP67 6 x 2.5mm2 2 x 20mm ISO EExd. BASEEFA EExd IIB 135C (-55 to AMB +70C)T4 100C (-55 to AMB + 55C)T5 85C (-55 to AMB + 40C)T6 Cert. No. 99 ATEX 2195X. CENELEC EN50014 and EN50018 Body: Glass reinforced polyester Lens: Glass Cover Screws + Backstrap: Stainless steel 316 Finish: Red

Product Code
540.001.039 Flameproof Xenon Beacon (XB11B02406RNBNNNR)

Material

Chapter 10 Page 22

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


The following section relates to a range of intrinsically safe barrier and isolator equipment for use with Tyco Safety Products manufactured fire detection systems. It essentially encompasses the relevant MTL 5000 and MTL 7000 series barriers plus the associated housing options as an alternative to existing MTL 700 series equipment. On all issues of intrinsically safe systems design, please refer to Manual 26A for guidance.

Intrinsically Safe Barriers - Atex Approved


Galvanic Isolators - MTL 5000
The MTL 5061 is a two channel interface for use with conventional fire and smoke detectors located in hazardous areas. This galvanic isolator is CE marked, and replaces the MTL 3043 barrier option. It is suitable for connecting loads in Zone 0, IIC, T4-6 hazardous areas if suitably certified. The MTL 5021 Isolating sounder driver enables an intrinsically safe sounder device located in the hazardous area, to be controlled from the safe area. The MTL 5021 barrier is designed as a CE marked replacement for the existing MTL 3021 barrier. It has one channel and is suitable for connecting loads in Zone 0, IIC, T4-6 hazardous area if suitably certified. When designing new systems or upgrading existing MTL 3000 series systems to MTL 5000 series, please use the appropriate MTL DX series enclosure equipment (16.2mm pitch). Product Codes 517.001.244 MTL 5061 2 channel galvanic isolator for conventional detector zone - used on BASEEFA Approved System 601 517.001.245 MTL 5021 I.S. Sounder driver

Zener Barriers - MTL 7700


The MTL 7700 Series intrinsically safe shunt-diode safety barriers are innovative devices designed to provide exceptionally high packing densities, straightforward installation and simplified connection, commissioning and maintenance facilities. The MTL 7700 Series include secondary replaceable fuses. These are useful where there is the possibility of faults occurring during commissioning, which would otherwise blow the barriers internal safety fuses. One secondary replaceable fuse for each barrier channel is provided and is lower in value than the safety related fuse. Fuses are packaged in small mouldings which can be latched in a disconnect position to break the safe and hazardous areas during commissioning, maintenance and fault finding, thus avoiding the need for additional disconnect terminals. Please note that this barrier is a direct alternative for the MTL 728+ barrier.

Product Code 517.001.301 MTL 7728 + Zener Safety Barrier for conventional detection circuits designed in accordance with System 601

Zener Barriers - MTL 700


The MTL700 series are 1 or 2 channel devices which pass the electrical signal from fire detectors to the control panel or from the control panel to the output device. The barriers limit the amount of energy to a level that cannot ignite explosive atmospheres. The over-voltage protection provided by a ShuntDiode Safety Barrier is with reference to the safety barrier earth connection. It is therefore imperative that a HIGH INTEGRITY EARTH is used for this type of barrier (14.2mm pitch). Product Codes 517.001.201 MTL728 Single Channel Zener Safety Barrier 517.001.202 MTL788 Dual Channel Zener Safety Barrier 546.004.005 Intrinsically safe sounder circuit interface module

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 23

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Safety Enclosures
UC Series Enclosures
The UC series of enclosures provides a simple but effective means of mounting and protecting the MTL3000 series units, in safe areas. A standard lightweight enclosure with transparent lid, which can accommodate 4 units. The polycarbonate enclosure is impact resistant, flame retardant and dustproof to IP65. Product Code 517.001.196 UC2 4 Way Barrier Housing

MT Series Enclosures
The MT series of enclosures provides a simple, effective means of mounting and protecting MTL700 Series barriers in safe areas or low-risk hazardous areas. Three lightweight polycarbonate enclosures with see through lids accommodate up to 2, 5 and 12 barriers in the safe area. All the enclosures are supplied ready fitted with a nickel plated brass busbar mount, so barriers can be installed and wired up immediately without special tools. Product Codes 517.001.198 MT2 2 Way Zener Barrier Housing. 517.001.199 MT5 5 Way Zener Barrier Housing. 517.001.200 MT12 12 Way Zener Barrier Housing

Ancillaries
The ERL7 earth rail is a nickel plated 3 x 10mm rail (1 metre long), suitable for a do-it-your self mounting arrangement. It will accommodate up to 2.5 ETM7 earth terminals per barrier location for terminating earth returns and cable screens from the hazardous area. The IMB7 mounts on a flat surface or top hat rail (35mm) or G-profile rail and acts as a convenient method for mounting the earth busbar. Product Codes 517.001.205 ERL7 Earth rail for I.S. systems 517.001.206 ETM7 Earth termination connection system 517.001.207 IMB7 Insulating mounting block 517.001.120 System 601 EOL Unit (PK10)

Chapter 10 Page 24

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


Features
Continuous detection despite extremely large monitoring area. Easy and rapid installation of the maintenance free sensor cable. Very high resistance to extreme ambient influences (immune against heat, cold, humidity, corrosion, strong winds and draft). Undiminished operation under electromagnetic interference. Unprecedented security against false alarms. Very high sensor cable service life of up to 30 years. Temperature profile over the complete measurement range delivers exact information of location, size and spread of fire. Very low maintenance costs as maintenance and trouble shooting can be done from the control unit. VdS certified to EN 54 part 5 One controller unit will drive up two 8 km spurs or one 8 km loop. Easy integration into existing installations. Each sensor cable divided into up to 256 zones. Individual configuration of 5 alarm criteria per zone. Network connection through Modbus, TCP/IP FTP and , SCPI interfaces.

MZX SensorLaser Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System


The MZX SensorLaser Plus guarantees fast and continuous fire detection even in difficult and varying ambient conditions. This linear heat detection system enables long and heavily fragmented facilities such as traffic and supply tunnels, cable routes and conveyor belts as well as large scale buildings such as production halls, cold stores and multi storey car parks to be monitored at all times. The MZX SensorLaser Plus is ideal for use in areas that are hard or impossible to access after installation, e.g. false floors, since maintenance and troubleshooting can be carried out from the control unit. The fibre optic sensor cable itself is maintenance free and, thanks to its particularly robust characteristics, offers a high level of security against false alarms. The sensor cable is insensitive to dust, dirt, moisture, high temperatures (up to approx. 90 C), pressure and the action of vibration and wind as well as corrosive atmospheres. Because of its purely passive, optical analysis process, the MZX SensorLaser Plus is even immune from electromagnetic interference caused by generators, energy routes, cables or electric motors. The MZX SensorLaser Plus delivers precise information about the location, size and spread of a fire even under ambient conditions that would cause other fire detection systems to fail. The MZX SensorLaser Plus enables a measuring range of up to 8 km per sensor cable. Up to 2 spurs each with an 8 km measurement range, or 1 loop with an 8 km range can be connected. Since the ambient conditions in a monitoring area of this size can vary enormously, each sensor cable can be divided into up to 256 zones. Several alarm criteria can be freely defined in each zone. This level of precision adjustment allows the MZX SensorLaser Plus to provide a high level of resistance to false alarms and precise fire detection despite contrary and variable ambient conditions. The accessible laser radiation emitted by the Class 1M laser is not hazardous to the eyes (provided there are no other optical instruments in the path of the beam), while operation is absolutely fail-safe even in the event of a break in the cable. In addition, the sensor cable can be used in explosive atmospheres (ATEX zones) up to zone 0 without any additional measures being required. In contrast to conventional fibre optic systems, the low laser output of < 20mW ensures that the measuring system has a long service life. Zone Configuration Ambient conditions (temperatures) can fluctuate sharply over a measuring range of many hundreds of metres. This makes it essential to divide the measuring range into zones that can be adapted optimally to the ambient conditions on the basis of differing alarm criteria. This ensures high detection reliability and also security against false alarms. The MZX SensorLaser Plus allows the measuring range to be very finely divided into zones. Up to 256 zones can be defined for each sensor cable, with up to 5 alarm criteria configurable in each zone. Another 2 alarm criteria respond when there is a temperature drop, enabling them to be used e.g. in tunnels to warn of black ice.

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 Page 25

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


MZX SensorLaser Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System Cont.
Control Unit With ten product variants, permitting measuring ranges of 1 to 8 km, the MZX SensorLaser Plus can be configured to suit the particular project. Sensor Cable The sensor cables offered are optimised for a rapid response time. The sheathing is flame retardant, halogen free and resistant to dust, dirt, moisture, corrosive atmospheres and most organic solvents. Both types of sensor cable offer adequate protection against rodents and are designed for a service life of 30 years. There are two different types of sensor cable for differing project requirements. The MZX SensorLaser Plus Safety cable can be used under normal ambient conditions. It is particularly flexible and extremely versatile. Where the sensor cable is expected to be exposed to high mechanical stresses, we recommend that the MZX SensorLaser Plus Steel Wire Armoured cable be used. This sensor cable, which was specifically developed for heavy duty applications, is particularly suitable where high tensile forces and high lateral pressures can occur. The cable length will be individually cut to the customer specified length and 2 connectors are fitted for easy handling. The cable should be commissioned in multiples of one metre and therefore the order for the cable has to be placed per metre. Every order for sensor cable must include the corresponding connectors, which will be assembled by the supplier. The cable with pre assembled connectors offers fast commissioning of the system without any additional splicing. Mounting Materials For professional mounting of the sensor cables four different types of mounting sets are available. These sets are designed for different applications. They can be used for the mounting of the sensor cable to the wall and the ceiling. Every set contains 100 x clamps, 100 x anchors and 1 x SDS drill bit. LAN (10/100M) Modbus / TCP/IP SCADA System Supervisory Control and Data Acquisition Controller Unit Interface Box PC Work Station 20 Relay Outputs 1 Fault 19 Alarms SCPI/FTP Modbus/TCP/IP/SCPI/FPT SCPI Plastic Clamps The plastic of these clamps is UV resistant, halogen free and particularly robust in ambient conditions. Steel Clamps The clamps in these sets are made of stainless steel or zinc plated steel and are rubber protected. The rubber protection guarantees that the sensor cable is not damaged if friction occurs. For every clamp 2 x nuts are included for fixing to the anchor. Connection Cable Connection to the MZX Fire Alarm Panel is by means of the MZX SensorLaser Plus Connection Set. This set consists of 3 x cables. For connection of the Fire Alarm Panel to one end of the sensor cable a D-Sub connector is included. The other end of the sensor cable is desoldered which provides a quick connection into the MZX System without any soldering effort. Enhanced Communication The MZX SensorLaser Plus iBox allows the 20 relay outputs supplied as standard to be expanded up to 2 x 256 outputs so that each zone can be assigned its own relay output. This could, for instance, be used to control fire extinguishing systems. The iBox also enables connection to SCADA or process control systems via Modbus TCP or Modbus RTU. The number of relays can be extended using the MZX SensorLaser Plus Relay Controller Set. This set consists of a pre-programmed field bus controller, one Digital Output Module and an End module. It also comes with 8 x relays and accessories for easy wiring.

MZX Panel Relay Controller Set

Relay Extension Set

By means of the Relay Controller Set and the Relay Extension Set an additional 256 relays per sensor cable can be connected. Chapter 10 Page 26 Fire Catalogue 02/12

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards


MZX SensorLaser Plus Fibre Optic Linear Heat Detection System Cont.
Complies with the essential requirements of the following applicable European Directives and carries the CE marking accordingly: The Low Voltage Directive 73/23/EEC amended by 93/68/EEC The EMC Directive 2004/108/EC Conforms with the following product standards: EMC IEC61326:1997+A1:1998+A2:2000 EN61326:1997+A1:1998+A2:2001 CISPR11:1997+A1:1999 / EN55011:1998+A1:1999 IEC61000-4-2:2001/EN61000-4-2:1995+A1:1998+A2:2001 IEC61000-4-3:2002/EN61000-4-3:2002 IEC61000-4-4:2001/EN61000-4-4:1995+A1:2001+A2:2001 IEC61000-4-5:2001/EN61000-4-5:1995+A1:2001 IEC61000-4-6:1995+A1:2000 /EN61000-4-6:1996+A1:2001 IEC61000-4-8:2001/EN61000-4-8:1993+A1:2001 IEC61000-4-11:1994+A1:2000 EN61000-4-11:1994+A1:2001 Canada: ICES-001:1998 SAFETY IEC61010-1:2001/EN61010-1:2001 IEC60825-1:2001/EN60825-1:1994+A11:1996+A2:2001 Canada:CAN/CSA-C22.2No.61010-1:2004 USA:UL61010-1:2004;FDA21CFR1040.10+Laser Notice No.50

Product Codes
516.016.310 516.016.311 516.016.312 516.016.313 516.016.333 516.016.334 516.016.314 516.016.315 516.016.316 516.016.317 516.016.318 516.016.319 516.016.320 516.016.321 516.016.322 516.016.322.C 516.016.323 516.016.323.C 516.016.324 516.016.325 516.016.326 516.016.327 516.016.328 516.016.329 516.016.330 516.016.331 516.016.332 MZX SensorLaser Plus 1/1 1 km range, 1 sensor cable. MZX SensorLaser Plus 1/2 1 km range, 2 sensor cables. MZX SensorLaser Plus 2/1 2 km range, 1 sensor cable. MZX SensorLaser Plus 2/2 2 km range, 2 sensor cables. MZX SensorLaser Plus 3/1 3 km range, 1 sensor cable. MZX SensorLaser Plus 3/2 3 km range, 2 sensor cables. MZX SensorLaser Plus 4/1 4 km range, 1 sensor cable. MZX SensorLaser Plus 4/2 4 km range, 2 sensor cables. MZX SensorLaser Plus 8/1 8 km range, 1 sensor cable. MZX SensorLaser Plus 8/2 8 km range, 2 sensor cables. MZX SensorLaser Plus Connection Set. MZX SensorLaser Plus iBox MZX SensorLaser Plus Relay Controller Set. MZX SensorLaser Plus Power Supply. MZX SensorLaser Plus Safety Cable (per metre). MZX SensorLaser Plus Safety Connector. MZX Steel Wire Armoured SensorLaser Plus Cable (per metre). MZX SensorLaser Plus Steel Connector. MZX SensorLaser Plus Setting Tool. MZX SensorLaser Plus Relay Extension Set. MZX SensorLaser Plus Zinc Plastic Clamp Set. (PK 100) MZX SensorLaser Plus Steel Plastic Clamp Set. (PK 100) MZX SensorLaser Plus Steel Zinc Clamp Set. (PK 100) MZX SensorLaser Plus Stainless Steel Clamp Set. (PK 100) MZX SensorLaser Plus Spare Unit. MZX SensorLaser Plus Demo Unit. MZX SensorLaser Plus Demo Box. Chapter 10 Page 27

Technical Specification
Operating temperature range: -10C to +60C (2 channel options: from -5C) Storage temperature range: -40C to +80C Operating humidity range: 0% to 95% RH (2 channel options: 15% to 85% RH) non condensing Dimensions (H x W x D): 88 x 448 x 364 mm (19 rack) Weight: 9 kg Fibre types: MM 50/125 m graded index MM 62.5/125 m graded index Dynamic range: 30 dB (2-way loss) Sensing temperature range: -273C to +700C depending on sensor coating Optical connector: E2000; 8 angled Number of channels: 1, 2 depending on channel option Computer interface: USB, LAN Relay board: 4 inputs / 20 outputs Power supply: 10 V to 30 Vdc Power consumption: 15 W typically, at 20C ambient temperature < 40 W (entire operating conditions) Measurement times: from 10s to 30s Available spatial resolution settings: 1 m; 1.5 m; 3 m; 5 m; 8 m Available measurement modes: Single ended/Dual ended; including fibre break recovery Internal data storage capability: 150 traces total Power Supply (option) operating conditions: 0C to +50C; non condensing; indoor use only Laser class (IEC 60825-1: 2001):1M

02/12

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 10 - Special Hazards

This page is left intentionally blank.

Chapter 10 Page 28

Fire Catalogue

02/12

Chapter 11 - Useful Information MX Addressable Detector , Mode Selection & Design Charts
These charts are designed to assist with the selection of the best detector for the risk. 1. First select the environment 2. Then select the fire loading or risk being protected

07/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 11 Page 1

Table 1- 801PC Detector

Chapter 11 - Useful Information

Chapter 11 Page 2

Fire Catalogue

07/10

Table 2 - 800 Series Detectors

Chapter 11 - Useful Information Conventional Detector Selection & Design Charts

07/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 11 Page 3

Table 3 - Series 600 Detectors

PART NO. DESCRIPTION


CONVENTIONAL ONLY CONVENTIONAL ONLY MINERVA ADDRESSABLE/MX MINERVA ADDRESSABLE/MX MZX-c ONLY MZX-c ONLY MX ONLY MX ONLY LOOP YES LOOP YES WHITE WHITE DETECTION CIRCUIT NO YELLOW DETECTION CIRCUIT NO YELLOW 24Vdc YES BLUE 24Vdc YES BLUE 24Vdc NO GREEN 24Vdc NO GREEN

CONTROL PANEL COMPATIBILITY

POWERED FROM

DETECTOR REQUIRED TO OPERATE

PARK CLIP COLOUR

577.001.035

601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.037

601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.911

901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE

Chapter 11 - Useful Information

Chapter 11 Page 4 CURRENT CONSUMPTION AT 68 dBA (MINIMUM VOLUME)


1.2mA 1.2mA 1.2mA 1.2mA 1.2mA 1.2mA 6.8mA 21mA 6.8mA 6.8mA 6.8mA 21mA 6.8mA 6.8mA

516.800.912

912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.036

602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE

577.001.038

602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.910

802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE

516.800.913

812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE

PART NO. DESCRIPTION

CURRENT CONSUMPTION AT 90 dBA (MAXIMUM VOLUME)

CURRENT CONSUMPTION AT 100dBA (FIXED VOLUME)

577.001.035

601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.037

601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.911

901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE

516.800.912

912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.036

602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE

577.001.038

602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.910

802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE

MKII Sounder Base Application Table

Fire Catalogue
YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES , YES YES YES

516.800.913

812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE

PART NO. DESCRIPTION

DUTCH SLOW TEMPORAL 4 SLOW SWEEP (3) MARCH TIME BEEP(25) SWEEP (7)

MARCH TIME BEEP(26)

577.001.035

601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.037

601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.911

901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE

516.800.912

912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE

YES

577.001.036

602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE

577.001.038

602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.910

802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE

516.800.913

812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE

YES

07/10

07/10 FAST SWEEP (2)


YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES YES

PART NO. DESCRIPTION

TEMPORAL 3 ALTERNATING 2(11) ALTERNATING 2 (9) CONTINUOUS(14)

CONTINUOUS

577.001.035

601SB CONVENTIONAL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.037

601SBD CONVENTIONAL DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.911

901SB UNIVERSAL SOUNDER BASE

516.800.912

912SB UNIVERSAL UL SOUNDER BASE

577.001.036

602SB 2 WIRE LINE POWERED SOUNDER BASE

577.001.038

602SBD 2 WIRE LINE POWERED DIODE SOUNDER BASE

516.800.910

802SB MX LOW POWERED SOUNDER BASE

516.800.913

812SB LOOP POWERED UL SOUNDER BASE

Chapter 11 - Useful Information

MKII Sounder Base Application Table

(2) (3) (7) (9) (11) (14) (25) (26) = ROSHNI TONE NUMBER

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 11 Page 5

Chapter 11 - Useful Information Sounder Tone Tables


Tone Information
No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 Description Banshee LF Buzz Banshee LF Fast Sweep Banshee LF Slow Sweep Banshee LF Continuous Banshee LF Fast Sweep (New) Medium Sweep LF Continuous LF Backup Alarm LF Alternate LF Medium Sweep LF Alternate LF Banshee/Bedlam HF buzz Banshee/Bedlam HF Fast Sweep Frequency and Timing 800Hz ato 950Hz swept at 120Hz* 800Hz to 950 swept at 9Hz* 800Hz to 950Hz swept at 3Hz* Continuous at 850Hz* 830Hz to 970Hz swept at 9Hz* 800Hz to 970Hz swept at 1 Hx* Continuous at 970Hz* Intermittent at 950Hz 1s on, 1s off* Alternating 800Hz/1000Hz,0.5s each sound* 800Hz/1000Hz swept at 0.5s* Alternating tones 800/950Hz* 2400Hz to 2900Hz at 120Hz 2400Hz to 2900Hz at 9Hz 2400Hz to 2900Hz at 3Hz Continuous at 2900Hz at 3Hz 2450Hz to 3100Hz swept at 9Hz Intermittent at 2900Hz 1s on 1s off Alternating tones 2400/2900Hz at 3Hz 500Hz rising to 1200Hz over 3.5, silence 0.5s, repeat 1200Hz falling to 500Hz over 1s, silence 10ms, repeat 554Hz for 100ms and 440Hz for 400ms 420Hz repeating 0.625s on, 0.625s off 500Hz rising to 1200Hz over 3.75s on, 0.25s off 950Hz for 0.5s on 0.5s off, for 3 phases, silence for 1.5s & repeat 2900Hz for 0.5s on 0.5s off, for 3 phases, silence for 1.5s & repeat Intermittent 660Hz 150ms on, 150ms off Continuous 660Hz Intermittent 970Hz 500ms on, 550ms off* Intermittent 2900Hz 500ms on, 500ms off Yodel 800Hz/1000Hz, 0.25s each frequency* Continuous 1000Hz* Bell Tone* 2nd Tone 4 4 4 4 4 7 7 4 4 4 4 15 15 15 15 15 15 15 4 4 4 4 4 4 15 26 27 28 29 31 31 32

Banshee 12V
dBa (Typ) 94 94 94 95 95 95 97 97 94 95 96 102 103 103 105 103 105 104 96 93 90 88 96 96 105 81 84 96 106 93 95 96 mA(Typ) 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 4 8 5 6 12 12 12 12 12 7 12 6 6 5 3 6 3 6 4 5 4 8 8 8 8

Banshee 24V
dBA(Typ) mA(Typ) 100 100 100 101 101 102 103 103 101 101 103 110 110 110 112 110 112 110 101 101 96 94 103 103 112 87 89 103 112 101 102 101 12 12 12 12 12 12 12 7 14 12 14 25 25 25 30 25 15 25 12 14 10 6 12 6 12 7 14 7 15 14 17 17 12345 00000 10000 01000 11000 00100 10100 01100 11100 00010 10010 01010 11010 00110 10110 01110 11110 00001 10001 01001 11001 00101 10101 01101 11101 00011 10011 01011 11011 00111 10111 01111 11111

14 Banshee/Bedlam HF Slow Sweep 15 Banshee/Bedlam HF Continuous

16 Banshee/Bedlam HF Fast Sweep (New) 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 Back up Alarm LF Alternate LF Slow Whoop Din Tone (DK) French Fire Sound Australian Alert SIgnal Australian Evacuation Signal US Temporal Tone LF US Temporal Tone HF Swedish Tone (Fire) Swedish Tone (all Clear) ISO8201LF ISO8201HF BT Banshee (FP1063.1) BT Banshee (FP1063.1) Bell Tone

*Tone meets frequency requirements of BS5839 Pt. 1 1988

Chapter 11 Page 6

Fire Catalogue

07/10

Chapter 11 - Useful Information


Fulleon Sounder Tone Compatibility Table
Fulleon Tone Tone Number 2 Wire Symphoni 24V Symphoni Sounder Base 601SB/601SBD 602SB/602SBD
SWITCH 1 2 3 4 111X (880Hz) PULSED/INTERMITTENT TONE (970HZ@ 1HZ) ALTERNATING TONE (970HZ/800HZ@2HZ) DUTCH SLOW WHOOP (500Hz-1200Hz-3s on/0.5s off) SLOW SWEEP (800Hz/970Hz@1Hz) FAST SWEEP (800Hz/970HZ@7HZ) TWO TONE/ALTERNATING (800HZ/970HZ@1HZ) 7 3 2 11 N/A N/A N/A N/A 11001 11101 11110 10101 000X 010X 100X 110X (660Hz/880Hz@1Hz)EURO ONLY 25 1 (CLOSEST MATCH) 11 01 (990HZ/650HZ@2HZ) 00111 11111 011X (880Hz@1Hz)EURO ONLY N/A

SWITCH A B CONTINUOUS TONE (970HZ) 14 10

SWITCH 1 2 3 4 5 10010

Fulleon Sounder Tone Table


No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 TONE ALT TONES 800/970 at 1/4 Hz SWEEPING 800/970Hz at 7Hz SWEEPING 800/970Hz at 1Hz CONTINUOUS at 2850Hz SWEEPING 2400-2850Hz at 7Hz SWEEPING 2400-2850Hz at 1Hz SLOW WHOOP SWEEP 1200-500 at 1Hz ALT TONES 2400/2850 2Hz INT TONE OF 970Hz at 1Hz ALT TONES 800/970 Hz at 1Hz INT TONE at 2850 Hz at 1Hz 970Hz at 1/4 SEC. ON 1 SEC. OFF CONTINUOUS AT 970Hz 554 FOR 100ms and 440Hz FOR 400ms INT 660Hz 150ms ON/150ms OFF INT 660Hz 1.8s ON/1.8s OFF INT 660Hz 6.5s ON/13s OFF CONTINUOUS 660Hz ALT 554/440Hz at 1Hz INT 660Hz 1Hz INT 2850Hz 150ms ON 100ms OFF SWEEP 800-970Hz at 50Hz SWEEP 2400-2850Z at 50 Hz INTERMITTENT 970Hz 500ms ON 500ms OFF INTERMITTENT 2850HZ 500ms ON 500ms OFF CONTINUOUS AT 4kHz ALTERNATING TONES 800/970 AT 2Hz ALTERNATING TONES 988/645 AT 2Hz ALTERNATING 510/610 at 1Hz SWEEPING 300-1200 at 1Hz CONTINUOUS AT 4kHz

07/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 11 Page 7

Chapter 11 - Useful Information


Features
Selecting the category of protection and coverage. How to configure detector zones and alarm zones within premises. Which type of fire detection system? Detector suitability. Detector coverage. Manual break glass call points. Limitation of false alarms. Means of giving warning to occupants. Control and indicating equipment. Power supplies. Cabling considerations. Communication with the fire service. System installation. Documentation. Standards and Specifications. Associated Ancillary Equipment. Networking and Graphics. Installation. Commissioning. Training. Maintenance.

Consultants Guide
A Fire Detection System Consultants Guide for consultants designing systems to BS5839-1:2002.

Product Code
CGUK-01 Consultants Guide

Chapter 11 Page 8

Fire Catalogue

07/10

Notes

07/10

Fire Catalogue

Chapter 11 Page 9

European Distribution Centre - Echt, Holland (Warehousing / Distribution / Purchasing / Customer Service / Call Centre Helpdesk) Voltaweg 20 6101 XK Echt Holland Tel: +31 475 371 666 Fax: +31 475 371 660 E-mail: tfseu.service@tycoint.com

European TSP Technical Support Call Centre Toll Free: 0800 CALL TYCO or (0800 22 55 89 26) 9:00 AM to 5:00 PM EET, CET & GMT UK Only: 08701 238 787

UK Distribution Centre (Warehousing / Distribution / Purchasing) Dunhams Lane Letchworth Hertfordshire SG6 1BE United Kingdom Tel: +44 (0) 1462 667 700 Fax: +44 (0) 1462 667 777 E-mail: tfsuk.service@tycoint.com

www.tycoemea.com 2012 Tyco International PMC001 Issue 7.24 / February 2012 The right is reserved to modify or withdraw any product or service without notice

a vital part of your world

You might also like